[AArch64] Fix mis-detection of unpredictable load/store operations with FP regs.
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / breakpoint.c
... / ...
CommitLineData
1/* Everything about breakpoints, for GDB.
2
3 Copyright (C) 1986-2014 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4
5 This file is part of GDB.
6
7 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify
8 it under the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by
9 the Free Software Foundation; either version 3 of the License, or
10 (at your option) any later version.
11
12 This program is distributed in the hope that it will be useful,
13 but WITHOUT ANY WARRANTY; without even the implied warranty of
14 MERCHANTABILITY or FITNESS FOR A PARTICULAR PURPOSE. See the
15 GNU General Public License for more details.
16
17 You should have received a copy of the GNU General Public License
18 along with this program. If not, see <http://www.gnu.org/licenses/>. */
19
20#include "defs.h"
21#include "arch-utils.h"
22#include <ctype.h>
23#include "hashtab.h"
24#include "symtab.h"
25#include "frame.h"
26#include "breakpoint.h"
27#include "tracepoint.h"
28#include "gdbtypes.h"
29#include "expression.h"
30#include "gdbcore.h"
31#include "gdbcmd.h"
32#include "value.h"
33#include "command.h"
34#include "inferior.h"
35#include "infrun.h"
36#include "gdbthread.h"
37#include "target.h"
38#include "language.h"
39#include "gdb-demangle.h"
40#include "filenames.h"
41#include "annotate.h"
42#include "symfile.h"
43#include "objfiles.h"
44#include "source.h"
45#include "linespec.h"
46#include "completer.h"
47#include "gdb.h"
48#include "ui-out.h"
49#include "cli/cli-script.h"
50#include "block.h"
51#include "solib.h"
52#include "solist.h"
53#include "observer.h"
54#include "memattr.h"
55#include "ada-lang.h"
56#include "top.h"
57#include "valprint.h"
58#include "jit.h"
59#include "xml-syscall.h"
60#include "parser-defs.h"
61#include "gdb_regex.h"
62#include "probe.h"
63#include "cli/cli-utils.h"
64#include "continuations.h"
65#include "stack.h"
66#include "skip.h"
67#include "ax-gdb.h"
68#include "dummy-frame.h"
69
70#include "format.h"
71
72/* readline include files */
73#include "readline/readline.h"
74#include "readline/history.h"
75
76/* readline defines this. */
77#undef savestring
78
79#include "mi/mi-common.h"
80#include "extension.h"
81
82/* Enums for exception-handling support. */
83enum exception_event_kind
84{
85 EX_EVENT_THROW,
86 EX_EVENT_RETHROW,
87 EX_EVENT_CATCH
88};
89
90/* Prototypes for local functions. */
91
92static void enable_delete_command (char *, int);
93
94static void enable_once_command (char *, int);
95
96static void enable_count_command (char *, int);
97
98static void disable_command (char *, int);
99
100static void enable_command (char *, int);
101
102static void map_breakpoint_numbers (char *, void (*) (struct breakpoint *,
103 void *),
104 void *);
105
106static void ignore_command (char *, int);
107
108static int breakpoint_re_set_one (void *);
109
110static void breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *);
111
112static void create_sals_from_address_default (char **,
113 struct linespec_result *,
114 enum bptype, char *,
115 char **);
116
117static void create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *,
118 struct linespec_result *,
119 char *, char *, enum bptype,
120 enum bpdisp, int, int,
121 int,
122 const struct breakpoint_ops *,
123 int, int, int, unsigned);
124
125static void decode_linespec_default (struct breakpoint *, char **,
126 struct symtabs_and_lines *);
127
128static void clear_command (char *, int);
129
130static void catch_command (char *, int);
131
132static int can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *);
133
134static void break_command_1 (char *, int, int);
135
136static void mention (struct breakpoint *);
137
138static struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *,
139 enum bptype,
140 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
141static struct bp_location *add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *,
142 const struct symtab_and_line *);
143
144/* This function is used in gdbtk sources and thus can not be made
145 static. */
146struct breakpoint *set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
147 struct symtab_and_line,
148 enum bptype,
149 const struct breakpoint_ops *);
150
151static struct breakpoint *
152 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
153 enum bptype type,
154 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
155 int loc_enabled);
156
157static void breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR, CORE_ADDR, int, int);
158
159static CORE_ADDR adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
160 CORE_ADDR bpaddr,
161 enum bptype bptype);
162
163static void describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *,
164 struct program_space *, CORE_ADDR,
165 struct obj_section *, int);
166
167static int watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
168 struct bp_location *loc2);
169
170static int breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
171 struct address_space *aspace,
172 CORE_ADDR addr);
173
174static void breakpoints_info (char *, int);
175
176static void watchpoints_info (char *, int);
177
178static int breakpoint_1 (char *, int,
179 int (*) (const struct breakpoint *));
180
181static int breakpoint_cond_eval (void *);
182
183static void cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *);
184
185static void commands_command (char *, int);
186
187static void condition_command (char *, int);
188
189typedef enum
190 {
191 mark_inserted,
192 mark_uninserted
193 }
194insertion_state_t;
195
196static int remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
197static int remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *, insertion_state_t);
198
199static enum print_stop_action print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs);
200
201static int watchpoint_check (void *);
202
203static void maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *, int);
204
205static int hw_breakpoint_used_count (void);
206
207static int hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *);
208
209static int hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
210 enum bptype type,
211 int *other_type_used);
212
213static void hbreak_command (char *, int);
214
215static void thbreak_command (char *, int);
216
217static void enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *, enum bpdisp,
218 int count);
219
220static void stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
221
222static void stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
223
224static void stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
225
226static void tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty);
227
228static void free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
229static void incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc);
230static void decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **loc);
231
232static struct bp_location *allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt);
233
234/* update_global_location_list's modes of operation wrt to whether to
235 insert locations now. */
236enum ugll_insert_mode
237{
238 /* Don't insert any breakpoint locations into the inferior, only
239 remove already-inserted locations that no longer should be
240 inserted. Functions that delete a breakpoint or breakpoints
241 should specify this mode, so that deleting a breakpoint doesn't
242 have the side effect of inserting the locations of other
243 breakpoints that are marked not-inserted, but should_be_inserted
244 returns true on them.
245
246 This behavior is useful is situations close to tear-down -- e.g.,
247 after an exec, while the target still has execution, but
248 breakpoint shadows of the previous executable image should *NOT*
249 be restored to the new image; or before detaching, where the
250 target still has execution and wants to delete breakpoints from
251 GDB's lists, and all breakpoints had already been removed from
252 the inferior. */
253 UGLL_DONT_INSERT,
254
255 /* May insert breakpoints iff breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now
256 claims breakpoints should be inserted now. */
257 UGLL_MAY_INSERT,
258
259 /* Insert locations now, irrespective of
260 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now. E.g., say all threads are
261 stopped right now, and the user did "continue". We need to
262 insert breakpoints _before_ resuming the target, but
263 UGLL_MAY_INSERT wouldn't insert them, because
264 breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now returns false at that point,
265 as no thread is running yet. */
266 UGLL_INSERT
267};
268
269static void update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode);
270
271static void update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode);
272
273static int is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt);
274
275static void insert_breakpoint_locations (void);
276
277static int syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b);
278
279static void tracepoints_info (char *, int);
280
281static void delete_trace_command (char *, int);
282
283static void enable_trace_command (char *, int);
284
285static void disable_trace_command (char *, int);
286
287static void trace_pass_command (char *, int);
288
289static void set_tracepoint_count (int num);
290
291static int is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b);
292
293static struct bp_location **get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address);
294
295/* Return 1 if B refers to a static tracepoint set by marker ("-m"), zero
296 otherwise. */
297
298static int strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b);
299
300/* The abstract base class all breakpoint_ops structures inherit
301 from. */
302struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops;
303
304/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherited by all breakpoint_ops
305 that are implemented on top of software or hardware breakpoints
306 (user breakpoints, internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
307static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
308
309/* Internal breakpoints class type. */
310static struct breakpoint_ops internal_breakpoint_ops;
311
312/* Momentary breakpoints class type. */
313static struct breakpoint_ops momentary_breakpoint_ops;
314
315/* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception class type. */
316static struct breakpoint_ops longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
317
318/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular user created
319 breakpoints. */
320struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
321
322/* Breakpoints set on probes. */
323static struct breakpoint_ops bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
324
325/* Dynamic printf class type. */
326struct breakpoint_ops dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
327
328/* The style in which to perform a dynamic printf. This is a user
329 option because different output options have different tradeoffs;
330 if GDB does the printing, there is better error handling if there
331 is a problem with any of the arguments, but using an inferior
332 function lets you have special-purpose printers and sending of
333 output to the same place as compiled-in print functions. */
334
335static const char dprintf_style_gdb[] = "gdb";
336static const char dprintf_style_call[] = "call";
337static const char dprintf_style_agent[] = "agent";
338static const char *const dprintf_style_enums[] = {
339 dprintf_style_gdb,
340 dprintf_style_call,
341 dprintf_style_agent,
342 NULL
343};
344static const char *dprintf_style = dprintf_style_gdb;
345
346/* The function to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
347 call into the inferior. The value is simply a string that is
348 copied into the command, so it can be anything that GDB can
349 evaluate to a callable address, not necessarily a function name. */
350
351static char *dprintf_function = "";
352
353/* The channel to use for dynamic printf if the preferred style is to
354 call into the inferior; if a nonempty string, it will be passed to
355 the call as the first argument, with the format string as the
356 second. As with the dprintf function, this can be anything that
357 GDB knows how to evaluate, so in addition to common choices like
358 "stderr", this could be an app-specific expression like
359 "mystreams[curlogger]". */
360
361static char *dprintf_channel = "";
362
363/* True if dprintf commands should continue to operate even if GDB
364 has disconnected. */
365static int disconnected_dprintf = 1;
366
367/* A reference-counted struct command_line. This lets multiple
368 breakpoints share a single command list. */
369struct counted_command_line
370{
371 /* The reference count. */
372 int refc;
373
374 /* The command list. */
375 struct command_line *commands;
376};
377
378struct command_line *
379breakpoint_commands (struct breakpoint *b)
380{
381 return b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
382}
383
384/* Flag indicating that a command has proceeded the inferior past the
385 current breakpoint. */
386
387static int breakpoint_proceeded;
388
389const char *
390bpdisp_text (enum bpdisp disp)
391{
392 /* NOTE: the following values are a part of MI protocol and
393 represent values of 'disp' field returned when inferior stops at
394 a breakpoint. */
395 static const char * const bpdisps[] = {"del", "dstp", "dis", "keep"};
396
397 return bpdisps[(int) disp];
398}
399
400/* Prototypes for exported functions. */
401/* If FALSE, gdb will not use hardware support for watchpoints, even
402 if such is available. */
403static int can_use_hw_watchpoints;
404
405static void
406show_can_use_hw_watchpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
407 struct cmd_list_element *c,
408 const char *value)
409{
410 fprintf_filtered (file,
411 _("Debugger's willingness to use "
412 "watchpoint hardware is %s.\n"),
413 value);
414}
415
416/* If AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE, gdb will not attempt to create pending breakpoints.
417 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_TRUE, gdb will automatically create pending breakpoints
418 for unrecognized breakpoint locations.
419 If AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO, gdb will query when breakpoints are unrecognized. */
420static enum auto_boolean pending_break_support;
421static void
422show_pending_break_support (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
423 struct cmd_list_element *c,
424 const char *value)
425{
426 fprintf_filtered (file,
427 _("Debugger's behavior regarding "
428 "pending breakpoints is %s.\n"),
429 value);
430}
431
432/* If 1, gdb will automatically use hardware breakpoints for breakpoints
433 set with "break" but falling in read-only memory.
434 If 0, gdb will warn about such breakpoints, but won't automatically
435 use hardware breakpoints. */
436static int automatic_hardware_breakpoints;
437static void
438show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
439 struct cmd_list_element *c,
440 const char *value)
441{
442 fprintf_filtered (file,
443 _("Automatic usage of hardware breakpoints is %s.\n"),
444 value);
445}
446
447/* If on, GDB keeps breakpoints inserted even if the inferior is
448 stopped, and immediately inserts any new breakpoints as soon as
449 they're created. If off (default), GDB keeps breakpoints off of
450 the target as long as possible. That is, it delays inserting
451 breakpoints until the next resume, and removes them again when the
452 target fully stops. This is a bit safer in case GDB crashes while
453 processing user input. */
454static int always_inserted_mode = 0;
455
456static void
457show_always_inserted_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
458 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
459{
460 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Always inserted breakpoint mode is %s.\n"),
461 value);
462}
463
464/* See breakpoint.h. */
465
466int
467breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now (void)
468{
469 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
470 {
471 /* If breakpoints are global, they should be inserted even if no
472 thread under gdb's control is running, or even if there are
473 no threads under GDB's control yet. */
474 return 1;
475 }
476 else if (target_has_execution)
477 {
478 if (always_inserted_mode)
479 {
480 /* The user wants breakpoints inserted even if all threads
481 are stopped. */
482 return 1;
483 }
484
485 if (threads_are_executing ())
486 return 1;
487 }
488 return 0;
489}
490
491static const char condition_evaluation_both[] = "host or target";
492
493/* Modes for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
494static const char condition_evaluation_auto[] = "auto";
495static const char condition_evaluation_host[] = "host";
496static const char condition_evaluation_target[] = "target";
497static const char *const condition_evaluation_enums[] = {
498 condition_evaluation_auto,
499 condition_evaluation_host,
500 condition_evaluation_target,
501 NULL
502};
503
504/* Global that holds the current mode for breakpoint condition evaluation. */
505static const char *condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_auto;
506
507/* Global that we use to display information to the user (gets its value from
508 condition_evaluation_mode_1. */
509static const char *condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_auto;
510
511/* Translate a condition evaluation mode MODE into either "host"
512 or "target". This is used mostly to translate from "auto" to the
513 real setting that is being used. It returns the translated
514 evaluation mode. */
515
516static const char *
517translate_condition_evaluation_mode (const char *mode)
518{
519 if (mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
520 {
521 if (target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
522 return condition_evaluation_target;
523 else
524 return condition_evaluation_host;
525 }
526 else
527 return mode;
528}
529
530/* Discovers what condition_evaluation_auto translates to. */
531
532static const char *
533breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode (void)
534{
535 return translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
536}
537
538/* Return true if GDB should evaluate breakpoint conditions or false
539 otherwise. */
540
541static int
542gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p (void)
543{
544 const char *mode = breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ();
545
546 return (mode == condition_evaluation_host);
547}
548
549void _initialize_breakpoint (void);
550
551/* Are we executing breakpoint commands? */
552static int executing_breakpoint_commands;
553
554/* Are overlay event breakpoints enabled? */
555static int overlay_events_enabled;
556
557/* See description in breakpoint.h. */
558int target_exact_watchpoints = 0;
559
560/* Walk the following statement or block through all breakpoints.
561 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE does so even if the statement deletes the
562 current breakpoint. */
563
564#define ALL_BREAKPOINTS(B) for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next)
565
566#define ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE(B,TMP) \
567 for (B = breakpoint_chain; \
568 B ? (TMP=B->next, 1): 0; \
569 B = TMP)
570
571/* Similar iterator for the low-level breakpoints. SAFE variant is
572 not provided so update_global_location_list must not be called
573 while executing the block of ALL_BP_LOCATIONS. */
574
575#define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS(B,BP_TMP) \
576 for (BP_TMP = bp_location; \
577 BP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count && (B = *BP_TMP); \
578 BP_TMP++)
579
580/* Iterates through locations with address ADDRESS for the currently selected
581 program space. BP_LOCP_TMP points to each object. BP_LOCP_START points
582 to where the loop should start from.
583 If BP_LOCP_START is a NULL pointer, the macro automatically seeks the
584 appropriate location to start with. */
585
586#define ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR(BP_LOCP_TMP, BP_LOCP_START, ADDRESS) \
587 for (BP_LOCP_START = BP_LOCP_START == NULL ? get_first_locp_gte_addr (ADDRESS) : BP_LOCP_START, \
588 BP_LOCP_TMP = BP_LOCP_START; \
589 BP_LOCP_START \
590 && (BP_LOCP_TMP < bp_location + bp_location_count \
591 && (*BP_LOCP_TMP)->address == ADDRESS); \
592 BP_LOCP_TMP++)
593
594/* Iterator for tracepoints only. */
595
596#define ALL_TRACEPOINTS(B) \
597 for (B = breakpoint_chain; B; B = B->next) \
598 if (is_tracepoint (B))
599
600/* Chains of all breakpoints defined. */
601
602struct breakpoint *breakpoint_chain;
603
604/* Array is sorted by bp_location_compare - primarily by the ADDRESS. */
605
606static struct bp_location **bp_location;
607
608/* Number of elements of BP_LOCATION. */
609
610static unsigned bp_location_count;
611
612/* Maximum alignment offset between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS and
613 ADDRESS for the current elements of BP_LOCATION which get a valid
614 result from bp_location_has_shadow. You can use it for roughly
615 limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to scan for shadow bytes for
616 an address you need to read. */
617
618static CORE_ADDR bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max;
619
620/* Maximum offset plus alignment between bp_target_info.PLACED_ADDRESS
621 + bp_target_info.SHADOW_LEN and ADDRESS for the current elements of
622 BP_LOCATION which get a valid result from bp_location_has_shadow.
623 You can use it for roughly limiting the subrange of BP_LOCATION to
624 scan for shadow bytes for an address you need to read. */
625
626static CORE_ADDR bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max;
627
628/* The locations that no longer correspond to any breakpoint, unlinked
629 from bp_location array, but for which a hit may still be reported
630 by a target. */
631VEC(bp_location_p) *moribund_locations = NULL;
632
633/* Number of last breakpoint made. */
634
635static int breakpoint_count;
636
637/* The value of `breakpoint_count' before the last command that
638 created breakpoints. If the last (break-like) command created more
639 than one breakpoint, then the difference between BREAKPOINT_COUNT
640 and PREV_BREAKPOINT_COUNT is more than one. */
641static int prev_breakpoint_count;
642
643/* Number of last tracepoint made. */
644
645static int tracepoint_count;
646
647static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_set_cmdlist;
648static struct cmd_list_element *breakpoint_show_cmdlist;
649struct cmd_list_element *save_cmdlist;
650
651/* Return whether a breakpoint is an active enabled breakpoint. */
652static int
653breakpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *b)
654{
655 return (b->enable_state == bp_enabled);
656}
657
658/* Set breakpoint count to NUM. */
659
660static void
661set_breakpoint_count (int num)
662{
663 prev_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
664 breakpoint_count = num;
665 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("bpnum"), num);
666}
667
668/* Used by `start_rbreak_breakpoints' below, to record the current
669 breakpoint count before "rbreak" creates any breakpoint. */
670static int rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
671
672/* Called at the start an "rbreak" command to record the first
673 breakpoint made. */
674
675void
676start_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
677{
678 rbreak_start_breakpoint_count = breakpoint_count;
679}
680
681/* Called at the end of an "rbreak" command to record the last
682 breakpoint made. */
683
684void
685end_rbreak_breakpoints (void)
686{
687 prev_breakpoint_count = rbreak_start_breakpoint_count;
688}
689
690/* Used in run_command to zero the hit count when a new run starts. */
691
692void
693clear_breakpoint_hit_counts (void)
694{
695 struct breakpoint *b;
696
697 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
698 b->hit_count = 0;
699}
700
701/* Allocate a new counted_command_line with reference count of 1.
702 The new structure owns COMMANDS. */
703
704static struct counted_command_line *
705alloc_counted_command_line (struct command_line *commands)
706{
707 struct counted_command_line *result
708 = xmalloc (sizeof (struct counted_command_line));
709
710 result->refc = 1;
711 result->commands = commands;
712 return result;
713}
714
715/* Increment reference count. This does nothing if CMD is NULL. */
716
717static void
718incref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line *cmd)
719{
720 if (cmd)
721 ++cmd->refc;
722}
723
724/* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
725 destroy the counted_command_line. Sets *CMDP to NULL. This does
726 nothing if *CMDP is NULL. */
727
728static void
729decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
730{
731 if (*cmdp)
732 {
733 if (--(*cmdp)->refc == 0)
734 {
735 free_command_lines (&(*cmdp)->commands);
736 xfree (*cmdp);
737 }
738 *cmdp = NULL;
739 }
740}
741
742/* A cleanup function that calls decref_counted_command_line. */
743
744static void
745do_cleanup_counted_command_line (void *arg)
746{
747 decref_counted_command_line (arg);
748}
749
750/* Create a cleanup that calls decref_counted_command_line on the
751 argument. */
752
753static struct cleanup *
754make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (struct counted_command_line **cmdp)
755{
756 return make_cleanup (do_cleanup_counted_command_line, cmdp);
757}
758
759\f
760/* Return the breakpoint with the specified number, or NULL
761 if the number does not refer to an existing breakpoint. */
762
763struct breakpoint *
764get_breakpoint (int num)
765{
766 struct breakpoint *b;
767
768 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
769 if (b->number == num)
770 return b;
771
772 return NULL;
773}
774
775\f
776
777/* Mark locations as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
778 evaluating conditions on its side. */
779
780static void
781mark_breakpoint_modified (struct breakpoint *b)
782{
783 struct bp_location *loc;
784
785 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
786 evaluating conditions and if the user has
787 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
788 side. */
789 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
790 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
791 return;
792
793 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
794 return;
795
796 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
797 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
798}
799
800/* Mark location as "conditions have changed" in case the target supports
801 evaluating conditions on its side. */
802
803static void
804mark_breakpoint_location_modified (struct bp_location *loc)
805{
806 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
807 evaluating conditions and if the user has
808 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
809 side. */
810 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
811 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
812
813 return;
814
815 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner))
816 return;
817
818 loc->condition_changed = condition_modified;
819}
820
821/* Sets the condition-evaluation mode using the static global
822 condition_evaluation_mode. */
823
824static void
825set_condition_evaluation_mode (char *args, int from_tty,
826 struct cmd_list_element *c)
827{
828 const char *old_mode, *new_mode;
829
830 if ((condition_evaluation_mode_1 == condition_evaluation_target)
831 && !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
832 {
833 condition_evaluation_mode_1 = condition_evaluation_mode;
834 warning (_("Target does not support breakpoint condition evaluation.\n"
835 "Using host evaluation mode instead."));
836 return;
837 }
838
839 new_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode_1);
840 old_mode = translate_condition_evaluation_mode (condition_evaluation_mode);
841
842 /* Flip the switch. Flip it even if OLD_MODE == NEW_MODE as one of the
843 settings was "auto". */
844 condition_evaluation_mode = condition_evaluation_mode_1;
845
846 /* Only update the mode if the user picked a different one. */
847 if (new_mode != old_mode)
848 {
849 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
850 /* If the user switched to a different evaluation mode, we
851 need to synch the changes with the target as follows:
852
853 "host" -> "target": Send all (valid) conditions to the target.
854 "target" -> "host": Remove all the conditions from the target.
855 */
856
857 if (new_mode == condition_evaluation_target)
858 {
859 /* Mark everything modified and synch conditions with the
860 target. */
861 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
862 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
863 }
864 else
865 {
866 /* Manually mark non-duplicate locations to synch conditions
867 with the target. We do this to remove all the conditions the
868 target knows about. */
869 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
870 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->inserted)
871 loc->needs_update = 1;
872 }
873
874 /* Do the update. */
875 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
876 }
877
878 return;
879}
880
881/* Shows the current mode of breakpoint condition evaluation. Explicitly shows
882 what "auto" is translating to. */
883
884static void
885show_condition_evaluation_mode (struct ui_file *file, int from_tty,
886 struct cmd_list_element *c, const char *value)
887{
888 if (condition_evaluation_mode == condition_evaluation_auto)
889 fprintf_filtered (file,
890 _("Breakpoint condition evaluation "
891 "mode is %s (currently %s).\n"),
892 value,
893 breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ());
894 else
895 fprintf_filtered (file, _("Breakpoint condition evaluation mode is %s.\n"),
896 value);
897}
898
899/* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP that is used by
900 bsearch. This comparison function only cares about addresses, unlike
901 the more general bp_location_compare function. */
902
903static int
904bp_location_compare_addrs (const void *ap, const void *bp)
905{
906 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
907 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
908
909 if (a->address == b->address)
910 return 0;
911 else
912 return ((a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address));
913}
914
915/* Helper function to skip all bp_locations with addresses
916 less than ADDRESS. It returns the first bp_location that
917 is greater than or equal to ADDRESS. If none is found, just
918 return NULL. */
919
920static struct bp_location **
921get_first_locp_gte_addr (CORE_ADDR address)
922{
923 struct bp_location dummy_loc;
924 struct bp_location *dummy_locp = &dummy_loc;
925 struct bp_location **locp_found = NULL;
926
927 /* Initialize the dummy location's address field. */
928 memset (&dummy_loc, 0, sizeof (struct bp_location));
929 dummy_loc.address = address;
930
931 /* Find a close match to the first location at ADDRESS. */
932 locp_found = bsearch (&dummy_locp, bp_location, bp_location_count,
933 sizeof (struct bp_location **),
934 bp_location_compare_addrs);
935
936 /* Nothing was found, nothing left to do. */
937 if (locp_found == NULL)
938 return NULL;
939
940 /* We may have found a location that is at ADDRESS but is not the first in the
941 location's list. Go backwards (if possible) and locate the first one. */
942 while ((locp_found - 1) >= bp_location
943 && (*(locp_found - 1))->address == address)
944 locp_found--;
945
946 return locp_found;
947}
948
949void
950set_breakpoint_condition (struct breakpoint *b, char *exp,
951 int from_tty)
952{
953 xfree (b->cond_string);
954 b->cond_string = NULL;
955
956 if (is_watchpoint (b))
957 {
958 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
959
960 xfree (w->cond_exp);
961 w->cond_exp = NULL;
962 }
963 else
964 {
965 struct bp_location *loc;
966
967 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
968 {
969 xfree (loc->cond);
970 loc->cond = NULL;
971
972 /* No need to free the condition agent expression
973 bytecode (if we have one). We will handle this
974 when we go through update_global_location_list. */
975 }
976 }
977
978 if (*exp == 0)
979 {
980 if (from_tty)
981 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint %d now unconditional.\n"), b->number);
982 }
983 else
984 {
985 const char *arg = exp;
986
987 /* I don't know if it matters whether this is the string the user
988 typed in or the decompiled expression. */
989 b->cond_string = xstrdup (arg);
990 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
991
992 if (is_watchpoint (b))
993 {
994 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
995
996 innermost_block = NULL;
997 arg = exp;
998 w->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
999 if (*arg)
1000 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
1001 w->cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
1002 }
1003 else
1004 {
1005 struct bp_location *loc;
1006
1007 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1008 {
1009 arg = exp;
1010 loc->cond =
1011 parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
1012 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
1013 if (*arg)
1014 error (_("Junk at end of expression"));
1015 }
1016 }
1017 }
1018 mark_breakpoint_modified (b);
1019
1020 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1021}
1022
1023/* Completion for the "condition" command. */
1024
1025static VEC (char_ptr) *
1026condition_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
1027 const char *text, const char *word)
1028{
1029 const char *space;
1030
1031 text = skip_spaces_const (text);
1032 space = skip_to_space_const (text);
1033 if (*space == '\0')
1034 {
1035 int len;
1036 struct breakpoint *b;
1037 VEC (char_ptr) *result = NULL;
1038
1039 if (text[0] == '$')
1040 {
1041 /* We don't support completion of history indices. */
1042 if (isdigit (text[1]))
1043 return NULL;
1044 return complete_internalvar (&text[1]);
1045 }
1046
1047 /* We're completing the breakpoint number. */
1048 len = strlen (text);
1049
1050 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1051 {
1052 char number[50];
1053
1054 xsnprintf (number, sizeof (number), "%d", b->number);
1055
1056 if (strncmp (number, text, len) == 0)
1057 VEC_safe_push (char_ptr, result, xstrdup (number));
1058 }
1059
1060 return result;
1061 }
1062
1063 /* We're completing the expression part. */
1064 text = skip_spaces_const (space);
1065 return expression_completer (cmd, text, word);
1066}
1067
1068/* condition N EXP -- set break condition of breakpoint N to EXP. */
1069
1070static void
1071condition_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1072{
1073 struct breakpoint *b;
1074 char *p;
1075 int bnum;
1076
1077 if (arg == 0)
1078 error_no_arg (_("breakpoint number"));
1079
1080 p = arg;
1081 bnum = get_number (&p);
1082 if (bnum == 0)
1083 error (_("Bad breakpoint argument: '%s'"), arg);
1084
1085 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1086 if (b->number == bnum)
1087 {
1088 /* Check if this breakpoint has a "stop" method implemented in an
1089 extension language. This method and conditions entered into GDB
1090 from the CLI are mutually exclusive. */
1091 const struct extension_language_defn *extlang
1092 = get_breakpoint_cond_ext_lang (b, EXT_LANG_NONE);
1093
1094 if (extlang != NULL)
1095 {
1096 error (_("Only one stop condition allowed. There is currently"
1097 " a %s stop condition defined for this breakpoint."),
1098 ext_lang_capitalized_name (extlang));
1099 }
1100 set_breakpoint_condition (b, p, from_tty);
1101
1102 if (is_breakpoint (b))
1103 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
1104
1105 return;
1106 }
1107
1108 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bnum);
1109}
1110
1111/* Check that COMMAND do not contain commands that are suitable
1112 only for tracepoints and not suitable for ordinary breakpoints.
1113 Throw if any such commands is found. */
1114
1115static void
1116check_no_tracepoint_commands (struct command_line *commands)
1117{
1118 struct command_line *c;
1119
1120 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1121 {
1122 int i;
1123
1124 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1125 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command can "
1126 "only be used for tracepoints"));
1127
1128 for (i = 0; i < c->body_count; ++i)
1129 check_no_tracepoint_commands ((c->body_list)[i]);
1130
1131 /* Not that command parsing removes leading whitespace and comment
1132 lines and also empty lines. So, we only need to check for
1133 command directly. */
1134 if (strstr (c->line, "collect ") == c->line)
1135 error (_("The 'collect' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1136
1137 if (strstr (c->line, "teval ") == c->line)
1138 error (_("The 'teval' command can only be used for tracepoints"));
1139 }
1140}
1141
1142/* Encapsulate tests for different types of tracepoints. */
1143
1144static int
1145is_tracepoint_type (enum bptype type)
1146{
1147 return (type == bp_tracepoint
1148 || type == bp_fast_tracepoint
1149 || type == bp_static_tracepoint);
1150}
1151
1152int
1153is_tracepoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
1154{
1155 return is_tracepoint_type (b->type);
1156}
1157
1158/* A helper function that validates that COMMANDS are valid for a
1159 breakpoint. This function will throw an exception if a problem is
1160 found. */
1161
1162static void
1163validate_commands_for_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
1164 struct command_line *commands)
1165{
1166 if (is_tracepoint (b))
1167 {
1168 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
1169 struct command_line *c;
1170 struct command_line *while_stepping = 0;
1171
1172 /* Reset the while-stepping step count. The previous commands
1173 might have included a while-stepping action, while the new
1174 ones might not. */
1175 t->step_count = 0;
1176
1177 /* We need to verify that each top-level element of commands is
1178 valid for tracepoints, that there's at most one
1179 while-stepping element, and that the while-stepping's body
1180 has valid tracing commands excluding nested while-stepping.
1181 We also need to validate the tracepoint action line in the
1182 context of the tracepoint --- validate_actionline actually
1183 has side effects, like setting the tracepoint's
1184 while-stepping STEP_COUNT, in addition to checking if the
1185 collect/teval actions parse and make sense in the
1186 tracepoint's context. */
1187 for (c = commands; c; c = c->next)
1188 {
1189 if (c->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1190 {
1191 if (b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
1192 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1193 "cannot be used for fast tracepoint"));
1194 else if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1195 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1196 "cannot be used for static tracepoint"));
1197
1198 if (while_stepping)
1199 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command "
1200 "can be used only once"));
1201 else
1202 while_stepping = c;
1203 }
1204
1205 validate_actionline (c->line, b);
1206 }
1207 if (while_stepping)
1208 {
1209 struct command_line *c2;
1210
1211 gdb_assert (while_stepping->body_count == 1);
1212 c2 = while_stepping->body_list[0];
1213 for (; c2; c2 = c2->next)
1214 {
1215 if (c2->control_type == while_stepping_control)
1216 error (_("The 'while-stepping' command cannot be nested"));
1217 }
1218 }
1219 }
1220 else
1221 {
1222 check_no_tracepoint_commands (commands);
1223 }
1224}
1225
1226/* Return a vector of all the static tracepoints set at ADDR. The
1227 caller is responsible for releasing the vector. */
1228
1229VEC(breakpoint_p) *
1230static_tracepoints_here (CORE_ADDR addr)
1231{
1232 struct breakpoint *b;
1233 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
1234 struct bp_location *loc;
1235
1236 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
1237 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
1238 {
1239 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
1240 if (loc->address == addr)
1241 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
1242 }
1243
1244 return found;
1245}
1246
1247/* Set the command list of B to COMMANDS. If breakpoint is tracepoint,
1248 validate that only allowed commands are included. */
1249
1250void
1251breakpoint_set_commands (struct breakpoint *b,
1252 struct command_line *commands)
1253{
1254 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, commands);
1255
1256 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1257 b->commands = alloc_counted_command_line (commands);
1258 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1259}
1260
1261/* Set the internal `silent' flag on the breakpoint. Note that this
1262 is not the same as the "silent" that may appear in the breakpoint's
1263 commands. */
1264
1265void
1266breakpoint_set_silent (struct breakpoint *b, int silent)
1267{
1268 int old_silent = b->silent;
1269
1270 b->silent = silent;
1271 if (old_silent != silent)
1272 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1273}
1274
1275/* Set the thread for this breakpoint. If THREAD is -1, make the
1276 breakpoint work for any thread. */
1277
1278void
1279breakpoint_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b, int thread)
1280{
1281 int old_thread = b->thread;
1282
1283 b->thread = thread;
1284 if (old_thread != thread)
1285 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1286}
1287
1288/* Set the task for this breakpoint. If TASK is 0, make the
1289 breakpoint work for any task. */
1290
1291void
1292breakpoint_set_task (struct breakpoint *b, int task)
1293{
1294 int old_task = b->task;
1295
1296 b->task = task;
1297 if (old_task != task)
1298 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1299}
1300
1301void
1302check_tracepoint_command (char *line, void *closure)
1303{
1304 struct breakpoint *b = closure;
1305
1306 validate_actionline (line, b);
1307}
1308
1309/* A structure used to pass information through
1310 map_breakpoint_numbers. */
1311
1312struct commands_info
1313{
1314 /* True if the command was typed at a tty. */
1315 int from_tty;
1316
1317 /* The breakpoint range spec. */
1318 char *arg;
1319
1320 /* Non-NULL if the body of the commands are being read from this
1321 already-parsed command. */
1322 struct command_line *control;
1323
1324 /* The command lines read from the user, or NULL if they have not
1325 yet been read. */
1326 struct counted_command_line *cmd;
1327};
1328
1329/* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that sets the commands for
1330 commands_command. */
1331
1332static void
1333do_map_commands_command (struct breakpoint *b, void *data)
1334{
1335 struct commands_info *info = data;
1336
1337 if (info->cmd == NULL)
1338 {
1339 struct command_line *l;
1340
1341 if (info->control != NULL)
1342 l = copy_command_lines (info->control->body_list[0]);
1343 else
1344 {
1345 struct cleanup *old_chain;
1346 char *str;
1347
1348 str = xstrprintf (_("Type commands for breakpoint(s) "
1349 "%s, one per line."),
1350 info->arg);
1351
1352 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, str);
1353
1354 l = read_command_lines (str,
1355 info->from_tty, 1,
1356 (is_tracepoint (b)
1357 ? check_tracepoint_command : 0),
1358 b);
1359
1360 do_cleanups (old_chain);
1361 }
1362
1363 info->cmd = alloc_counted_command_line (l);
1364 }
1365
1366 /* If a breakpoint was on the list more than once, we don't need to
1367 do anything. */
1368 if (b->commands != info->cmd)
1369 {
1370 validate_commands_for_breakpoint (b, info->cmd->commands);
1371 incref_counted_command_line (info->cmd);
1372 decref_counted_command_line (&b->commands);
1373 b->commands = info->cmd;
1374 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
1375 }
1376}
1377
1378static void
1379commands_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
1380 struct command_line *control)
1381{
1382 struct cleanup *cleanups;
1383 struct commands_info info;
1384
1385 info.from_tty = from_tty;
1386 info.control = control;
1387 info.cmd = NULL;
1388 /* If we read command lines from the user, then `info' will hold an
1389 extra reference to the commands that we must clean up. */
1390 cleanups = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&info.cmd);
1391
1392 if (arg == NULL || !*arg)
1393 {
1394 if (breakpoint_count - prev_breakpoint_count > 1)
1395 arg = xstrprintf ("%d-%d", prev_breakpoint_count + 1,
1396 breakpoint_count);
1397 else if (breakpoint_count > 0)
1398 arg = xstrprintf ("%d", breakpoint_count);
1399 else
1400 {
1401 /* So that we don't try to free the incoming non-NULL
1402 argument in the cleanup below. Mapping breakpoint
1403 numbers will fail in this case. */
1404 arg = NULL;
1405 }
1406 }
1407 else
1408 /* The command loop has some static state, so we need to preserve
1409 our argument. */
1410 arg = xstrdup (arg);
1411
1412 if (arg != NULL)
1413 make_cleanup (xfree, arg);
1414
1415 info.arg = arg;
1416
1417 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_commands_command, &info);
1418
1419 if (info.cmd == NULL)
1420 error (_("No breakpoints specified."));
1421
1422 do_cleanups (cleanups);
1423}
1424
1425static void
1426commands_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
1427{
1428 commands_command_1 (arg, from_tty, NULL);
1429}
1430
1431/* Like commands_command, but instead of reading the commands from
1432 input stream, takes them from an already parsed command structure.
1433
1434 This is used by cli-script.c to DTRT with breakpoint commands
1435 that are part of if and while bodies. */
1436enum command_control_type
1437commands_from_control_command (char *arg, struct command_line *cmd)
1438{
1439 commands_command_1 (arg, 0, cmd);
1440 return simple_control;
1441}
1442
1443/* Return non-zero if BL->TARGET_INFO contains valid information. */
1444
1445static int
1446bp_location_has_shadow (struct bp_location *bl)
1447{
1448 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
1449 return 0;
1450 if (!bl->inserted)
1451 return 0;
1452 if (bl->target_info.shadow_len == 0)
1453 /* BL isn't valid, or doesn't shadow memory. */
1454 return 0;
1455 return 1;
1456}
1457
1458/* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address
1459 MEMADDR, by replacing a memory breakpoint with its shadowed
1460 contents.
1461
1462 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with the of
1463 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffer. Otherwise, a
1464 failed assertion internal error will be raised. */
1465
1466static void
1467one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1468 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1469 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len,
1470 struct bp_target_info *target_info,
1471 struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
1472{
1473 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1474 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1475 int bp_size = 0;
1476 int bptoffset = 0;
1477
1478 if (!breakpoint_address_match (target_info->placed_address_space, 0,
1479 current_program_space->aspace, 0))
1480 {
1481 /* The breakpoint is inserted in a different address space. */
1482 return;
1483 }
1484
1485 /* Addresses and length of the part of the breakpoint that
1486 we need to copy. */
1487 bp_addr = target_info->placed_address;
1488 bp_size = target_info->shadow_len;
1489
1490 if (bp_addr + bp_size <= memaddr)
1491 {
1492 /* The breakpoint is entirely before the chunk of memory we are
1493 reading. */
1494 return;
1495 }
1496
1497 if (bp_addr >= memaddr + len)
1498 {
1499 /* The breakpoint is entirely after the chunk of memory we are
1500 reading. */
1501 return;
1502 }
1503
1504 /* Offset within shadow_contents. */
1505 if (bp_addr < memaddr)
1506 {
1507 /* Only copy the second part of the breakpoint. */
1508 bp_size -= memaddr - bp_addr;
1509 bptoffset = memaddr - bp_addr;
1510 bp_addr = memaddr;
1511 }
1512
1513 if (bp_addr + bp_size > memaddr + len)
1514 {
1515 /* Only copy the first part of the breakpoint. */
1516 bp_size -= (bp_addr + bp_size) - (memaddr + len);
1517 }
1518
1519 if (readbuf != NULL)
1520 {
1521 /* Verify that the readbuf buffer does not overlap with the
1522 shadow_contents buffer. */
1523 gdb_assert (target_info->shadow_contents >= readbuf + len
1524 || readbuf >= (target_info->shadow_contents
1525 + target_info->shadow_len));
1526
1527 /* Update the read buffer with this inserted breakpoint's
1528 shadow. */
1529 memcpy (readbuf + bp_addr - memaddr,
1530 target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset, bp_size);
1531 }
1532 else
1533 {
1534 const unsigned char *bp;
1535 CORE_ADDR addr = target_info->reqstd_address;
1536 int placed_size;
1537
1538 /* Update the shadow with what we want to write to memory. */
1539 memcpy (target_info->shadow_contents + bptoffset,
1540 writebuf_org + bp_addr - memaddr, bp_size);
1541
1542 /* Determine appropriate breakpoint contents and size for this
1543 address. */
1544 bp = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (gdbarch, &addr, &placed_size);
1545
1546 /* Update the final write buffer with this inserted
1547 breakpoint's INSN. */
1548 memcpy (writebuf + bp_addr - memaddr, bp + bptoffset, bp_size);
1549 }
1550}
1551
1552/* Update BUF, which is LEN bytes read from the target address MEMADDR,
1553 by replacing any memory breakpoints with their shadowed contents.
1554
1555 If READBUF is not NULL, this buffer must not overlap with any of
1556 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents buffers. Otherwise,
1557 a failed assertion internal error will be raised.
1558
1559 The range of shadowed area by each bp_location is:
1560 bl->address - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1561 up to bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1562 The range we were requested to resolve shadows for is:
1563 memaddr ... memaddr + len
1564 Thus the safe cutoff boundaries for performance optimization are
1565 memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1566 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
1567 and:
1568 bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max <= memaddr */
1569
1570void
1571breakpoint_xfer_memory (gdb_byte *readbuf, gdb_byte *writebuf,
1572 const gdb_byte *writebuf_org,
1573 ULONGEST memaddr, LONGEST len)
1574{
1575 /* Left boundary, right boundary and median element of our binary
1576 search. */
1577 unsigned bc_l, bc_r, bc;
1578 size_t i;
1579
1580 /* Find BC_L which is a leftmost element which may affect BUF
1581 content. It is safe to report lower value but a failure to
1582 report higher one. */
1583
1584 bc_l = 0;
1585 bc_r = bp_location_count;
1586 while (bc_l + 1 < bc_r)
1587 {
1588 struct bp_location *bl;
1589
1590 bc = (bc_l + bc_r) / 2;
1591 bl = bp_location[bc];
1592
1593 /* Check first BL->ADDRESS will not overflow due to the added
1594 constant. Then advance the left boundary only if we are sure
1595 the BC element can in no way affect the BUF content (MEMADDR
1596 to MEMADDR + LEN range).
1597
1598 Use the BP_LOCATION_SHADOW_LEN_AFTER_ADDRESS_MAX safety
1599 offset so that we cannot miss a breakpoint with its shadow
1600 range tail still reaching MEMADDR. */
1601
1602 if ((bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1603 >= bl->address)
1604 && (bl->address + bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max
1605 <= memaddr))
1606 bc_l = bc;
1607 else
1608 bc_r = bc;
1609 }
1610
1611 /* Due to the binary search above, we need to make sure we pick the
1612 first location that's at BC_L's address. E.g., if there are
1613 multiple locations at the same address, BC_L may end up pointing
1614 at a duplicate location, and miss the "master"/"inserted"
1615 location. Say, given locations L1, L2 and L3 at addresses A and
1616 B:
1617
1618 L1@A, L2@A, L3@B, ...
1619
1620 BC_L could end up pointing at location L2, while the "master"
1621 location could be L1. Since the `loc->inserted' flag is only set
1622 on "master" locations, we'd forget to restore the shadow of L1
1623 and L2. */
1624 while (bc_l > 0
1625 && bp_location[bc_l]->address == bp_location[bc_l - 1]->address)
1626 bc_l--;
1627
1628 /* Now do full processing of the found relevant range of elements. */
1629
1630 for (bc = bc_l; bc < bp_location_count; bc++)
1631 {
1632 struct bp_location *bl = bp_location[bc];
1633 CORE_ADDR bp_addr = 0;
1634 int bp_size = 0;
1635 int bptoffset = 0;
1636
1637 /* bp_location array has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
1638 if (bl->owner->type == bp_none)
1639 warning (_("reading through apparently deleted breakpoint #%d?"),
1640 bl->owner->number);
1641
1642 /* Performance optimization: any further element can no longer affect BUF
1643 content. */
1644
1645 if (bl->address >= bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max
1646 && memaddr + len <= (bl->address
1647 - bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max))
1648 break;
1649
1650 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
1651 continue;
1652
1653 one_breakpoint_xfer_memory (readbuf, writebuf, writebuf_org,
1654 memaddr, len, &bl->target_info, bl->gdbarch);
1655 }
1656}
1657
1658\f
1659
1660/* Return true if BPT is either a software breakpoint or a hardware
1661 breakpoint. */
1662
1663int
1664is_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1665{
1666 return (bpt->type == bp_breakpoint
1667 || bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
1668 || bpt->type == bp_dprintf);
1669}
1670
1671/* Return true if BPT is of any hardware watchpoint kind. */
1672
1673static int
1674is_hardware_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1675{
1676 return (bpt->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
1677 || bpt->type == bp_read_watchpoint
1678 || bpt->type == bp_access_watchpoint);
1679}
1680
1681/* Return true if BPT is of any watchpoint kind, hardware or
1682 software. */
1683
1684int
1685is_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *bpt)
1686{
1687 return (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt)
1688 || bpt->type == bp_watchpoint);
1689}
1690
1691/* Returns true if the current thread and its running state are safe
1692 to evaluate or update watchpoint B. Watchpoints on local
1693 expressions need to be evaluated in the context of the thread that
1694 was current when the watchpoint was created, and, that thread needs
1695 to be stopped to be able to select the correct frame context.
1696 Watchpoints on global expressions can be evaluated on any thread,
1697 and in any state. It is presently left to the target allowing
1698 memory accesses when threads are running. */
1699
1700static int
1701watchpoint_in_thread_scope (struct watchpoint *b)
1702{
1703 return (b->base.pspace == current_program_space
1704 && (ptid_equal (b->watchpoint_thread, null_ptid)
1705 || (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, b->watchpoint_thread)
1706 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))));
1707}
1708
1709/* Set watchpoint B to disp_del_at_next_stop, even including its possible
1710 associated bp_watchpoint_scope breakpoint. */
1711
1712static void
1713watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (struct watchpoint *w)
1714{
1715 struct breakpoint *b = &w->base;
1716
1717 if (b->related_breakpoint != b)
1718 {
1719 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope);
1720 gdb_assert (b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint == b);
1721 b->related_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1722 b->related_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b->related_breakpoint;
1723 b->related_breakpoint = b;
1724 }
1725 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
1726}
1727
1728/* Extract a bitfield value from value VAL using the bit parameters contained in
1729 watchpoint W. */
1730
1731static struct value *
1732extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (struct watchpoint *w, struct value *val)
1733{
1734 struct value *bit_val;
1735
1736 if (val == NULL)
1737 return NULL;
1738
1739 bit_val = allocate_value (value_type (val));
1740
1741 unpack_value_bitfield (bit_val,
1742 w->val_bitpos,
1743 w->val_bitsize,
1744 value_contents_for_printing (val),
1745 value_offset (val),
1746 val);
1747
1748 return bit_val;
1749}
1750
1751/* Assuming that B is a watchpoint:
1752 - Reparse watchpoint expression, if REPARSE is non-zero
1753 - Evaluate expression and store the result in B->val
1754 - Evaluate the condition if there is one, and store the result
1755 in b->loc->cond.
1756 - Update the list of values that must be watched in B->loc.
1757
1758 If the watchpoint disposition is disp_del_at_next_stop, then do
1759 nothing. If this is local watchpoint that is out of scope, delete
1760 it.
1761
1762 Even with `set breakpoint always-inserted on' the watchpoints are
1763 removed + inserted on each stop here. Normal breakpoints must
1764 never be removed because they might be missed by a running thread
1765 when debugging in non-stop mode. On the other hand, hardware
1766 watchpoints (is_hardware_watchpoint; processed here) are specific
1767 to each LWP since they are stored in each LWP's hardware debug
1768 registers. Therefore, such LWP must be stopped first in order to
1769 be able to modify its hardware watchpoints.
1770
1771 Hardware watchpoints must be reset exactly once after being
1772 presented to the user. It cannot be done sooner, because it would
1773 reset the data used to present the watchpoint hit to the user. And
1774 it must not be done later because it could display the same single
1775 watchpoint hit during multiple GDB stops. Note that the latter is
1776 relevant only to the hardware watchpoint types bp_read_watchpoint
1777 and bp_access_watchpoint. False hit by bp_hardware_watchpoint is
1778 not user-visible - its hit is suppressed if the memory content has
1779 not changed.
1780
1781 The following constraints influence the location where we can reset
1782 hardware watchpoints:
1783
1784 * target_stopped_by_watchpoint and target_stopped_data_address are
1785 called several times when GDB stops.
1786
1787 [linux]
1788 * Multiple hardware watchpoints can be hit at the same time,
1789 causing GDB to stop. GDB only presents one hardware watchpoint
1790 hit at a time as the reason for stopping, and all the other hits
1791 are presented later, one after the other, each time the user
1792 requests the execution to be resumed. Execution is not resumed
1793 for the threads still having pending hit event stored in
1794 LWP_INFO->STATUS. While the watchpoint is already removed from
1795 the inferior on the first stop the thread hit event is kept being
1796 reported from its cached value by linux_nat_stopped_data_address
1797 until the real thread resume happens after the watchpoint gets
1798 presented and thus its LWP_INFO->STATUS gets reset.
1799
1800 Therefore the hardware watchpoint hit can get safely reset on the
1801 watchpoint removal from inferior. */
1802
1803static void
1804update_watchpoint (struct watchpoint *b, int reparse)
1805{
1806 int within_current_scope;
1807 struct frame_id saved_frame_id;
1808 int frame_saved;
1809
1810 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
1811 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
1812 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
1813 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
1814 return;
1815
1816 if (b->base.disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
1817 return;
1818
1819 frame_saved = 0;
1820
1821 /* Determine if the watchpoint is within scope. */
1822 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
1823 within_current_scope = 1;
1824 else
1825 {
1826 struct frame_info *fi = get_current_frame ();
1827 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (fi);
1828 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (fi);
1829
1830 /* If we're in a function epilogue, unwinding may not work
1831 properly, so do not attempt to recreate locations at this
1832 point. See similar comments in watchpoint_check. */
1833 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
1834 return;
1835
1836 /* Save the current frame's ID so we can restore it after
1837 evaluating the watchpoint expression on its own frame. */
1838 /* FIXME drow/2003-09-09: It would be nice if evaluate_expression
1839 took a frame parameter, so that we didn't have to change the
1840 selected frame. */
1841 frame_saved = 1;
1842 saved_frame_id = get_frame_id (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1843
1844 fi = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
1845 within_current_scope = (fi != NULL);
1846 if (within_current_scope)
1847 select_frame (fi);
1848 }
1849
1850 /* We don't free locations. They are stored in the bp_location array
1851 and update_global_location_list will eventually delete them and
1852 remove breakpoints if needed. */
1853 b->base.loc = NULL;
1854
1855 if (within_current_scope && reparse)
1856 {
1857 const char *s;
1858
1859 if (b->exp)
1860 {
1861 xfree (b->exp);
1862 b->exp = NULL;
1863 }
1864 s = b->exp_string_reparse ? b->exp_string_reparse : b->exp_string;
1865 b->exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->exp_valid_block, 0);
1866 /* If the meaning of expression itself changed, the old value is
1867 no longer relevant. We don't want to report a watchpoint hit
1868 to the user when the old value and the new value may actually
1869 be completely different objects. */
1870 value_free (b->val);
1871 b->val = NULL;
1872 b->val_valid = 0;
1873
1874 /* Note that unlike with breakpoints, the watchpoint's condition
1875 expression is stored in the breakpoint object, not in the
1876 locations (re)created below. */
1877 if (b->base.cond_string != NULL)
1878 {
1879 if (b->cond_exp != NULL)
1880 {
1881 xfree (b->cond_exp);
1882 b->cond_exp = NULL;
1883 }
1884
1885 s = b->base.cond_string;
1886 b->cond_exp = parse_exp_1 (&s, 0, b->cond_exp_valid_block, 0);
1887 }
1888 }
1889
1890 /* If we failed to parse the expression, for example because
1891 it refers to a global variable in a not-yet-loaded shared library,
1892 don't try to insert watchpoint. We don't automatically delete
1893 such watchpoint, though, since failure to parse expression
1894 is different from out-of-scope watchpoint. */
1895 if (!target_has_execution)
1896 {
1897 /* Without execution, memory can't change. No use to try and
1898 set watchpoint locations. The watchpoint will be reset when
1899 the target gains execution, through breakpoint_re_set. */
1900 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
1901 {
1902 if (b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
1903 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
1904 else
1905 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
1906 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
1907 }
1908 }
1909 else if (within_current_scope && b->exp)
1910 {
1911 int pc = 0;
1912 struct value *val_chain, *v, *result, *next;
1913 struct program_space *frame_pspace;
1914
1915 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &v, &result, &val_chain, 0);
1916
1917 /* Avoid setting b->val if it's already set. The meaning of
1918 b->val is 'the last value' user saw, and we should update
1919 it only if we reported that last value to user. As it
1920 happens, the code that reports it updates b->val directly.
1921 We don't keep track of the memory value for masked
1922 watchpoints. */
1923 if (!b->val_valid && !is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
1924 {
1925 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
1926 {
1927 v = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, v);
1928 if (v != NULL)
1929 release_value (v);
1930 }
1931 b->val = v;
1932 b->val_valid = 1;
1933 }
1934
1935 frame_pspace = get_frame_program_space (get_selected_frame (NULL));
1936
1937 /* Look at each value on the value chain. */
1938 for (v = val_chain; v; v = value_next (v))
1939 {
1940 /* If it's a memory location, and GDB actually needed
1941 its contents to evaluate the expression, then we
1942 must watch it. If the first value returned is
1943 still lazy, that means an error occurred reading it;
1944 watch it anyway in case it becomes readable. */
1945 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory
1946 && (v == val_chain || ! value_lazy (v)))
1947 {
1948 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
1949
1950 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked
1951 for it explicitly, never if they just happen to
1952 appear in the middle of some value chain. */
1953 if (v == result
1954 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
1955 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
1956 {
1957 CORE_ADDR addr;
1958 int type;
1959 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
1960 int bitpos = 0, bitsize = 0;
1961
1962 if (value_bitsize (v) != 0)
1963 {
1964 /* Extract the bit parameters out from the bitfield
1965 sub-expression. */
1966 bitpos = value_bitpos (v);
1967 bitsize = value_bitsize (v);
1968 }
1969 else if (v == result && b->val_bitsize != 0)
1970 {
1971 /* If VAL_BITSIZE != 0 then RESULT is actually a bitfield
1972 lvalue whose bit parameters are saved in the fields
1973 VAL_BITPOS and VAL_BITSIZE. */
1974 bitpos = b->val_bitpos;
1975 bitsize = b->val_bitsize;
1976 }
1977
1978 addr = value_address (v);
1979 if (bitsize != 0)
1980 {
1981 /* Skip the bytes that don't contain the bitfield. */
1982 addr += bitpos / 8;
1983 }
1984
1985 type = hw_write;
1986 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
1987 type = hw_read;
1988 else if (b->base.type == bp_access_watchpoint)
1989 type = hw_access;
1990
1991 loc = allocate_bp_location (&b->base);
1992 for (tmp = &(b->base.loc); *tmp != NULL; tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
1993 ;
1994 *tmp = loc;
1995 loc->gdbarch = get_type_arch (value_type (v));
1996
1997 loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
1998 loc->address = addr;
1999
2000 if (bitsize != 0)
2001 {
2002 /* Just cover the bytes that make up the bitfield. */
2003 loc->length = ((bitpos % 8) + bitsize + 7) / 8;
2004 }
2005 else
2006 loc->length = TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
2007
2008 loc->watchpoint_type = type;
2009 }
2010 }
2011 }
2012
2013 /* Change the type of breakpoint between hardware assisted or
2014 an ordinary watchpoint depending on the hardware support
2015 and free hardware slots. REPARSE is set when the inferior
2016 is started. */
2017 if (reparse)
2018 {
2019 int reg_cnt;
2020 enum bp_loc_type loc_type;
2021 struct bp_location *bl;
2022
2023 reg_cnt = can_use_hardware_watchpoint (val_chain);
2024
2025 if (reg_cnt)
2026 {
2027 int i, target_resources_ok, other_type_used;
2028 enum bptype type;
2029
2030 /* Use an exact watchpoint when there's only one memory region to be
2031 watched, and only one debug register is needed to watch it. */
2032 b->exact = target_exact_watchpoints && reg_cnt == 1;
2033
2034 /* We need to determine how many resources are already
2035 used for all other hardware watchpoints plus this one
2036 to see if we still have enough resources to also fit
2037 this watchpoint in as well. */
2038
2039 /* If this is a software watchpoint, we try to turn it
2040 to a hardware one -- count resources as if B was of
2041 hardware watchpoint type. */
2042 type = b->base.type;
2043 if (type == bp_watchpoint)
2044 type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
2045
2046 /* This watchpoint may or may not have been placed on
2047 the list yet at this point (it won't be in the list
2048 if we're trying to create it for the first time,
2049 through watch_command), so always account for it
2050 manually. */
2051
2052 /* Count resources used by all watchpoints except B. */
2053 i = hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (&b->base, type, &other_type_used);
2054
2055 /* Add in the resources needed for B. */
2056 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (&b->base);
2057
2058 target_resources_ok
2059 = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (type, i, other_type_used);
2060 if (target_resources_ok <= 0)
2061 {
2062 int sw_mode = b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base);
2063
2064 if (target_resources_ok == 0 && !sw_mode)
2065 error (_("Target does not support this type of "
2066 "hardware watchpoint."));
2067 else if (target_resources_ok < 0 && !sw_mode)
2068 error (_("There are not enough available hardware "
2069 "resources for this watchpoint."));
2070
2071 /* Downgrade to software watchpoint. */
2072 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2073 }
2074 else
2075 {
2076 /* If this was a software watchpoint, we've just
2077 found we have enough resources to turn it to a
2078 hardware watchpoint. Otherwise, this is a
2079 nop. */
2080 b->base.type = type;
2081 }
2082 }
2083 else if (!b->base.ops->works_in_software_mode (&b->base))
2084 {
2085 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
2086 error (_("Can't set read/access watchpoint when "
2087 "hardware watchpoints are disabled."));
2088 else
2089 error (_("Expression cannot be implemented with "
2090 "read/access watchpoint."));
2091 }
2092 else
2093 b->base.type = bp_watchpoint;
2094
2095 loc_type = (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint? bp_loc_other
2096 : bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint);
2097 for (bl = b->base.loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
2098 bl->loc_type = loc_type;
2099 }
2100
2101 for (v = val_chain; v; v = next)
2102 {
2103 next = value_next (v);
2104 if (v != b->val)
2105 value_free (v);
2106 }
2107
2108 /* If a software watchpoint is not watching any memory, then the
2109 above left it without any location set up. But,
2110 bpstat_stop_status requires a location to be able to report
2111 stops, so make sure there's at least a dummy one. */
2112 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint && b->base.loc == NULL)
2113 {
2114 struct breakpoint *base = &b->base;
2115 base->loc = allocate_bp_location (base);
2116 base->loc->pspace = frame_pspace;
2117 base->loc->address = -1;
2118 base->loc->length = -1;
2119 base->loc->watchpoint_type = -1;
2120 }
2121 }
2122 else if (!within_current_scope)
2123 {
2124 printf_filtered (_("\
2125Watchpoint %d deleted because the program has left the block\n\
2126in which its expression is valid.\n"),
2127 b->base.number);
2128 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
2129 }
2130
2131 /* Restore the selected frame. */
2132 if (frame_saved)
2133 select_frame (frame_find_by_id (saved_frame_id));
2134}
2135
2136
2137/* Returns 1 iff breakpoint location should be
2138 inserted in the inferior. We don't differentiate the type of BL's owner
2139 (breakpoint vs. tracepoint), although insert_location in tracepoint's
2140 breakpoint_ops is not defined, because in insert_bp_location,
2141 tracepoint's insert_location will not be called. */
2142static int
2143should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2144{
2145 if (bl->owner == NULL || !breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner))
2146 return 0;
2147
2148 if (bl->owner->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
2149 return 0;
2150
2151 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled || bl->duplicate)
2152 return 0;
2153
2154 if (user_breakpoint_p (bl->owner) && bl->pspace->executing_startup)
2155 return 0;
2156
2157 /* This is set for example, when we're attached to the parent of a
2158 vfork, and have detached from the child. The child is running
2159 free, and we expect it to do an exec or exit, at which point the
2160 OS makes the parent schedulable again (and the target reports
2161 that the vfork is done). Until the child is done with the shared
2162 memory region, do not insert breakpoints in the parent, otherwise
2163 the child could still trip on the parent's breakpoints. Since
2164 the parent is blocked anyway, it won't miss any breakpoint. */
2165 if (bl->pspace->breakpoints_not_allowed)
2166 return 0;
2167
2168 /* Don't insert a breakpoint if we're trying to step past its
2169 location. */
2170 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2171 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2172 && stepping_past_instruction_at (bl->pspace->aspace,
2173 bl->address))
2174 {
2175 if (debug_infrun)
2176 {
2177 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2178 "infrun: skipping breakpoint: "
2179 "stepping past insn at: %s\n",
2180 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2181 }
2182 return 0;
2183 }
2184
2185 /* Don't insert watchpoints if we're trying to step past the
2186 instruction that triggered one. */
2187 if ((bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
2188 && stepping_past_nonsteppable_watchpoint ())
2189 {
2190 if (debug_infrun)
2191 {
2192 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog,
2193 "infrun: stepping past non-steppable watchpoint. "
2194 "skipping watchpoint at %s:%d\n",
2195 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
2196 bl->length);
2197 }
2198 return 0;
2199 }
2200
2201 return 1;
2202}
2203
2204/* Same as should_be_inserted but does the check assuming
2205 that the location is not duplicated. */
2206
2207static int
2208unduplicated_should_be_inserted (struct bp_location *bl)
2209{
2210 int result;
2211 const int save_duplicate = bl->duplicate;
2212
2213 bl->duplicate = 0;
2214 result = should_be_inserted (bl);
2215 bl->duplicate = save_duplicate;
2216 return result;
2217}
2218
2219/* Parses a conditional described by an expression COND into an
2220 agent expression bytecode suitable for evaluation
2221 by the bytecode interpreter. Return NULL if there was
2222 any error during parsing. */
2223
2224static struct agent_expr *
2225parse_cond_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, struct expression *cond)
2226{
2227 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2228 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
2229
2230 if (!cond)
2231 return NULL;
2232
2233 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2234 that may show up. */
2235 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2236 {
2237 aexpr = gen_eval_for_expr (scope, cond);
2238 }
2239
2240 if (ex.reason < 0)
2241 {
2242 /* If we got here, it means the condition could not be parsed to a valid
2243 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2244 It's no use iterating through the conditions. */
2245 return NULL;
2246 }
2247
2248 /* We have a valid agent expression. */
2249 return aexpr;
2250}
2251
2252/* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint conditions to be
2253 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with different
2254 conditions, we will add such conditions to the list. The idea is that the
2255 target will evaluate the list of conditions and will only notify GDB when
2256 one of them is true. */
2257
2258static void
2259build_target_condition_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2260{
2261 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2262 int null_condition_or_parse_error = 0;
2263 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2264 struct bp_location *loc;
2265
2266 /* Release conditions left over from a previous insert. */
2267 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions);
2268
2269 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
2270 evaluating conditions and if the user has
2271 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
2272 side. */
2273 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
2274 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
2275 return;
2276
2277 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2278 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2279 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2280 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2281 response back to GDB. */
2282 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2283 {
2284 loc = (*loc2p);
2285 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2286 {
2287 if (modified)
2288 {
2289 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2290
2291 /* Re-parse the conditions since something changed. In that
2292 case we already freed the condition bytecodes (see
2293 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2294 need to parse the condition to bytecodes again. */
2295 aexpr = parse_cond_to_aexpr (bl->address, loc->cond);
2296 loc->cond_bytecode = aexpr;
2297
2298 /* Check if we managed to parse the conditional expression
2299 correctly. If not, we will not send this condition
2300 to the target. */
2301 if (aexpr)
2302 continue;
2303 }
2304
2305 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2306 went wrong or we have a null condition expression. */
2307 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2308 {
2309 null_condition_or_parse_error = 1;
2310 break;
2311 }
2312 }
2313 }
2314
2315 /* If any of these happened, it means we will have to evaluate the conditions
2316 for the location's address on gdb's side. It is no use keeping bytecodes
2317 for all the other duplicate locations, thus we free all of them here.
2318
2319 This is so we have a finer control over which locations' conditions are
2320 being evaluated by GDB or the remote stub. */
2321 if (null_condition_or_parse_error)
2322 {
2323 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2324 {
2325 loc = (*loc2p);
2326 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2327 {
2328 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2329 located. */
2330 if (!loc->cond_bytecode)
2331 return;
2332
2333 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
2334 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
2335 }
2336 }
2337 }
2338
2339 /* No NULL conditions or failed bytecode generation. Build a condition list
2340 for this location's address. */
2341 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2342 {
2343 loc = (*loc2p);
2344 if (loc->cond
2345 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2346 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2347 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2348 && loc->enabled)
2349 /* Add the condition to the vector. This will be used later to send the
2350 conditions to the target. */
2351 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.conditions,
2352 loc->cond_bytecode);
2353 }
2354
2355 return;
2356}
2357
2358/* Parses a command described by string CMD into an agent expression
2359 bytecode suitable for evaluation by the bytecode interpreter.
2360 Return NULL if there was any error during parsing. */
2361
2362static struct agent_expr *
2363parse_cmd_to_aexpr (CORE_ADDR scope, char *cmd)
2364{
2365 struct cleanup *old_cleanups = 0;
2366 struct expression *expr, **argvec;
2367 struct agent_expr *aexpr = NULL;
2368 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
2369 const char *cmdrest;
2370 const char *format_start, *format_end;
2371 struct format_piece *fpieces;
2372 int nargs;
2373 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
2374
2375 if (!cmd)
2376 return NULL;
2377
2378 cmdrest = cmd;
2379
2380 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2381 ++cmdrest;
2382 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2383
2384 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2385 error (_("No format string following the location"));
2386
2387 format_start = cmdrest;
2388
2389 fpieces = parse_format_string (&cmdrest);
2390
2391 old_cleanups = make_cleanup (free_format_pieces_cleanup, &fpieces);
2392
2393 format_end = cmdrest;
2394
2395 if (*cmdrest++ != '"')
2396 error (_("Bad format string, non-terminated '\"'."));
2397
2398 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2399
2400 if (!(*cmdrest == ',' || *cmdrest == '\0'))
2401 error (_("Invalid argument syntax"));
2402
2403 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2404 cmdrest++;
2405 cmdrest = skip_spaces_const (cmdrest);
2406
2407 /* For each argument, make an expression. */
2408
2409 argvec = (struct expression **) alloca (strlen (cmd)
2410 * sizeof (struct expression *));
2411
2412 nargs = 0;
2413 while (*cmdrest != '\0')
2414 {
2415 const char *cmd1;
2416
2417 cmd1 = cmdrest;
2418 expr = parse_exp_1 (&cmd1, scope, block_for_pc (scope), 1);
2419 argvec[nargs++] = expr;
2420 cmdrest = cmd1;
2421 if (*cmdrest == ',')
2422 ++cmdrest;
2423 }
2424
2425 /* We don't want to stop processing, so catch any errors
2426 that may show up. */
2427 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
2428 {
2429 aexpr = gen_printf (scope, gdbarch, 0, 0,
2430 format_start, format_end - format_start,
2431 fpieces, nargs, argvec);
2432 }
2433
2434 do_cleanups (old_cleanups);
2435
2436 if (ex.reason < 0)
2437 {
2438 /* If we got here, it means the command could not be parsed to a valid
2439 bytecode expression and thus can't be evaluated on the target's side.
2440 It's no use iterating through the other commands. */
2441 return NULL;
2442 }
2443
2444 /* We have a valid agent expression, return it. */
2445 return aexpr;
2446}
2447
2448/* Based on location BL, create a list of breakpoint commands to be
2449 passed on to the target. If we have duplicated locations with
2450 different commands, we will add any such to the list. */
2451
2452static void
2453build_target_command_list (struct bp_location *bl)
2454{
2455 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
2456 int null_command_or_parse_error = 0;
2457 int modified = bl->needs_update;
2458 struct bp_location *loc;
2459
2460 /* Release commands left over from a previous insert. */
2461 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands);
2462
2463 if (!target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
2464 return;
2465
2466 /* For now, limit to agent-style dprintf breakpoints. */
2467 if (dprintf_style != dprintf_style_agent)
2468 return;
2469
2470 /* For now, if we have any duplicate location that isn't a dprintf,
2471 don't install the target-side commands, as that would make the
2472 breakpoint not be reported to the core, and we'd lose
2473 control. */
2474 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2475 {
2476 loc = (*loc2p);
2477 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2478 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2479 && loc->owner->type != bp_dprintf)
2480 return;
2481 }
2482
2483 /* Do a first pass to check for locations with no assigned
2484 conditions or conditions that fail to parse to a valid agent expression
2485 bytecode. If any of these happen, then it's no use to send conditions
2486 to the target since this location will always trigger and generate a
2487 response back to GDB. */
2488 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2489 {
2490 loc = (*loc2p);
2491 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2492 {
2493 if (modified)
2494 {
2495 struct agent_expr *aexpr;
2496
2497 /* Re-parse the commands since something changed. In that
2498 case we already freed the command bytecodes (see
2499 force_breakpoint_reinsertion). We just
2500 need to parse the command to bytecodes again. */
2501 aexpr = parse_cmd_to_aexpr (bl->address,
2502 loc->owner->extra_string);
2503 loc->cmd_bytecode = aexpr;
2504
2505 if (!aexpr)
2506 continue;
2507 }
2508
2509 /* If we have a NULL bytecode expression, it means something
2510 went wrong or we have a null command expression. */
2511 if (!loc->cmd_bytecode)
2512 {
2513 null_command_or_parse_error = 1;
2514 break;
2515 }
2516 }
2517 }
2518
2519 /* If anything failed, then we're not doing target-side commands,
2520 and so clean up. */
2521 if (null_command_or_parse_error)
2522 {
2523 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2524 {
2525 loc = (*loc2p);
2526 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2527 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num)
2528 {
2529 /* Only go as far as the first NULL bytecode is
2530 located. */
2531 if (loc->cmd_bytecode == NULL)
2532 return;
2533
2534 free_agent_expr (loc->cmd_bytecode);
2535 loc->cmd_bytecode = NULL;
2536 }
2537 }
2538 }
2539
2540 /* No NULL commands or failed bytecode generation. Build a command list
2541 for this location's address. */
2542 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, bl->address)
2543 {
2544 loc = (*loc2p);
2545 if (loc->owner->extra_string
2546 && is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
2547 && loc->pspace->num == bl->pspace->num
2548 && loc->owner->enable_state == bp_enabled
2549 && loc->enabled)
2550 /* Add the command to the vector. This will be used later
2551 to send the commands to the target. */
2552 VEC_safe_push (agent_expr_p, bl->target_info.tcommands,
2553 loc->cmd_bytecode);
2554 }
2555
2556 bl->target_info.persist = 0;
2557 /* Maybe flag this location as persistent. */
2558 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf && disconnected_dprintf)
2559 bl->target_info.persist = 1;
2560}
2561
2562/* Insert a low-level "breakpoint" of some type. BL is the breakpoint
2563 location. Any error messages are printed to TMP_ERROR_STREAM; and
2564 DISABLED_BREAKS, and HW_BREAKPOINT_ERROR are used to report problems.
2565 Returns 0 for success, 1 if the bp_location type is not supported or
2566 -1 for failure.
2567
2568 NOTE drow/2003-09-09: This routine could be broken down to an
2569 object-style method for each breakpoint or catchpoint type. */
2570static int
2571insert_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl,
2572 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream,
2573 int *disabled_breaks,
2574 int *hw_breakpoint_error,
2575 int *hw_bp_error_explained_already)
2576{
2577 enum errors bp_err = GDB_NO_ERROR;
2578 const char *bp_err_message = NULL;
2579 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
2580
2581 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
2582 return 0;
2583
2584 /* Note we don't initialize bl->target_info, as that wipes out
2585 the breakpoint location's shadow_contents if the breakpoint
2586 is still inserted at that location. This in turn breaks
2587 target_read_memory which depends on these buffers when
2588 a memory read is requested at the breakpoint location:
2589 Once the target_info has been wiped, we fail to see that
2590 we have a breakpoint inserted at that address and thus
2591 read the breakpoint instead of returning the data saved in
2592 the breakpoint location's shadow contents. */
2593 bl->target_info.reqstd_address = bl->address;
2594 bl->target_info.placed_address_space = bl->pspace->aspace;
2595 bl->target_info.length = bl->length;
2596
2597 /* When working with target-side conditions, we must pass all the conditions
2598 for the same breakpoint address down to the target since GDB will not
2599 insert those locations. With a list of breakpoint conditions, the target
2600 can decide when to stop and notify GDB. */
2601
2602 if (is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
2603 {
2604 build_target_condition_list (bl);
2605 build_target_command_list (bl);
2606 /* Reset the modification marker. */
2607 bl->needs_update = 0;
2608 }
2609
2610 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2611 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2612 {
2613 if (bl->owner->type != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
2614 {
2615 /* If the explicitly specified breakpoint type
2616 is not hardware breakpoint, check the memory map to see
2617 if the breakpoint address is in read only memory or not.
2618
2619 Two important cases are:
2620 - location type is not hardware breakpoint, memory
2621 is readonly. We change the type of the location to
2622 hardware breakpoint.
2623 - location type is hardware breakpoint, memory is
2624 read-write. This means we've previously made the
2625 location hardware one, but then the memory map changed,
2626 so we undo.
2627
2628 When breakpoints are removed, remove_breakpoints will use
2629 location types we've just set here, the only possible
2630 problem is that memory map has changed during running
2631 program, but it's not going to work anyway with current
2632 gdb. */
2633 struct mem_region *mr
2634 = lookup_mem_region (bl->target_info.reqstd_address);
2635
2636 if (mr)
2637 {
2638 if (automatic_hardware_breakpoints)
2639 {
2640 enum bp_loc_type new_type;
2641
2642 if (mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2643 new_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
2644 else
2645 new_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
2646
2647 if (new_type != bl->loc_type)
2648 {
2649 static int said = 0;
2650
2651 bl->loc_type = new_type;
2652 if (!said)
2653 {
2654 fprintf_filtered (gdb_stdout,
2655 _("Note: automatically using "
2656 "hardware breakpoints for "
2657 "read-only addresses.\n"));
2658 said = 1;
2659 }
2660 }
2661 }
2662 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2663 && mr->attrib.mode != MEM_RW)
2664 {
2665 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2666 _("Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2667 "Cannot set software breakpoint "
2668 "at read-only address %s\n"),
2669 bl->owner->number,
2670 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address));
2671 return 1;
2672 }
2673 }
2674 }
2675
2676 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
2677 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
2678 || bl->section == NULL
2679 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
2680 {
2681 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2682 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2683 {
2684 int val;
2685
2686 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2687 if (val)
2688 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2689 }
2690 if (e.reason < 0)
2691 {
2692 bp_err = e.error;
2693 bp_err_message = e.message;
2694 }
2695 }
2696 else
2697 {
2698 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
2699 Shall we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
2700 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
2701 {
2702 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active,
2703 so we must try to set a breakpoint at the LMA.
2704 This will not work for a hardware breakpoint. */
2705 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2706 warning (_("hardware breakpoint %d not supported in overlay!"),
2707 bl->owner->number);
2708 else
2709 {
2710 CORE_ADDR addr = overlay_unmapped_address (bl->address,
2711 bl->section);
2712 /* Set a software (trap) breakpoint at the LMA. */
2713 bl->overlay_target_info = bl->target_info;
2714 bl->overlay_target_info.reqstd_address = addr;
2715
2716 /* No overlay handling: just set the breakpoint. */
2717 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2718 {
2719 int val;
2720
2721 val = target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
2722 &bl->overlay_target_info);
2723 if (val)
2724 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2725 }
2726 if (e.reason < 0)
2727 {
2728 bp_err = e.error;
2729 bp_err_message = e.message;
2730 }
2731
2732 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2733 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2734 "Overlay breakpoint %d "
2735 "failed: in ROM?\n",
2736 bl->owner->number);
2737 }
2738 }
2739 /* Shall we set a breakpoint at the VMA? */
2740 if (section_is_mapped (bl->section))
2741 {
2742 /* Yes. This overlay section is mapped into memory. */
2743 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
2744 {
2745 int val;
2746
2747 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2748 if (val)
2749 bp_err = GENERIC_ERROR;
2750 }
2751 if (e.reason < 0)
2752 {
2753 bp_err = e.error;
2754 bp_err_message = e.message;
2755 }
2756 }
2757 else
2758 {
2759 /* No. This breakpoint will not be inserted.
2760 No error, but do not mark the bp as 'inserted'. */
2761 return 0;
2762 }
2763 }
2764
2765 if (bp_err != GDB_NO_ERROR)
2766 {
2767 /* Can't set the breakpoint. */
2768
2769 /* In some cases, we might not be able to insert a
2770 breakpoint in a shared library that has already been
2771 removed, but we have not yet processed the shlib unload
2772 event. Unfortunately, some targets that implement
2773 breakpoint insertion themselves can't tell why the
2774 breakpoint insertion failed (e.g., the remote target
2775 doesn't define error codes), so we must treat generic
2776 errors as memory errors. */
2777 if ((bp_err == GENERIC_ERROR || bp_err == MEMORY_ERROR)
2778 && bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
2779 && (solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
2780 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
2781 bl->address)))
2782 {
2783 /* See also: disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs. */
2784 bl->shlib_disabled = 1;
2785 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bl->owner);
2786 if (!*disabled_breaks)
2787 {
2788 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2789 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n",
2790 bl->owner->number);
2791 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2792 "Temporarily disabling shared "
2793 "library breakpoints:\n");
2794 }
2795 *disabled_breaks = 1;
2796 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2797 "breakpoint #%d\n", bl->owner->number);
2798 return 0;
2799 }
2800 else
2801 {
2802 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
2803 {
2804 *hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
2805 *hw_bp_error_explained_already = bp_err_message != NULL;
2806 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2807 "Cannot insert hardware breakpoint %d%s",
2808 bl->owner->number, bp_err_message ? ":" : ".\n");
2809 if (bp_err_message != NULL)
2810 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "%s.\n", bp_err_message);
2811 }
2812 else
2813 {
2814 if (bp_err_message == NULL)
2815 {
2816 char *message
2817 = memory_error_message (TARGET_XFER_E_IO,
2818 bl->gdbarch, bl->address);
2819 struct cleanup *old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
2820
2821 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2822 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d.\n"
2823 "%s\n",
2824 bl->owner->number, message);
2825 do_cleanups (old_chain);
2826 }
2827 else
2828 {
2829 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
2830 "Cannot insert breakpoint %d: %s\n",
2831 bl->owner->number,
2832 bp_err_message);
2833 }
2834 }
2835 return 1;
2836
2837 }
2838 }
2839 else
2840 bl->inserted = 1;
2841
2842 return 0;
2843 }
2844
2845 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
2846 /* NOTE drow/2003-09-08: This state only exists for removing
2847 watchpoints. It's not clear that it's necessary... */
2848 && bl->owner->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
2849 {
2850 int val;
2851
2852 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2853 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2854
2855 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2856
2857 /* If trying to set a read-watchpoint, and it turns out it's not
2858 supported, try emulating one with an access watchpoint. */
2859 if (val == 1 && bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
2860 {
2861 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2862
2863 /* But don't try to insert it, if there's already another
2864 hw_access location that would be considered a duplicate
2865 of this one. */
2866 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2867 if (loc != bl
2868 && loc->watchpoint_type == hw_access
2869 && watchpoint_locations_match (bl, loc))
2870 {
2871 bl->duplicate = 1;
2872 bl->inserted = 1;
2873 bl->target_info = loc->target_info;
2874 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2875 val = 0;
2876 break;
2877 }
2878
2879 if (val == 1)
2880 {
2881 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_access;
2882 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2883
2884 if (val)
2885 /* Back to the original value. */
2886 bl->watchpoint_type = hw_read;
2887 }
2888 }
2889
2890 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2891 }
2892
2893 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint)
2894 {
2895 int val;
2896
2897 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
2898 && bl->owner->ops->insert_location != NULL);
2899
2900 val = bl->owner->ops->insert_location (bl);
2901 if (val)
2902 {
2903 bl->owner->enable_state = bp_disabled;
2904
2905 if (val == 1)
2906 warning (_("\
2907Error inserting catchpoint %d: Your system does not support this type\n\
2908of catchpoint."), bl->owner->number);
2909 else
2910 warning (_("Error inserting catchpoint %d."), bl->owner->number);
2911 }
2912
2913 bl->inserted = (val == 0);
2914
2915 /* We've already printed an error message if there was a problem
2916 inserting this catchpoint, and we've disabled the catchpoint,
2917 so just return success. */
2918 return 0;
2919 }
2920
2921 return 0;
2922}
2923
2924/* This function is called when program space PSPACE is about to be
2925 deleted. It takes care of updating breakpoints to not reference
2926 PSPACE anymore. */
2927
2928void
2929breakpoint_program_space_exit (struct program_space *pspace)
2930{
2931 struct breakpoint *b, *b_temp;
2932 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_temp;
2933
2934 /* Remove any breakpoint that was set through this program space. */
2935 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_temp)
2936 {
2937 if (b->pspace == pspace)
2938 delete_breakpoint (b);
2939 }
2940
2941 /* Breakpoints set through other program spaces could have locations
2942 bound to PSPACE as well. Remove those. */
2943 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_temp)
2944 {
2945 struct bp_location *tmp;
2946
2947 if (loc->pspace == pspace)
2948 {
2949 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
2950 if (loc->owner->loc == loc)
2951 loc->owner->loc = loc->next;
2952 else
2953 for (tmp = loc->owner->loc; tmp->next != NULL; tmp = tmp->next)
2954 if (tmp->next == loc)
2955 {
2956 tmp->next = loc->next;
2957 break;
2958 }
2959 }
2960 }
2961
2962 /* Now update the global location list to permanently delete the
2963 removed locations above. */
2964 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
2965}
2966
2967/* Make sure all breakpoints are inserted in inferior.
2968 Throws exception on any error.
2969 A breakpoint that is already inserted won't be inserted
2970 again, so calling this function twice is safe. */
2971void
2972insert_breakpoints (void)
2973{
2974 struct breakpoint *bpt;
2975
2976 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
2977 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
2978 {
2979 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
2980
2981 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
2982 }
2983
2984 /* Updating watchpoints creates new locations, so update the global
2985 location list. Explicitly tell ugll to insert locations and
2986 ignore breakpoints_always_inserted_mode. */
2987 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
2988}
2989
2990/* Invoke CALLBACK for each of bp_location. */
2991
2992void
2993iterate_over_bp_locations (walk_bp_location_callback callback)
2994{
2995 struct bp_location *loc, **loc_tmp;
2996
2997 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, loc_tmp)
2998 {
2999 callback (loc, NULL);
3000 }
3001}
3002
3003/* This is used when we need to synch breakpoint conditions between GDB and the
3004 target. It is the case with deleting and disabling of breakpoints when using
3005 always-inserted mode. */
3006
3007static void
3008update_inserted_breakpoint_locations (void)
3009{
3010 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3011 int error_flag = 0;
3012 int val = 0;
3013 int disabled_breaks = 0;
3014 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
3015 int hw_bp_details_reported = 0;
3016
3017 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3018 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3019
3020 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
3021 there was an error. */
3022 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
3023
3024 save_current_space_and_thread ();
3025
3026 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3027 {
3028 /* We only want to update software breakpoints and hardware
3029 breakpoints. */
3030 if (!is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
3031 continue;
3032
3033 /* We only want to update locations that are already inserted
3034 and need updating. This is to avoid unwanted insertion during
3035 deletion of breakpoints. */
3036 if (!bl->inserted || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3037 continue;
3038
3039 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3040
3041 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3042 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3043 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3044 insert breakpoints. */
3045 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3046 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3047 continue;
3048
3049 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3050 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_details_reported);
3051 if (val)
3052 error_flag = val;
3053 }
3054
3055 if (error_flag)
3056 {
3057 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3058 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3059 }
3060
3061 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3062}
3063
3064/* Used when starting or continuing the program. */
3065
3066static void
3067insert_breakpoint_locations (void)
3068{
3069 struct breakpoint *bpt;
3070 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3071 int error_flag = 0;
3072 int val = 0;
3073 int disabled_breaks = 0;
3074 int hw_breakpoint_error = 0;
3075 int hw_bp_error_explained_already = 0;
3076
3077 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3078 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3079
3080 /* Explicitly mark the warning -- this will only be printed if
3081 there was an error. */
3082 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream, "Warning:\n");
3083
3084 save_current_space_and_thread ();
3085
3086 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3087 {
3088 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || (bl->inserted && !bl->needs_update))
3089 continue;
3090
3091 /* There is no point inserting thread-specific breakpoints if
3092 the thread no longer exists. ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location
3093 has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
3094 if (bl->owner->thread != -1
3095 && !valid_thread_id (bl->owner->thread))
3096 continue;
3097
3098 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
3099
3100 /* For targets that support global breakpoints, there's no need
3101 to select an inferior to insert breakpoint to. In fact, even
3102 if we aren't attached to any process yet, we should still
3103 insert breakpoints. */
3104 if (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
3105 && ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
3106 continue;
3107
3108 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &disabled_breaks,
3109 &hw_breakpoint_error, &hw_bp_error_explained_already);
3110 if (val)
3111 error_flag = val;
3112 }
3113
3114 /* If we failed to insert all locations of a watchpoint, remove
3115 them, as half-inserted watchpoint is of limited use. */
3116 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
3117 {
3118 int some_failed = 0;
3119 struct bp_location *loc;
3120
3121 if (!is_hardware_watchpoint (bpt))
3122 continue;
3123
3124 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
3125 continue;
3126
3127 if (bpt->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
3128 continue;
3129
3130 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3131 if (!loc->inserted && should_be_inserted (loc))
3132 {
3133 some_failed = 1;
3134 break;
3135 }
3136 if (some_failed)
3137 {
3138 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
3139 if (loc->inserted)
3140 remove_breakpoint (loc, mark_uninserted);
3141
3142 hw_breakpoint_error = 1;
3143 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3144 "Could not insert hardware watchpoint %d.\n",
3145 bpt->number);
3146 error_flag = -1;
3147 }
3148 }
3149
3150 if (error_flag)
3151 {
3152 /* If a hardware breakpoint or watchpoint was inserted, add a
3153 message about possibly exhausted resources. */
3154 if (hw_breakpoint_error && !hw_bp_error_explained_already)
3155 {
3156 fprintf_unfiltered (tmp_error_stream,
3157 "Could not insert hardware breakpoints:\n\
3158You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints/watchpoints.\n");
3159 }
3160 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
3161 error_stream (tmp_error_stream);
3162 }
3163
3164 do_cleanups (cleanups);
3165}
3166
3167/* Used when the program stops.
3168 Returns zero if successful, or non-zero if there was a problem
3169 removing a breakpoint location. */
3170
3171int
3172remove_breakpoints (void)
3173{
3174 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3175 int val = 0;
3176
3177 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3178 {
3179 if (bl->inserted && !is_tracepoint (bl->owner))
3180 val |= remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
3181 }
3182 return val;
3183}
3184
3185/* When a thread exits, remove breakpoints that are related to
3186 that thread. */
3187
3188static void
3189remove_threaded_breakpoints (struct thread_info *tp, int silent)
3190{
3191 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3192
3193 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3194 {
3195 if (b->thread == tp->num && user_breakpoint_p (b))
3196 {
3197 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
3198
3199 printf_filtered (_("\
3200Thread-specific breakpoint %d deleted - thread %d no longer in the thread list.\n"),
3201 b->number, tp->num);
3202
3203 /* Hide it from the user. */
3204 b->number = 0;
3205 }
3206 }
3207}
3208
3209/* Remove breakpoints of process PID. */
3210
3211int
3212remove_breakpoints_pid (int pid)
3213{
3214 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3215 int val;
3216 struct inferior *inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3217
3218 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3219 {
3220 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3221 continue;
3222
3223 if (bl->owner->type == bp_dprintf)
3224 continue;
3225
3226 if (bl->inserted)
3227 {
3228 val = remove_breakpoint (bl, mark_uninserted);
3229 if (val != 0)
3230 return val;
3231 }
3232 }
3233 return 0;
3234}
3235
3236int
3237reattach_breakpoints (int pid)
3238{
3239 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3240 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3241 int val;
3242 struct ui_file *tmp_error_stream;
3243 int dummy1 = 0, dummy2 = 0, dummy3 = 0;
3244 struct inferior *inf;
3245 struct thread_info *tp;
3246
3247 tp = any_live_thread_of_process (pid);
3248 if (tp == NULL)
3249 return 1;
3250
3251 inf = find_inferior_pid (pid);
3252 old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3253
3254 inferior_ptid = tp->ptid;
3255
3256 tmp_error_stream = mem_fileopen ();
3257 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (tmp_error_stream);
3258
3259 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3260 {
3261 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3262 continue;
3263
3264 if (bl->inserted)
3265 {
3266 bl->inserted = 0;
3267 val = insert_bp_location (bl, tmp_error_stream, &dummy1, &dummy2, &dummy3);
3268 if (val != 0)
3269 {
3270 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3271 return val;
3272 }
3273 }
3274 }
3275 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3276 return 0;
3277}
3278
3279static int internal_breakpoint_number = -1;
3280
3281/* Set the breakpoint number of B, depending on the value of INTERNAL.
3282 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be populated
3283 from internal_breakpoint_number and that variable decremented.
3284 Otherwise the breakpoint number will be populated from
3285 breakpoint_count and that value incremented. Internal breakpoints
3286 do not set the internal var bpnum. */
3287static void
3288set_breakpoint_number (int internal, struct breakpoint *b)
3289{
3290 if (internal)
3291 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3292 else
3293 {
3294 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
3295 b->number = breakpoint_count;
3296 }
3297}
3298
3299static struct breakpoint *
3300create_internal_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
3301 CORE_ADDR address, enum bptype type,
3302 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
3303{
3304 struct symtab_and_line sal;
3305 struct breakpoint *b;
3306
3307 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
3308
3309 sal.pc = address;
3310 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (sal.pc);
3311 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
3312
3313 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
3314 b->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
3315 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
3316
3317 return b;
3318}
3319
3320static const char *const longjmp_names[] =
3321 {
3322 "longjmp", "_longjmp", "siglongjmp", "_siglongjmp"
3323 };
3324#define NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES ARRAY_SIZE(longjmp_names)
3325
3326/* Per-objfile data private to breakpoint.c. */
3327struct breakpoint_objfile_data
3328{
3329 /* Minimal symbol for "_ovly_debug_event" (if any). */
3330 struct bound_minimal_symbol overlay_msym;
3331
3332 /* Minimal symbol(s) for "longjmp", "siglongjmp", etc. (if any). */
3333 struct bound_minimal_symbol longjmp_msym[NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES];
3334
3335 /* True if we have looked for longjmp probes. */
3336 int longjmp_searched;
3337
3338 /* SystemTap probe points for longjmp (if any). */
3339 VEC (probe_p) *longjmp_probes;
3340
3341 /* Minimal symbol for "std::terminate()" (if any). */
3342 struct bound_minimal_symbol terminate_msym;
3343
3344 /* Minimal symbol for "_Unwind_DebugHook" (if any). */
3345 struct bound_minimal_symbol exception_msym;
3346
3347 /* True if we have looked for exception probes. */
3348 int exception_searched;
3349
3350 /* SystemTap probe points for unwinding (if any). */
3351 VEC (probe_p) *exception_probes;
3352};
3353
3354static const struct objfile_data *breakpoint_objfile_key;
3355
3356/* Minimal symbol not found sentinel. */
3357static struct minimal_symbol msym_not_found;
3358
3359/* Returns TRUE if MSYM point to the "not found" sentinel. */
3360
3361static int
3362msym_not_found_p (const struct minimal_symbol *msym)
3363{
3364 return msym == &msym_not_found;
3365}
3366
3367/* Return per-objfile data needed by breakpoint.c.
3368 Allocate the data if necessary. */
3369
3370static struct breakpoint_objfile_data *
3371get_breakpoint_objfile_data (struct objfile *objfile)
3372{
3373 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3374
3375 bp_objfile_data = objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key);
3376 if (bp_objfile_data == NULL)
3377 {
3378 bp_objfile_data = obstack_alloc (&objfile->objfile_obstack,
3379 sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
3380
3381 memset (bp_objfile_data, 0, sizeof (*bp_objfile_data));
3382 set_objfile_data (objfile, breakpoint_objfile_key, bp_objfile_data);
3383 }
3384 return bp_objfile_data;
3385}
3386
3387static void
3388free_breakpoint_probes (struct objfile *obj, void *data)
3389{
3390 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data = data;
3391
3392 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes);
3393 VEC_free (probe_p, bp_objfile_data->exception_probes);
3394}
3395
3396static void
3397create_overlay_event_breakpoint (void)
3398{
3399 struct objfile *objfile;
3400 const char *const func_name = "_ovly_debug_event";
3401
3402 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3403 {
3404 struct breakpoint *b;
3405 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3406 CORE_ADDR addr;
3407
3408 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3409
3410 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym))
3411 continue;
3412
3413 if (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym == NULL)
3414 {
3415 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3416
3417 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3418 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3419 {
3420 /* Avoid future lookups in this objfile. */
3421 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3422 continue;
3423 }
3424 bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym = m;
3425 }
3426
3427 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->overlay_msym);
3428 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3429 bp_overlay_event,
3430 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3431 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3432
3433 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_auto)
3434 {
3435 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
3436 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
3437 }
3438 else
3439 {
3440 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3441 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
3442 }
3443 }
3444 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3445}
3446
3447static void
3448create_longjmp_master_breakpoint (void)
3449{
3450 struct program_space *pspace;
3451 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3452
3453 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3454
3455 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3456 {
3457 struct objfile *objfile;
3458
3459 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3460
3461 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3462 {
3463 int i;
3464 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3465 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3466
3467 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3468
3469 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3470
3471 if (!bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched)
3472 {
3473 VEC (probe_p) *ret;
3474
3475 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libc", "longjmp");
3476 if (ret != NULL)
3477 {
3478 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3479 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3480
3481 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3482 {
3483 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3484 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3485 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3486 ret = NULL;
3487 }
3488 }
3489 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes = ret;
3490 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_searched = 1;
3491 }
3492
3493 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes != NULL)
3494 {
3495 int i;
3496 struct probe *probe;
3497 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3498
3499 for (i = 0;
3500 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3501 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_probes,
3502 i, probe);
3503 ++i)
3504 {
3505 struct breakpoint *b;
3506
3507 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3508 get_probe_address (probe,
3509 objfile),
3510 bp_longjmp_master,
3511 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3512 b->addr_string = xstrdup ("-probe-stap libc:longjmp");
3513 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3514 }
3515
3516 continue;
3517 }
3518
3519 if (!gdbarch_get_longjmp_target_p (gdbarch))
3520 continue;
3521
3522 for (i = 0; i < NUM_LONGJMP_NAMES; i++)
3523 {
3524 struct breakpoint *b;
3525 const char *func_name;
3526 CORE_ADDR addr;
3527
3528 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym))
3529 continue;
3530
3531 func_name = longjmp_names[i];
3532 if (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym == NULL)
3533 {
3534 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3535
3536 m = lookup_minimal_symbol_text (func_name, objfile);
3537 if (m.minsym == NULL)
3538 {
3539 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3540 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i].minsym = &msym_not_found;
3541 continue;
3542 }
3543 bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i] = m;
3544 }
3545
3546 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->longjmp_msym[i]);
3547 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_longjmp_master,
3548 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3549 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3550 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3551 }
3552 }
3553 }
3554 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3555
3556 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3557}
3558
3559/* Create a master std::terminate breakpoint. */
3560static void
3561create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint (void)
3562{
3563 struct program_space *pspace;
3564 struct cleanup *old_chain;
3565 const char *const func_name = "std::terminate()";
3566
3567 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
3568
3569 ALL_PSPACES (pspace)
3570 {
3571 struct objfile *objfile;
3572 CORE_ADDR addr;
3573
3574 set_current_program_space (pspace);
3575
3576 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3577 {
3578 struct breakpoint *b;
3579 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3580
3581 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3582
3583 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym))
3584 continue;
3585
3586 if (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym == NULL)
3587 {
3588 struct bound_minimal_symbol m;
3589
3590 m = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3591 if (m.minsym == NULL || (MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_text
3592 && MSYMBOL_TYPE (m.minsym) != mst_file_text))
3593 {
3594 /* Prevent future lookups in this objfile. */
3595 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3596 continue;
3597 }
3598 bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym = m;
3599 }
3600
3601 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->terminate_msym);
3602 b = create_internal_breakpoint (get_objfile_arch (objfile), addr,
3603 bp_std_terminate_master,
3604 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3605 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3606 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3607 }
3608 }
3609
3610 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3611
3612 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3613}
3614
3615/* Install a master breakpoint on the unwinder's debug hook. */
3616
3617static void
3618create_exception_master_breakpoint (void)
3619{
3620 struct objfile *objfile;
3621 const char *const func_name = "_Unwind_DebugHook";
3622
3623 ALL_OBJFILES (objfile)
3624 {
3625 struct breakpoint *b;
3626 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
3627 struct breakpoint_objfile_data *bp_objfile_data;
3628 CORE_ADDR addr;
3629
3630 bp_objfile_data = get_breakpoint_objfile_data (objfile);
3631
3632 /* We prefer the SystemTap probe point if it exists. */
3633 if (!bp_objfile_data->exception_searched)
3634 {
3635 VEC (probe_p) *ret;
3636
3637 ret = find_probes_in_objfile (objfile, "libgcc", "unwind");
3638
3639 if (ret != NULL)
3640 {
3641 /* We are only interested in checking one element. */
3642 struct probe *p = VEC_index (probe_p, ret, 0);
3643
3644 if (!can_evaluate_probe_arguments (p))
3645 {
3646 /* We cannot use the probe interface here, because it does
3647 not know how to evaluate arguments. */
3648 VEC_free (probe_p, ret);
3649 ret = NULL;
3650 }
3651 }
3652 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes = ret;
3653 bp_objfile_data->exception_searched = 1;
3654 }
3655
3656 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_probes != NULL)
3657 {
3658 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3659 int i;
3660 struct probe *probe;
3661
3662 for (i = 0;
3663 VEC_iterate (probe_p,
3664 bp_objfile_data->exception_probes,
3665 i, probe);
3666 ++i)
3667 {
3668 struct breakpoint *b;
3669
3670 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch,
3671 get_probe_address (probe,
3672 objfile),
3673 bp_exception_master,
3674 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3675 b->addr_string = xstrdup ("-probe-stap libgcc:unwind");
3676 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3677 }
3678
3679 continue;
3680 }
3681
3682 /* Otherwise, try the hook function. */
3683
3684 if (msym_not_found_p (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym))
3685 continue;
3686
3687 gdbarch = get_objfile_arch (objfile);
3688
3689 if (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym == NULL)
3690 {
3691 struct bound_minimal_symbol debug_hook;
3692
3693 debug_hook = lookup_minimal_symbol (func_name, NULL, objfile);
3694 if (debug_hook.minsym == NULL)
3695 {
3696 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym.minsym = &msym_not_found;
3697 continue;
3698 }
3699
3700 bp_objfile_data->exception_msym = debug_hook;
3701 }
3702
3703 addr = BMSYMBOL_VALUE_ADDRESS (bp_objfile_data->exception_msym);
3704 addr = gdbarch_convert_from_func_ptr_addr (gdbarch, addr,
3705 &current_target);
3706 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, addr, bp_exception_master,
3707 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
3708 b->addr_string = xstrdup (func_name);
3709 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
3710 }
3711
3712 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
3713}
3714
3715void
3716update_breakpoints_after_exec (void)
3717{
3718 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
3719 struct bp_location *bploc, **bplocp_tmp;
3720
3721 /* We're about to delete breakpoints from GDB's lists. If the
3722 INSERTED flag is true, GDB will try to lift the breakpoints by
3723 writing the breakpoints' "shadow contents" back into memory. The
3724 "shadow contents" are NOT valid after an exec, so GDB should not
3725 do that. Instead, the target is responsible from marking
3726 breakpoints out as soon as it detects an exec. We don't do that
3727 here instead, because there may be other attempts to delete
3728 breakpoints after detecting an exec and before reaching here. */
3729 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bploc, bplocp_tmp)
3730 if (bploc->pspace == current_program_space)
3731 gdb_assert (!bploc->inserted);
3732
3733 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
3734 {
3735 if (b->pspace != current_program_space)
3736 continue;
3737
3738 /* Solib breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3739 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
3740 {
3741 delete_breakpoint (b);
3742 continue;
3743 }
3744
3745 /* JIT breakpoints must be explicitly reset after an exec(). */
3746 if (b->type == bp_jit_event)
3747 {
3748 delete_breakpoint (b);
3749 continue;
3750 }
3751
3752 /* Thread event breakpoints must be set anew after an exec(),
3753 as must overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints. */
3754 if (b->type == bp_thread_event || b->type == bp_overlay_event
3755 || b->type == bp_longjmp_master || b->type == bp_std_terminate_master
3756 || b->type == bp_exception_master)
3757 {
3758 delete_breakpoint (b);
3759 continue;
3760 }
3761
3762 /* Step-resume breakpoints are meaningless after an exec(). */
3763 if (b->type == bp_step_resume || b->type == bp_hp_step_resume)
3764 {
3765 delete_breakpoint (b);
3766 continue;
3767 }
3768
3769 /* Just like single-step breakpoints. */
3770 if (b->type == bp_single_step)
3771 {
3772 delete_breakpoint (b);
3773 continue;
3774 }
3775
3776 /* Longjmp and longjmp-resume breakpoints are also meaningless
3777 after an exec. */
3778 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_longjmp_resume
3779 || b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy
3780 || b->type == bp_exception || b->type == bp_exception_resume)
3781 {
3782 delete_breakpoint (b);
3783 continue;
3784 }
3785
3786 if (b->type == bp_catchpoint)
3787 {
3788 /* For now, none of the bp_catchpoint breakpoints need to
3789 do anything at this point. In the future, if some of
3790 the catchpoints need to something, we will need to add
3791 a new method, and call this method from here. */
3792 continue;
3793 }
3794
3795 /* bp_finish is a special case. The only way we ought to be able
3796 to see one of these when an exec() has happened, is if the user
3797 caught a vfork, and then said "finish". Ordinarily a finish just
3798 carries them to the call-site of the current callee, by setting
3799 a temporary bp there and resuming. But in this case, the finish
3800 will carry them entirely through the vfork & exec.
3801
3802 We don't want to allow a bp_finish to remain inserted now. But
3803 we can't safely delete it, 'cause finish_command has a handle to
3804 the bp on a bpstat, and will later want to delete it. There's a
3805 chance (and I've seen it happen) that if we delete the bp_finish
3806 here, that its storage will get reused by the time finish_command
3807 gets 'round to deleting the "use to be a bp_finish" breakpoint.
3808 We really must allow finish_command to delete a bp_finish.
3809
3810 In the absence of a general solution for the "how do we know
3811 it's safe to delete something others may have handles to?"
3812 problem, what we'll do here is just uninsert the bp_finish, and
3813 let finish_command delete it.
3814
3815 (We know the bp_finish is "doomed" in the sense that it's
3816 momentary, and will be deleted as soon as finish_command sees
3817 the inferior stopped. So it doesn't matter that the bp's
3818 address is probably bogus in the new a.out, unlike e.g., the
3819 solib breakpoints.) */
3820
3821 if (b->type == bp_finish)
3822 {
3823 continue;
3824 }
3825
3826 /* Without a symbolic address, we have little hope of the
3827 pre-exec() address meaning the same thing in the post-exec()
3828 a.out. */
3829 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
3830 {
3831 delete_breakpoint (b);
3832 continue;
3833 }
3834 }
3835}
3836
3837int
3838detach_breakpoints (ptid_t ptid)
3839{
3840 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
3841 int val = 0;
3842 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_inferior_ptid ();
3843 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
3844
3845 if (ptid_get_pid (ptid) == ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid))
3846 error (_("Cannot detach breakpoints of inferior_ptid"));
3847
3848 /* Set inferior_ptid; remove_breakpoint_1 uses this global. */
3849 inferior_ptid = ptid;
3850 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
3851 {
3852 if (bl->pspace != inf->pspace)
3853 continue;
3854
3855 /* This function must physically remove breakpoints locations
3856 from the specified ptid, without modifying the breakpoint
3857 package's state. Locations of type bp_loc_other are only
3858 maintained at GDB side. So, there is no need to remove
3859 these bp_loc_other locations. Moreover, removing these
3860 would modify the breakpoint package's state. */
3861 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_other)
3862 continue;
3863
3864 if (bl->inserted)
3865 val |= remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, mark_inserted);
3866 }
3867
3868 do_cleanups (old_chain);
3869 return val;
3870}
3871
3872/* Remove the breakpoint location BL from the current address space.
3873 Note that this is used to detach breakpoints from a child fork.
3874 When we get here, the child isn't in the inferior list, and neither
3875 do we have objects to represent its address space --- we should
3876 *not* look at bl->pspace->aspace here. */
3877
3878static int
3879remove_breakpoint_1 (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
3880{
3881 int val;
3882
3883 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
3884 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
3885
3886 if (bl->permanent)
3887 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
3888 return 0;
3889
3890 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
3891 This should not ever happen. */
3892 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
3893
3894 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3895 || bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3896 {
3897 /* "Normal" instruction breakpoint: either the standard
3898 trap-instruction bp (bp_breakpoint), or a
3899 bp_hardware_breakpoint. */
3900
3901 /* First check to see if we have to handle an overlay. */
3902 if (overlay_debugging == ovly_off
3903 || bl->section == NULL
3904 || !(section_is_overlay (bl->section)))
3905 {
3906 /* No overlay handling: just remove the breakpoint. */
3907
3908 /* If we're trying to uninsert a memory breakpoint that we
3909 know is set in a dynamic object that is marked
3910 shlib_disabled, then either the dynamic object was
3911 removed with "remove-symbol-file" or with
3912 "nosharedlibrary". In the former case, we don't know
3913 whether another dynamic object might have loaded over the
3914 breakpoint's address -- the user might well let us know
3915 about it next with add-symbol-file (the whole point of
3916 add-symbol-file is letting the user manually maintain a
3917 list of dynamically loaded objects). If we have the
3918 breakpoint's shadow memory, that is, this is a software
3919 breakpoint managed by GDB, check whether the breakpoint
3920 is still inserted in memory, to avoid overwriting wrong
3921 code with stale saved shadow contents. Note that HW
3922 breakpoints don't have shadow memory, as they're
3923 implemented using a mechanism that is not dependent on
3924 being able to modify the target's memory, and as such
3925 they should always be removed. */
3926 if (bl->shlib_disabled
3927 && bl->target_info.shadow_len != 0
3928 && !memory_validate_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info))
3929 val = 0;
3930 else
3931 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3932 }
3933 else
3934 {
3935 /* This breakpoint is in an overlay section.
3936 Did we set a breakpoint at the LMA? */
3937 if (!overlay_events_enabled)
3938 {
3939 /* Yes -- overlay event support is not active, so we
3940 should have set a breakpoint at the LMA. Remove it.
3941 */
3942 /* Ignore any failures: if the LMA is in ROM, we will
3943 have already warned when we failed to insert it. */
3944 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
3945 target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3946 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3947 else
3948 target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch,
3949 &bl->overlay_target_info);
3950 }
3951 /* Did we set a breakpoint at the VMA?
3952 If so, we will have marked the breakpoint 'inserted'. */
3953 if (bl->inserted)
3954 {
3955 /* Yes -- remove it. Previously we did not bother to
3956 remove the breakpoint if the section had been
3957 unmapped, but let's not rely on that being safe. We
3958 don't know what the overlay manager might do. */
3959
3960 /* However, we should remove *software* breakpoints only
3961 if the section is still mapped, or else we overwrite
3962 wrong code with the saved shadow contents. */
3963 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
3964 || section_is_mapped (bl->section))
3965 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
3966 else
3967 val = 0;
3968 }
3969 else
3970 {
3971 /* No -- not inserted, so no need to remove. No error. */
3972 val = 0;
3973 }
3974 }
3975
3976 /* In some cases, we might not be able to remove a breakpoint in
3977 a shared library that has already been removed, but we have
3978 not yet processed the shlib unload event. Similarly for an
3979 unloaded add-symbol-file object - the user might not yet have
3980 had the chance to remove-symbol-file it. shlib_disabled will
3981 be set if the library/object has already been removed, but
3982 the breakpoint hasn't been uninserted yet, e.g., after
3983 "nosharedlibrary" or "remove-symbol-file" with breakpoints
3984 always-inserted mode. */
3985 if (val
3986 && (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint
3987 && (bl->shlib_disabled
3988 || solib_name_from_address (bl->pspace, bl->address)
3989 || shared_objfile_contains_address_p (bl->pspace,
3990 bl->address))))
3991 val = 0;
3992
3993 if (val)
3994 return val;
3995 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
3996 }
3997 else if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint)
3998 {
3999 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
4000 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
4001
4002 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
4003 bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
4004
4005 /* Failure to remove any of the hardware watchpoints comes here. */
4006 if ((is == mark_uninserted) && (bl->inserted))
4007 warning (_("Could not remove hardware watchpoint %d."),
4008 bl->owner->number);
4009 }
4010 else if (bl->owner->type == bp_catchpoint
4011 && breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4012 && !bl->duplicate)
4013 {
4014 gdb_assert (bl->owner->ops != NULL
4015 && bl->owner->ops->remove_location != NULL);
4016
4017 val = bl->owner->ops->remove_location (bl);
4018 if (val)
4019 return val;
4020
4021 bl->inserted = (is == mark_inserted);
4022 }
4023
4024 return 0;
4025}
4026
4027static int
4028remove_breakpoint (struct bp_location *bl, insertion_state_t is)
4029{
4030 int ret;
4031 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4032
4033 /* BL is never in moribund_locations by our callers. */
4034 gdb_assert (bl->owner != NULL);
4035
4036 if (bl->permanent)
4037 /* Permanent breakpoints cannot be inserted or removed. */
4038 return 0;
4039
4040 /* The type of none suggests that owner is actually deleted.
4041 This should not ever happen. */
4042 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type != bp_none);
4043
4044 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
4045
4046 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
4047
4048 ret = remove_breakpoint_1 (bl, is);
4049
4050 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4051 return ret;
4052}
4053
4054/* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints. */
4055
4056void
4057mark_breakpoints_out (void)
4058{
4059 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4060
4061 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4062 if (bl->pspace == current_program_space
4063 && !bl->permanent)
4064 bl->inserted = 0;
4065}
4066
4067/* Clear the "inserted" flag in all breakpoints and delete any
4068 breakpoints which should go away between runs of the program.
4069
4070 Plus other such housekeeping that has to be done for breakpoints
4071 between runs.
4072
4073 Note: this function gets called at the end of a run (by
4074 generic_mourn_inferior) and when a run begins (by
4075 init_wait_for_inferior). */
4076
4077
4078
4079void
4080breakpoint_init_inferior (enum inf_context context)
4081{
4082 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
4083 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4084 int ix;
4085 struct program_space *pspace = current_program_space;
4086
4087 /* If breakpoint locations are shared across processes, then there's
4088 nothing to do. */
4089 if (gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ()))
4090 return;
4091
4092 mark_breakpoints_out ();
4093
4094 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
4095 {
4096 if (b->loc && b->loc->pspace != pspace)
4097 continue;
4098
4099 switch (b->type)
4100 {
4101 case bp_call_dummy:
4102 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
4103
4104 /* If the call dummy breakpoint is at the entry point it will
4105 cause problems when the inferior is rerun, so we better get
4106 rid of it. */
4107
4108 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
4109
4110 /* Also get rid of scope breakpoints. */
4111
4112 case bp_shlib_event:
4113
4114 /* Also remove solib event breakpoints. Their addresses may
4115 have changed since the last time we ran the program.
4116 Actually we may now be debugging against different target;
4117 and so the solib backend that installed this breakpoint may
4118 not be used in by the target. E.g.,
4119
4120 (gdb) file prog-linux
4121 (gdb) run # native linux target
4122 ...
4123 (gdb) kill
4124 (gdb) file prog-win.exe
4125 (gdb) tar rem :9999 # remote Windows gdbserver.
4126 */
4127
4128 case bp_step_resume:
4129
4130 /* Also remove step-resume breakpoints. */
4131
4132 case bp_single_step:
4133
4134 /* Also remove single-step breakpoints. */
4135
4136 delete_breakpoint (b);
4137 break;
4138
4139 case bp_watchpoint:
4140 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
4141 case bp_read_watchpoint:
4142 case bp_access_watchpoint:
4143 {
4144 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4145
4146 /* Likewise for watchpoints on local expressions. */
4147 if (w->exp_valid_block != NULL)
4148 delete_breakpoint (b);
4149 else if (context == inf_starting)
4150 {
4151 /* Reset val field to force reread of starting value in
4152 insert_breakpoints. */
4153 if (w->val)
4154 value_free (w->val);
4155 w->val = NULL;
4156 w->val_valid = 0;
4157 }
4158 }
4159 break;
4160 default:
4161 break;
4162 }
4163 }
4164
4165 /* Get rid of the moribund locations. */
4166 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, bl); ++ix)
4167 decref_bp_location (&bl);
4168 VEC_free (bp_location_p, moribund_locations);
4169}
4170
4171/* These functions concern about actual breakpoints inserted in the
4172 target --- to e.g. check if we need to do decr_pc adjustment or if
4173 we need to hop over the bkpt --- so we check for address space
4174 match, not program space. */
4175
4176/* breakpoint_here_p (PC) returns non-zero if an enabled breakpoint
4177 exists at PC. It returns ordinary_breakpoint_here if it's an
4178 ordinary breakpoint, or permanent_breakpoint_here if it's a
4179 permanent breakpoint.
4180 - When continuing from a location with an ordinary breakpoint, we
4181 actually single step once before calling insert_breakpoints.
4182 - When continuing from a location with a permanent breakpoint, we
4183 need to use the `SKIP_PERMANENT_BREAKPOINT' macro, provided by
4184 the target, to advance the PC past the breakpoint. */
4185
4186enum breakpoint_here
4187breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4188{
4189 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4190 int any_breakpoint_here = 0;
4191
4192 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4193 {
4194 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4195 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4196 continue;
4197
4198 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has BL->OWNER always non-NULL. */
4199 if ((breakpoint_enabled (bl->owner)
4200 || bl->permanent)
4201 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4202 {
4203 if (overlay_debugging
4204 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4205 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4206 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4207 else if (bl->permanent)
4208 return permanent_breakpoint_here;
4209 else
4210 any_breakpoint_here = 1;
4211 }
4212 }
4213
4214 return any_breakpoint_here ? ordinary_breakpoint_here : 0;
4215}
4216
4217/* Return true if there's a moribund breakpoint at PC. */
4218
4219int
4220moribund_breakpoint_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4221{
4222 struct bp_location *loc;
4223 int ix;
4224
4225 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
4226 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
4227 return 1;
4228
4229 return 0;
4230}
4231
4232/* Returns non-zero iff there's a breakpoint inserted at PC. */
4233
4234int
4235breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc)
4236{
4237 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4238
4239 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4240 {
4241 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint
4242 && bl->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
4243 continue;
4244
4245 if (bl->inserted
4246 && breakpoint_location_address_match (bl, aspace, pc))
4247 {
4248 if (overlay_debugging
4249 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4250 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4251 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4252 else
4253 return 1;
4254 }
4255 }
4256 return 0;
4257}
4258
4259/* This function returns non-zero iff there is a software breakpoint
4260 inserted at PC. */
4261
4262int
4263software_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
4264 CORE_ADDR pc)
4265{
4266 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
4267
4268 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
4269 {
4270 if (bl->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
4271 continue;
4272
4273 if (bl->inserted
4274 && breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
4275 aspace, pc))
4276 {
4277 if (overlay_debugging
4278 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
4279 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
4280 continue; /* unmapped overlay -- can't be a match */
4281 else
4282 return 1;
4283 }
4284 }
4285
4286 return 0;
4287}
4288
4289int
4290hardware_watchpoint_inserted_in_range (struct address_space *aspace,
4291 CORE_ADDR addr, ULONGEST len)
4292{
4293 struct breakpoint *bpt;
4294
4295 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
4296 {
4297 struct bp_location *loc;
4298
4299 if (bpt->type != bp_hardware_watchpoint
4300 && bpt->type != bp_access_watchpoint)
4301 continue;
4302
4303 if (!breakpoint_enabled (bpt))
4304 continue;
4305
4306 for (loc = bpt->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4307 if (loc->pspace->aspace == aspace && loc->inserted)
4308 {
4309 CORE_ADDR l, h;
4310
4311 /* Check for intersection. */
4312 l = max (loc->address, addr);
4313 h = min (loc->address + loc->length, addr + len);
4314 if (l < h)
4315 return 1;
4316 }
4317 }
4318 return 0;
4319}
4320\f
4321
4322/* bpstat stuff. External routines' interfaces are documented
4323 in breakpoint.h. */
4324
4325int
4326is_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *ep)
4327{
4328 return (ep->type == bp_catchpoint);
4329}
4330
4331/* Frees any storage that is part of a bpstat. Does not walk the
4332 'next' chain. */
4333
4334static void
4335bpstat_free (bpstat bs)
4336{
4337 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4338 value_free (bs->old_val);
4339 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4340 decref_bp_location (&bs->bp_location_at);
4341 xfree (bs);
4342}
4343
4344/* Clear a bpstat so that it says we are not at any breakpoint.
4345 Also free any storage that is part of a bpstat. */
4346
4347void
4348bpstat_clear (bpstat *bsp)
4349{
4350 bpstat p;
4351 bpstat q;
4352
4353 if (bsp == 0)
4354 return;
4355 p = *bsp;
4356 while (p != NULL)
4357 {
4358 q = p->next;
4359 bpstat_free (p);
4360 p = q;
4361 }
4362 *bsp = NULL;
4363}
4364
4365/* Return a copy of a bpstat. Like "bs1 = bs2" but all storage that
4366 is part of the bpstat is copied as well. */
4367
4368bpstat
4369bpstat_copy (bpstat bs)
4370{
4371 bpstat p = NULL;
4372 bpstat tmp;
4373 bpstat retval = NULL;
4374
4375 if (bs == NULL)
4376 return bs;
4377
4378 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4379 {
4380 tmp = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*tmp));
4381 memcpy (tmp, bs, sizeof (*tmp));
4382 incref_counted_command_line (tmp->commands);
4383 incref_bp_location (tmp->bp_location_at);
4384 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4385 {
4386 tmp->old_val = value_copy (bs->old_val);
4387 release_value (tmp->old_val);
4388 }
4389
4390 if (p == NULL)
4391 /* This is the first thing in the chain. */
4392 retval = tmp;
4393 else
4394 p->next = tmp;
4395 p = tmp;
4396 }
4397 p->next = NULL;
4398 return retval;
4399}
4400
4401/* Find the bpstat associated with this breakpoint. */
4402
4403bpstat
4404bpstat_find_breakpoint (bpstat bsp, struct breakpoint *breakpoint)
4405{
4406 if (bsp == NULL)
4407 return NULL;
4408
4409 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4410 {
4411 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == breakpoint)
4412 return bsp;
4413 }
4414 return NULL;
4415}
4416
4417/* See breakpoint.h. */
4418
4419int
4420bpstat_explains_signal (bpstat bsp, enum gdb_signal sig)
4421{
4422 for (; bsp != NULL; bsp = bsp->next)
4423 {
4424 if (bsp->breakpoint_at == NULL)
4425 {
4426 /* A moribund location can never explain a signal other than
4427 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
4428 if (sig == GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
4429 return 1;
4430 }
4431 else
4432 {
4433 if (bsp->breakpoint_at->ops->explains_signal (bsp->breakpoint_at,
4434 sig))
4435 return 1;
4436 }
4437 }
4438
4439 return 0;
4440}
4441
4442/* Put in *NUM the breakpoint number of the first breakpoint we are
4443 stopped at. *BSP upon return is a bpstat which points to the
4444 remaining breakpoints stopped at (but which is not guaranteed to be
4445 good for anything but further calls to bpstat_num).
4446
4447 Return 0 if passed a bpstat which does not indicate any breakpoints.
4448 Return -1 if stopped at a breakpoint that has been deleted since
4449 we set it.
4450 Return 1 otherwise. */
4451
4452int
4453bpstat_num (bpstat *bsp, int *num)
4454{
4455 struct breakpoint *b;
4456
4457 if ((*bsp) == NULL)
4458 return 0; /* No more breakpoint values */
4459
4460 /* We assume we'll never have several bpstats that correspond to a
4461 single breakpoint -- otherwise, this function might return the
4462 same number more than once and this will look ugly. */
4463 b = (*bsp)->breakpoint_at;
4464 *bsp = (*bsp)->next;
4465 if (b == NULL)
4466 return -1; /* breakpoint that's been deleted since */
4467
4468 *num = b->number; /* We have its number */
4469 return 1;
4470}
4471
4472/* See breakpoint.h. */
4473
4474void
4475bpstat_clear_actions (void)
4476{
4477 struct thread_info *tp;
4478 bpstat bs;
4479
4480 if (ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4481 return;
4482
4483 tp = find_thread_ptid (inferior_ptid);
4484 if (tp == NULL)
4485 return;
4486
4487 for (bs = tp->control.stop_bpstat; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4488 {
4489 decref_counted_command_line (&bs->commands);
4490
4491 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
4492 {
4493 value_free (bs->old_val);
4494 bs->old_val = NULL;
4495 }
4496 }
4497}
4498
4499/* Called when a command is about to proceed the inferior. */
4500
4501static void
4502breakpoint_about_to_proceed (void)
4503{
4504 if (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid))
4505 {
4506 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
4507
4508 /* Allow inferior function calls in breakpoint commands to not
4509 interrupt the command list. When the call finishes
4510 successfully, the inferior will be standing at the same
4511 breakpoint as if nothing happened. */
4512 if (tp->control.in_infcall)
4513 return;
4514 }
4515
4516 breakpoint_proceeded = 1;
4517}
4518
4519/* Stub for cleaning up our state if we error-out of a breakpoint
4520 command. */
4521static void
4522cleanup_executing_breakpoints (void *ignore)
4523{
4524 executing_breakpoint_commands = 0;
4525}
4526
4527/* Return non-zero iff CMD as the first line of a command sequence is `silent'
4528 or its equivalent. */
4529
4530static int
4531command_line_is_silent (struct command_line *cmd)
4532{
4533 return cmd && (strcmp ("silent", cmd->line) == 0
4534 || (xdb_commands && strcmp ("Q", cmd->line) == 0));
4535}
4536
4537/* Execute all the commands associated with all the breakpoints at
4538 this location. Any of these commands could cause the process to
4539 proceed beyond this point, etc. We look out for such changes by
4540 checking the global "breakpoint_proceeded" after each command.
4541
4542 Returns true if a breakpoint command resumed the inferior. In that
4543 case, it is the caller's responsibility to recall it again with the
4544 bpstat of the current thread. */
4545
4546static int
4547bpstat_do_actions_1 (bpstat *bsp)
4548{
4549 bpstat bs;
4550 struct cleanup *old_chain;
4551 int again = 0;
4552
4553 /* Avoid endless recursion if a `source' command is contained
4554 in bs->commands. */
4555 if (executing_breakpoint_commands)
4556 return 0;
4557
4558 executing_breakpoint_commands = 1;
4559 old_chain = make_cleanup (cleanup_executing_breakpoints, 0);
4560
4561 prevent_dont_repeat ();
4562
4563 /* This pointer will iterate over the list of bpstat's. */
4564 bs = *bsp;
4565
4566 breakpoint_proceeded = 0;
4567 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
4568 {
4569 struct counted_command_line *ccmd;
4570 struct command_line *cmd;
4571 struct cleanup *this_cmd_tree_chain;
4572
4573 /* Take ownership of the BSP's command tree, if it has one.
4574
4575 The command tree could legitimately contain commands like
4576 'step' and 'next', which call clear_proceed_status, which
4577 frees stop_bpstat's command tree. To make sure this doesn't
4578 free the tree we're executing out from under us, we need to
4579 take ownership of the tree ourselves. Since a given bpstat's
4580 commands are only executed once, we don't need to copy it; we
4581 can clear the pointer in the bpstat, and make sure we free
4582 the tree when we're done. */
4583 ccmd = bs->commands;
4584 bs->commands = NULL;
4585 this_cmd_tree_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&ccmd);
4586 cmd = ccmd ? ccmd->commands : NULL;
4587 if (command_line_is_silent (cmd))
4588 {
4589 /* The action has been already done by bpstat_stop_status. */
4590 cmd = cmd->next;
4591 }
4592
4593 while (cmd != NULL)
4594 {
4595 execute_control_command (cmd);
4596
4597 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4598 break;
4599 else
4600 cmd = cmd->next;
4601 }
4602
4603 /* We can free this command tree now. */
4604 do_cleanups (this_cmd_tree_chain);
4605
4606 if (breakpoint_proceeded)
4607 {
4608 if (target_can_async_p ())
4609 /* If we are in async mode, then the target might be still
4610 running, not stopped at any breakpoint, so nothing for
4611 us to do here -- just return to the event loop. */
4612 ;
4613 else
4614 /* In sync mode, when execute_control_command returns
4615 we're already standing on the next breakpoint.
4616 Breakpoint commands for that stop were not run, since
4617 execute_command does not run breakpoint commands --
4618 only command_line_handler does, but that one is not
4619 involved in execution of breakpoint commands. So, we
4620 can now execute breakpoint commands. It should be
4621 noted that making execute_command do bpstat actions is
4622 not an option -- in this case we'll have recursive
4623 invocation of bpstat for each breakpoint with a
4624 command, and can easily blow up GDB stack. Instead, we
4625 return true, which will trigger the caller to recall us
4626 with the new stop_bpstat. */
4627 again = 1;
4628 break;
4629 }
4630 }
4631 do_cleanups (old_chain);
4632 return again;
4633}
4634
4635void
4636bpstat_do_actions (void)
4637{
4638 struct cleanup *cleanup_if_error = make_bpstat_clear_actions_cleanup ();
4639
4640 /* Do any commands attached to breakpoint we are stopped at. */
4641 while (!ptid_equal (inferior_ptid, null_ptid)
4642 && target_has_execution
4643 && !is_exited (inferior_ptid)
4644 && !is_executing (inferior_ptid))
4645 /* Since in sync mode, bpstat_do_actions may resume the inferior,
4646 and only return when it is stopped at the next breakpoint, we
4647 keep doing breakpoint actions until it returns false to
4648 indicate the inferior was not resumed. */
4649 if (!bpstat_do_actions_1 (&inferior_thread ()->control.stop_bpstat))
4650 break;
4651
4652 discard_cleanups (cleanup_if_error);
4653}
4654
4655/* Print out the (old or new) value associated with a watchpoint. */
4656
4657static void
4658watchpoint_value_print (struct value *val, struct ui_file *stream)
4659{
4660 if (val == NULL)
4661 fprintf_unfiltered (stream, _("<unreadable>"));
4662 else
4663 {
4664 struct value_print_options opts;
4665 get_user_print_options (&opts);
4666 value_print (val, stream, &opts);
4667 }
4668}
4669
4670/* Generic routine for printing messages indicating why we
4671 stopped. The behavior of this function depends on the value
4672 'print_it' in the bpstat structure. Under some circumstances we
4673 may decide not to print anything here and delegate the task to
4674 normal_stop(). */
4675
4676static enum print_stop_action
4677print_bp_stop_message (bpstat bs)
4678{
4679 switch (bs->print_it)
4680 {
4681 case print_it_noop:
4682 /* Nothing should be printed for this bpstat entry. */
4683 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4684 break;
4685
4686 case print_it_done:
4687 /* We still want to print the frame, but we already printed the
4688 relevant messages. */
4689 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
4690 break;
4691
4692 case print_it_normal:
4693 {
4694 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
4695
4696 /* bs->breakpoint_at can be NULL if it was a momentary breakpoint
4697 which has since been deleted. */
4698 if (b == NULL)
4699 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4700
4701 /* Normal case. Call the breakpoint's print_it method. */
4702 return b->ops->print_it (bs);
4703 }
4704 break;
4705
4706 default:
4707 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
4708 _("print_bp_stop_message: unrecognized enum value"));
4709 break;
4710 }
4711}
4712
4713/* A helper function that prints a shared library stopped event. */
4714
4715static void
4716print_solib_event (int is_catchpoint)
4717{
4718 int any_deleted
4719 = !VEC_empty (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs);
4720 int any_added
4721 = !VEC_empty (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs);
4722
4723 if (!is_catchpoint)
4724 {
4725 if (any_added || any_deleted)
4726 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4727 _("Stopped due to shared library event:\n"));
4728 else
4729 ui_out_text (current_uiout,
4730 _("Stopped due to shared library event (no "
4731 "libraries added or removed)\n"));
4732 }
4733
4734 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
4735 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "reason",
4736 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_SOLIB_EVENT));
4737
4738 if (any_deleted)
4739 {
4740 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4741 char *name;
4742 int ix;
4743
4744 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior unloaded "));
4745 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4746 "removed");
4747 for (ix = 0;
4748 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
4749 ix, name);
4750 ++ix)
4751 {
4752 if (ix > 0)
4753 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4754 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", name);
4755 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4756 }
4757
4758 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4759 }
4760
4761 if (any_added)
4762 {
4763 struct so_list *iter;
4764 int ix;
4765 struct cleanup *cleanup;
4766
4767 ui_out_text (current_uiout, _(" Inferior loaded "));
4768 cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (current_uiout,
4769 "added");
4770 for (ix = 0;
4771 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
4772 ix, iter);
4773 ++ix)
4774 {
4775 if (ix > 0)
4776 ui_out_text (current_uiout, " ");
4777 ui_out_field_string (current_uiout, "library", iter->so_name);
4778 ui_out_text (current_uiout, "\n");
4779 }
4780
4781 do_cleanups (cleanup);
4782 }
4783}
4784
4785/* Print a message indicating what happened. This is called from
4786 normal_stop(). The input to this routine is the head of the bpstat
4787 list - a list of the eventpoints that caused this stop. KIND is
4788 the target_waitkind for the stopping event. This
4789 routine calls the generic print routine for printing a message
4790 about reasons for stopping. This will print (for example) the
4791 "Breakpoint n," part of the output. The return value of this
4792 routine is one of:
4793
4794 PRINT_UNKNOWN: Means we printed nothing.
4795 PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC: Means we printed something, and expect subsequent
4796 code to print the location. An example is
4797 "Breakpoint 1, " which should be followed by
4798 the location.
4799 PRINT_SRC_ONLY: Means we printed something, but there is no need
4800 to also print the location part of the message.
4801 An example is the catch/throw messages, which
4802 don't require a location appended to the end.
4803 PRINT_NOTHING: We have done some printing and we don't need any
4804 further info to be printed. */
4805
4806enum print_stop_action
4807bpstat_print (bpstat bs, int kind)
4808{
4809 int val;
4810
4811 /* Maybe another breakpoint in the chain caused us to stop.
4812 (Currently all watchpoints go on the bpstat whether hit or not.
4813 That probably could (should) be changed, provided care is taken
4814 with respect to bpstat_explains_signal). */
4815 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
4816 {
4817 val = print_bp_stop_message (bs);
4818 if (val == PRINT_SRC_ONLY
4819 || val == PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC
4820 || val == PRINT_NOTHING)
4821 return val;
4822 }
4823
4824 /* If we had hit a shared library event breakpoint,
4825 print_bp_stop_message would print out this message. If we hit an
4826 OS-level shared library event, do the same thing. */
4827 if (kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
4828 {
4829 print_solib_event (0);
4830 return PRINT_NOTHING;
4831 }
4832
4833 /* We reached the end of the chain, or we got a null BS to start
4834 with and nothing was printed. */
4835 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
4836}
4837
4838/* Evaluate the expression EXP and return 1 if value is zero.
4839 This returns the inverse of the condition because it is called
4840 from catch_errors which returns 0 if an exception happened, and if an
4841 exception happens we want execution to stop.
4842 The argument is a "struct expression *" that has been cast to a
4843 "void *" to make it pass through catch_errors. */
4844
4845static int
4846breakpoint_cond_eval (void *exp)
4847{
4848 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
4849 int i = !value_true (evaluate_expression ((struct expression *) exp));
4850
4851 value_free_to_mark (mark);
4852 return i;
4853}
4854
4855/* Allocate a new bpstat. Link it to the FIFO list by BS_LINK_POINTER. */
4856
4857static bpstat
4858bpstat_alloc (struct bp_location *bl, bpstat **bs_link_pointer)
4859{
4860 bpstat bs;
4861
4862 bs = (bpstat) xmalloc (sizeof (*bs));
4863 bs->next = NULL;
4864 **bs_link_pointer = bs;
4865 *bs_link_pointer = &bs->next;
4866 bs->breakpoint_at = bl->owner;
4867 bs->bp_location_at = bl;
4868 incref_bp_location (bl);
4869 /* If the condition is false, etc., don't do the commands. */
4870 bs->commands = NULL;
4871 bs->old_val = NULL;
4872 bs->print_it = print_it_normal;
4873 return bs;
4874}
4875\f
4876/* The target has stopped with waitstatus WS. Check if any hardware
4877 watchpoints have triggered, according to the target. */
4878
4879int
4880watchpoints_triggered (struct target_waitstatus *ws)
4881{
4882 int stopped_by_watchpoint = target_stopped_by_watchpoint ();
4883 CORE_ADDR addr;
4884 struct breakpoint *b;
4885
4886 if (!stopped_by_watchpoint)
4887 {
4888 /* We were not stopped by a watchpoint. Mark all watchpoints
4889 as not triggered. */
4890 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4891 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4892 {
4893 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4894
4895 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4896 }
4897
4898 return 0;
4899 }
4900
4901 if (!target_stopped_data_address (&current_target, &addr))
4902 {
4903 /* We were stopped by a watchpoint, but we don't know where.
4904 Mark all watchpoints as unknown. */
4905 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4906 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4907 {
4908 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4909
4910 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_unknown;
4911 }
4912
4913 return 1;
4914 }
4915
4916 /* The target could report the data address. Mark watchpoints
4917 affected by this data address as triggered, and all others as not
4918 triggered. */
4919
4920 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
4921 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
4922 {
4923 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
4924 struct bp_location *loc;
4925
4926 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_no;
4927 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
4928 {
4929 if (is_masked_watchpoint (b))
4930 {
4931 CORE_ADDR newaddr = addr & w->hw_wp_mask;
4932 CORE_ADDR start = loc->address & w->hw_wp_mask;
4933
4934 if (newaddr == start)
4935 {
4936 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4937 break;
4938 }
4939 }
4940 /* Exact match not required. Within range is sufficient. */
4941 else if (target_watchpoint_addr_within_range (&current_target,
4942 addr, loc->address,
4943 loc->length))
4944 {
4945 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
4946 break;
4947 }
4948 }
4949 }
4950
4951 return 1;
4952}
4953
4954/* Possible return values for watchpoint_check (this can't be an enum
4955 because of check_errors). */
4956/* The watchpoint has been deleted. */
4957#define WP_DELETED 1
4958/* The value has changed. */
4959#define WP_VALUE_CHANGED 2
4960/* The value has not changed. */
4961#define WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED 3
4962/* Ignore this watchpoint, no matter if the value changed or not. */
4963#define WP_IGNORE 4
4964
4965#define BP_TEMPFLAG 1
4966#define BP_HARDWAREFLAG 2
4967
4968/* Evaluate watchpoint condition expression and check if its value
4969 changed.
4970
4971 P should be a pointer to struct bpstat, but is defined as a void *
4972 in order for this function to be usable with catch_errors. */
4973
4974static int
4975watchpoint_check (void *p)
4976{
4977 bpstat bs = (bpstat) p;
4978 struct watchpoint *b;
4979 struct frame_info *fr;
4980 int within_current_scope;
4981
4982 /* BS is built from an existing struct breakpoint. */
4983 gdb_assert (bs->breakpoint_at != NULL);
4984 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
4985
4986 /* If this is a local watchpoint, we only want to check if the
4987 watchpoint frame is in scope if the current thread is the thread
4988 that was used to create the watchpoint. */
4989 if (!watchpoint_in_thread_scope (b))
4990 return WP_IGNORE;
4991
4992 if (b->exp_valid_block == NULL)
4993 within_current_scope = 1;
4994 else
4995 {
4996 struct frame_info *frame = get_current_frame ();
4997 struct gdbarch *frame_arch = get_frame_arch (frame);
4998 CORE_ADDR frame_pc = get_frame_pc (frame);
4999
5000 /* in_function_epilogue_p() returns a non-zero value if we're
5001 still in the function but the stack frame has already been
5002 invalidated. Since we can't rely on the values of local
5003 variables after the stack has been destroyed, we are treating
5004 the watchpoint in that state as `not changed' without further
5005 checking. Don't mark watchpoints as changed if the current
5006 frame is in an epilogue - even if they are in some other
5007 frame, our view of the stack is likely to be wrong and
5008 frame_find_by_id could error out. */
5009 if (gdbarch_in_function_epilogue_p (frame_arch, frame_pc))
5010 return WP_IGNORE;
5011
5012 fr = frame_find_by_id (b->watchpoint_frame);
5013 within_current_scope = (fr != NULL);
5014
5015 /* If we've gotten confused in the unwinder, we might have
5016 returned a frame that can't describe this variable. */
5017 if (within_current_scope)
5018 {
5019 struct symbol *function;
5020
5021 function = get_frame_function (fr);
5022 if (function == NULL
5023 || !contained_in (b->exp_valid_block,
5024 SYMBOL_BLOCK_VALUE (function)))
5025 within_current_scope = 0;
5026 }
5027
5028 if (within_current_scope)
5029 /* If we end up stopping, the current frame will get selected
5030 in normal_stop. So this call to select_frame won't affect
5031 the user. */
5032 select_frame (fr);
5033 }
5034
5035 if (within_current_scope)
5036 {
5037 /* We use value_{,free_to_}mark because it could be a *long*
5038 time before we return to the command level and call
5039 free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values because we
5040 might be in the middle of evaluating a function call. */
5041
5042 int pc = 0;
5043 struct value *mark;
5044 struct value *new_val;
5045
5046 if (is_masked_watchpoint (&b->base))
5047 /* Since we don't know the exact trigger address (from
5048 stopped_data_address), just tell the user we've triggered
5049 a mask watchpoint. */
5050 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5051
5052 mark = value_mark ();
5053 fetch_subexp_value (b->exp, &pc, &new_val, NULL, NULL, 0);
5054
5055 if (b->val_bitsize != 0)
5056 new_val = extract_bitfield_from_watchpoint_value (b, new_val);
5057
5058 /* We use value_equal_contents instead of value_equal because
5059 the latter coerces an array to a pointer, thus comparing just
5060 the address of the array instead of its contents. This is
5061 not what we want. */
5062 if ((b->val != NULL) != (new_val != NULL)
5063 || (b->val != NULL && !value_equal_contents (b->val, new_val)))
5064 {
5065 if (new_val != NULL)
5066 {
5067 release_value (new_val);
5068 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5069 }
5070 bs->old_val = b->val;
5071 b->val = new_val;
5072 b->val_valid = 1;
5073 return WP_VALUE_CHANGED;
5074 }
5075 else
5076 {
5077 /* Nothing changed. */
5078 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5079 return WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED;
5080 }
5081 }
5082 else
5083 {
5084 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5085
5086 /* This seems like the only logical thing to do because
5087 if we temporarily ignored the watchpoint, then when
5088 we reenter the block in which it is valid it contains
5089 garbage (in the case of a function, it may have two
5090 garbage values, one before and one after the prologue).
5091 So we can't even detect the first assignment to it and
5092 watch after that (since the garbage may or may not equal
5093 the first value assigned). */
5094 /* We print all the stop information in
5095 breakpoint_ops->print_it, but in this case, by the time we
5096 call breakpoint_ops->print_it this bp will be deleted
5097 already. So we have no choice but print the information
5098 here. */
5099 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5100 ui_out_field_string
5101 (uiout, "reason", async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_SCOPE));
5102 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nWatchpoint ");
5103 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "wpnum", b->base.number);
5104 ui_out_text (uiout,
5105 " deleted because the program has left the block in\n\
5106which its expression is valid.\n");
5107
5108 /* Make sure the watchpoint's commands aren't executed. */
5109 decref_counted_command_line (&b->base.commands);
5110 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5111
5112 return WP_DELETED;
5113 }
5114}
5115
5116/* Return true if it looks like target has stopped due to hitting
5117 breakpoint location BL. This function does not check if we should
5118 stop, only if BL explains the stop. */
5119
5120static int
5121bpstat_check_location (const struct bp_location *bl,
5122 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
5123 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5124{
5125 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
5126
5127 /* BL is from an existing breakpoint. */
5128 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5129
5130 return b->ops->breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
5131}
5132
5133/* Determine if the watched values have actually changed, and we
5134 should stop. If not, set BS->stop to 0. */
5135
5136static void
5137bpstat_check_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
5138{
5139 const struct bp_location *bl;
5140 struct watchpoint *b;
5141
5142 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5143 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5144 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5145 b = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5146 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5147
5148 {
5149 int must_check_value = 0;
5150
5151 if (b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5152 /* For a software watchpoint, we must always check the
5153 watched value. */
5154 must_check_value = 1;
5155 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_yes)
5156 /* We have a hardware watchpoint (read, write, or access)
5157 and the target earlier reported an address watched by
5158 this watchpoint. */
5159 must_check_value = 1;
5160 else if (b->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_unknown
5161 && b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
5162 /* We were stopped by a hardware watchpoint, but the target could
5163 not report the data address. We must check the watchpoint's
5164 value. Access and read watchpoints are out of luck; without
5165 a data address, we can't figure it out. */
5166 must_check_value = 1;
5167
5168 if (must_check_value)
5169 {
5170 char *message
5171 = xstrprintf ("Error evaluating expression for watchpoint %d\n",
5172 b->base.number);
5173 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
5174 int e = catch_errors (watchpoint_check, bs, message,
5175 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5176 do_cleanups (cleanups);
5177 switch (e)
5178 {
5179 case WP_DELETED:
5180 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5181 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5182 /* Stop. */
5183 break;
5184 case WP_IGNORE:
5185 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5186 bs->stop = 0;
5187 break;
5188 case WP_VALUE_CHANGED:
5189 if (b->base.type == bp_read_watchpoint)
5190 {
5191 /* There are two cases to consider here:
5192
5193 1. We're watching the triggered memory for reads.
5194 In that case, trust the target, and always report
5195 the watchpoint hit to the user. Even though
5196 reads don't cause value changes, the value may
5197 have changed since the last time it was read, and
5198 since we're not trapping writes, we will not see
5199 those, and as such we should ignore our notion of
5200 old value.
5201
5202 2. We're watching the triggered memory for both
5203 reads and writes. There are two ways this may
5204 happen:
5205
5206 2.1. This is a target that can't break on data
5207 reads only, but can break on accesses (reads or
5208 writes), such as e.g., x86. We detect this case
5209 at the time we try to insert read watchpoints.
5210
5211 2.2. Otherwise, the target supports read
5212 watchpoints, but, the user set an access or write
5213 watchpoint watching the same memory as this read
5214 watchpoint.
5215
5216 If we're watching memory writes as well as reads,
5217 ignore watchpoint hits when we find that the
5218 value hasn't changed, as reads don't cause
5219 changes. This still gives false positives when
5220 the program writes the same value to memory as
5221 what there was already in memory (we will confuse
5222 it for a read), but it's much better than
5223 nothing. */
5224
5225 int other_write_watchpoint = 0;
5226
5227 if (bl->watchpoint_type == hw_read)
5228 {
5229 struct breakpoint *other_b;
5230
5231 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other_b)
5232 if (other_b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5233 || other_b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
5234 {
5235 struct watchpoint *other_w =
5236 (struct watchpoint *) other_b;
5237
5238 if (other_w->watchpoint_triggered
5239 == watch_triggered_yes)
5240 {
5241 other_write_watchpoint = 1;
5242 break;
5243 }
5244 }
5245 }
5246
5247 if (other_write_watchpoint
5248 || bl->watchpoint_type == hw_access)
5249 {
5250 /* We're watching the same memory for writes,
5251 and the value changed since the last time we
5252 updated it, so this trap must be for a write.
5253 Ignore it. */
5254 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5255 bs->stop = 0;
5256 }
5257 }
5258 break;
5259 case WP_VALUE_NOT_CHANGED:
5260 if (b->base.type == bp_hardware_watchpoint
5261 || b->base.type == bp_watchpoint)
5262 {
5263 /* Don't stop: write watchpoints shouldn't fire if
5264 the value hasn't changed. */
5265 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5266 bs->stop = 0;
5267 }
5268 /* Stop. */
5269 break;
5270 default:
5271 /* Can't happen. */
5272 case 0:
5273 /* Error from catch_errors. */
5274 printf_filtered (_("Watchpoint %d deleted.\n"), b->base.number);
5275 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (b);
5276 /* We've already printed what needs to be printed. */
5277 bs->print_it = print_it_done;
5278 break;
5279 }
5280 }
5281 else /* must_check_value == 0 */
5282 {
5283 /* This is a case where some watchpoint(s) triggered, but
5284 not at the address of this watchpoint, or else no
5285 watchpoint triggered after all. So don't print
5286 anything for this watchpoint. */
5287 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5288 bs->stop = 0;
5289 }
5290 }
5291}
5292
5293/* For breakpoints that are currently marked as telling gdb to stop,
5294 check conditions (condition proper, frame, thread and ignore count)
5295 of breakpoint referred to by BS. If we should not stop for this
5296 breakpoint, set BS->stop to 0. */
5297
5298static void
5299bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bpstat bs, ptid_t ptid)
5300{
5301 const struct bp_location *bl;
5302 struct breakpoint *b;
5303 int value_is_zero = 0;
5304 struct expression *cond;
5305
5306 gdb_assert (bs->stop);
5307
5308 /* BS is built for existing struct breakpoint. */
5309 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
5310 gdb_assert (bl != NULL);
5311 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5312 gdb_assert (b != NULL);
5313
5314 /* Even if the target evaluated the condition on its end and notified GDB, we
5315 need to do so again since GDB does not know if we stopped due to a
5316 breakpoint or a single step breakpoint. */
5317
5318 if (frame_id_p (b->frame_id)
5319 && !frame_id_eq (b->frame_id, get_stack_frame_id (get_current_frame ())))
5320 {
5321 bs->stop = 0;
5322 return;
5323 }
5324
5325 /* If this is a thread/task-specific breakpoint, don't waste cpu
5326 evaluating the condition if this isn't the specified
5327 thread/task. */
5328 if ((b->thread != -1 && b->thread != pid_to_thread_id (ptid))
5329 || (b->task != 0 && b->task != ada_get_task_number (ptid)))
5330
5331 {
5332 bs->stop = 0;
5333 return;
5334 }
5335
5336 /* Evaluate extension language breakpoints that have a "stop" method
5337 implemented. */
5338 bs->stop = breakpoint_ext_lang_cond_says_stop (b);
5339
5340 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5341 {
5342 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5343
5344 cond = w->cond_exp;
5345 }
5346 else
5347 cond = bl->cond;
5348
5349 if (cond && b->disposition != disp_del_at_next_stop)
5350 {
5351 int within_current_scope = 1;
5352 struct watchpoint * w;
5353
5354 /* We use value_mark and value_free_to_mark because it could
5355 be a long time before we return to the command level and
5356 call free_all_values. We can't call free_all_values
5357 because we might be in the middle of evaluating a
5358 function call. */
5359 struct value *mark = value_mark ();
5360
5361 if (is_watchpoint (b))
5362 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
5363 else
5364 w = NULL;
5365
5366 /* Need to select the frame, with all that implies so that
5367 the conditions will have the right context. Because we
5368 use the frame, we will not see an inlined function's
5369 variables when we arrive at a breakpoint at the start
5370 of the inlined function; the current frame will be the
5371 call site. */
5372 if (w == NULL || w->cond_exp_valid_block == NULL)
5373 select_frame (get_current_frame ());
5374 else
5375 {
5376 struct frame_info *frame;
5377
5378 /* For local watchpoint expressions, which particular
5379 instance of a local is being watched matters, so we
5380 keep track of the frame to evaluate the expression
5381 in. To evaluate the condition however, it doesn't
5382 really matter which instantiation of the function
5383 where the condition makes sense triggers the
5384 watchpoint. This allows an expression like "watch
5385 global if q > 10" set in `func', catch writes to
5386 global on all threads that call `func', or catch
5387 writes on all recursive calls of `func' by a single
5388 thread. We simply always evaluate the condition in
5389 the innermost frame that's executing where it makes
5390 sense to evaluate the condition. It seems
5391 intuitive. */
5392 frame = block_innermost_frame (w->cond_exp_valid_block);
5393 if (frame != NULL)
5394 select_frame (frame);
5395 else
5396 within_current_scope = 0;
5397 }
5398 if (within_current_scope)
5399 value_is_zero
5400 = catch_errors (breakpoint_cond_eval, cond,
5401 "Error in testing breakpoint condition:\n",
5402 RETURN_MASK_ALL);
5403 else
5404 {
5405 warning (_("Watchpoint condition cannot be tested "
5406 "in the current scope"));
5407 /* If we failed to set the right context for this
5408 watchpoint, unconditionally report it. */
5409 value_is_zero = 0;
5410 }
5411 /* FIXME-someday, should give breakpoint #. */
5412 value_free_to_mark (mark);
5413 }
5414
5415 if (cond && value_is_zero)
5416 {
5417 bs->stop = 0;
5418 }
5419 else if (b->ignore_count > 0)
5420 {
5421 b->ignore_count--;
5422 bs->stop = 0;
5423 /* Increase the hit count even though we don't stop. */
5424 ++(b->hit_count);
5425 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5426 }
5427}
5428
5429
5430/* Get a bpstat associated with having just stopped at address
5431 BP_ADDR in thread PTID.
5432
5433 Determine whether we stopped at a breakpoint, etc, or whether we
5434 don't understand this stop. Result is a chain of bpstat's such
5435 that:
5436
5437 if we don't understand the stop, the result is a null pointer.
5438
5439 if we understand why we stopped, the result is not null.
5440
5441 Each element of the chain refers to a particular breakpoint or
5442 watchpoint at which we have stopped. (We may have stopped for
5443 several reasons concurrently.)
5444
5445 Each element of the chain has valid next, breakpoint_at,
5446 commands, FIXME??? fields. */
5447
5448bpstat
5449bpstat_stop_status (struct address_space *aspace,
5450 CORE_ADDR bp_addr, ptid_t ptid,
5451 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
5452{
5453 struct breakpoint *b = NULL;
5454 struct bp_location *bl;
5455 struct bp_location *loc;
5456 /* First item of allocated bpstat's. */
5457 bpstat bs_head = NULL, *bs_link = &bs_head;
5458 /* Pointer to the last thing in the chain currently. */
5459 bpstat bs;
5460 int ix;
5461 int need_remove_insert;
5462 int removed_any;
5463
5464 /* First, build the bpstat chain with locations that explain a
5465 target stop, while being careful to not set the target running,
5466 as that may invalidate locations (in particular watchpoint
5467 locations are recreated). Resuming will happen here with
5468 breakpoint conditions or watchpoint expressions that include
5469 inferior function calls. */
5470
5471 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5472 {
5473 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
5474 continue;
5475
5476 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
5477 {
5478 /* For hardware watchpoints, we look only at the first
5479 location. The watchpoint_check function will work on the
5480 entire expression, not the individual locations. For
5481 read watchpoints, the watchpoints_triggered function has
5482 checked all locations already. */
5483 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint && bl != b->loc)
5484 break;
5485
5486 if (!bl->enabled || bl->shlib_disabled)
5487 continue;
5488
5489 if (!bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
5490 continue;
5491
5492 /* Come here if it's a watchpoint, or if the break address
5493 matches. */
5494
5495 bs = bpstat_alloc (bl, &bs_link); /* Alloc a bpstat to
5496 explain stop. */
5497
5498 /* Assume we stop. Should we find a watchpoint that is not
5499 actually triggered, or if the condition of the breakpoint
5500 evaluates as false, we'll reset 'stop' to 0. */
5501 bs->stop = 1;
5502 bs->print = 1;
5503
5504 /* If this is a scope breakpoint, mark the associated
5505 watchpoint as triggered so that we will handle the
5506 out-of-scope event. We'll get to the watchpoint next
5507 iteration. */
5508 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint_scope && b->related_breakpoint != b)
5509 {
5510 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b->related_breakpoint;
5511
5512 w->watchpoint_triggered = watch_triggered_yes;
5513 }
5514 }
5515 }
5516
5517 /* Check if a moribund breakpoint explains the stop. */
5518 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
5519 {
5520 if (breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, bp_addr))
5521 {
5522 bs = bpstat_alloc (loc, &bs_link);
5523 /* For hits of moribund locations, we should just proceed. */
5524 bs->stop = 0;
5525 bs->print = 0;
5526 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5527 }
5528 }
5529
5530 /* A bit of special processing for shlib breakpoints. We need to
5531 process solib loading here, so that the lists of loaded and
5532 unloaded libraries are correct before we handle "catch load" and
5533 "catch unload". */
5534 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5535 {
5536 if (bs->breakpoint_at && bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
5537 {
5538 handle_solib_event ();
5539 break;
5540 }
5541 }
5542
5543 /* Now go through the locations that caused the target to stop, and
5544 check whether we're interested in reporting this stop to higher
5545 layers, or whether we should resume the target transparently. */
5546
5547 removed_any = 0;
5548
5549 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5550 {
5551 if (!bs->stop)
5552 continue;
5553
5554 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5555 b->ops->check_status (bs);
5556 if (bs->stop)
5557 {
5558 bpstat_check_breakpoint_conditions (bs, ptid);
5559
5560 if (bs->stop)
5561 {
5562 ++(b->hit_count);
5563 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
5564
5565 /* We will stop here. */
5566 if (b->disposition == disp_disable)
5567 {
5568 --(b->enable_count);
5569 if (b->enable_count <= 0)
5570 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
5571 removed_any = 1;
5572 }
5573 if (b->silent)
5574 bs->print = 0;
5575 bs->commands = b->commands;
5576 incref_counted_command_line (bs->commands);
5577 if (command_line_is_silent (bs->commands
5578 ? bs->commands->commands : NULL))
5579 bs->print = 0;
5580
5581 b->ops->after_condition_true (bs);
5582 }
5583
5584 }
5585
5586 /* Print nothing for this entry if we don't stop or don't
5587 print. */
5588 if (!bs->stop || !bs->print)
5589 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
5590 }
5591
5592 /* If we aren't stopping, the value of some hardware watchpoint may
5593 not have changed, but the intermediate memory locations we are
5594 watching may have. Don't bother if we're stopping; this will get
5595 done later. */
5596 need_remove_insert = 0;
5597 if (! bpstat_causes_stop (bs_head))
5598 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5599 if (!bs->stop
5600 && bs->breakpoint_at
5601 && is_hardware_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at))
5602 {
5603 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
5604
5605 update_watchpoint (w, 0 /* don't reparse. */);
5606 need_remove_insert = 1;
5607 }
5608
5609 if (need_remove_insert)
5610 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
5611 else if (removed_any)
5612 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
5613
5614 return bs_head;
5615}
5616
5617static void
5618handle_jit_event (void)
5619{
5620 struct frame_info *frame;
5621 struct gdbarch *gdbarch;
5622
5623 /* Switch terminal for any messages produced by
5624 breakpoint_re_set. */
5625 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
5626
5627 frame = get_current_frame ();
5628 gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
5629
5630 jit_event_handler (gdbarch);
5631
5632 target_terminal_inferior ();
5633}
5634
5635/* Prepare WHAT final decision for infrun. */
5636
5637/* Decide what infrun needs to do with this bpstat. */
5638
5639struct bpstat_what
5640bpstat_what (bpstat bs_head)
5641{
5642 struct bpstat_what retval;
5643 int jit_event = 0;
5644 bpstat bs;
5645
5646 retval.main_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5647 retval.call_dummy = STOP_NONE;
5648 retval.is_longjmp = 0;
5649
5650 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5651 {
5652 /* Extract this BS's action. After processing each BS, we check
5653 if its action overrides all we've seem so far. */
5654 enum bpstat_what_main_action this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5655 enum bptype bptype;
5656
5657 if (bs->breakpoint_at == NULL)
5658 {
5659 /* I suspect this can happen if it was a momentary
5660 breakpoint which has since been deleted. */
5661 bptype = bp_none;
5662 }
5663 else
5664 bptype = bs->breakpoint_at->type;
5665
5666 switch (bptype)
5667 {
5668 case bp_none:
5669 break;
5670 case bp_breakpoint:
5671 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
5672 case bp_single_step:
5673 case bp_until:
5674 case bp_finish:
5675 case bp_shlib_event:
5676 if (bs->stop)
5677 {
5678 if (bs->print)
5679 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5680 else
5681 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5682 }
5683 else
5684 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5685 break;
5686 case bp_watchpoint:
5687 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
5688 case bp_read_watchpoint:
5689 case bp_access_watchpoint:
5690 if (bs->stop)
5691 {
5692 if (bs->print)
5693 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5694 else
5695 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5696 }
5697 else
5698 {
5699 /* There was a watchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5700 This requires no further action. */
5701 }
5702 break;
5703 case bp_longjmp:
5704 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
5705 case bp_exception:
5706 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SET_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5707 retval.is_longjmp = bptype != bp_exception;
5708 break;
5709 case bp_longjmp_resume:
5710 case bp_exception_resume:
5711 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_CLEAR_LONGJMP_RESUME;
5712 retval.is_longjmp = bptype == bp_longjmp_resume;
5713 break;
5714 case bp_step_resume:
5715 if (bs->stop)
5716 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STEP_RESUME;
5717 else
5718 {
5719 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5720 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5721 }
5722 break;
5723 case bp_hp_step_resume:
5724 if (bs->stop)
5725 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_HP_STEP_RESUME;
5726 else
5727 {
5728 /* It is for the wrong frame. */
5729 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5730 }
5731 break;
5732 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
5733 case bp_thread_event:
5734 case bp_overlay_event:
5735 case bp_longjmp_master:
5736 case bp_std_terminate_master:
5737 case bp_exception_master:
5738 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5739 break;
5740 case bp_catchpoint:
5741 if (bs->stop)
5742 {
5743 if (bs->print)
5744 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_NOISY;
5745 else
5746 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5747 }
5748 else
5749 {
5750 /* There was a catchpoint, but we're not stopping.
5751 This requires no further action. */
5752 }
5753 break;
5754 case bp_jit_event:
5755 jit_event = 1;
5756 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5757 break;
5758 case bp_call_dummy:
5759 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5760 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5761 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STACK_DUMMY;
5762 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5763 break;
5764 case bp_std_terminate:
5765 /* Make sure the action is stop (silent or noisy),
5766 so infrun.c pops the dummy frame. */
5767 retval.call_dummy = STOP_STD_TERMINATE;
5768 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5769 break;
5770 case bp_tracepoint:
5771 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
5772 case bp_static_tracepoint:
5773 /* Tracepoint hits should not be reported back to GDB, and
5774 if one got through somehow, it should have been filtered
5775 out already. */
5776 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5777 _("bpstat_what: tracepoint encountered"));
5778 break;
5779 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5780 /* Step over it (and insert bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return). */
5781 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5782 break;
5783 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5784 /* The breakpoint will be removed, execution will restart from the
5785 PC of the former breakpoint. */
5786 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_KEEP_CHECKING;
5787 break;
5788
5789 case bp_dprintf:
5790 if (bs->stop)
5791 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_STOP_SILENT;
5792 else
5793 this_action = BPSTAT_WHAT_SINGLE;
5794 break;
5795
5796 default:
5797 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
5798 _("bpstat_what: unhandled bptype %d"), (int) bptype);
5799 }
5800
5801 retval.main_action = max (retval.main_action, this_action);
5802 }
5803
5804 /* These operations may affect the bs->breakpoint_at state so they are
5805 delayed after MAIN_ACTION is decided above. */
5806
5807 if (jit_event)
5808 {
5809 if (debug_infrun)
5810 fprintf_unfiltered (gdb_stdlog, "bpstat_what: bp_jit_event\n");
5811
5812 handle_jit_event ();
5813 }
5814
5815 for (bs = bs_head; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5816 {
5817 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
5818
5819 if (b == NULL)
5820 continue;
5821 switch (b->type)
5822 {
5823 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
5824 gnu_ifunc_resolver_stop (b);
5825 break;
5826 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
5827 gnu_ifunc_resolver_return_stop (b);
5828 break;
5829 }
5830 }
5831
5832 return retval;
5833}
5834
5835/* Nonzero if we should step constantly (e.g. watchpoints on machines
5836 without hardware support). This isn't related to a specific bpstat,
5837 just to things like whether watchpoints are set. */
5838
5839int
5840bpstat_should_step (void)
5841{
5842 struct breakpoint *b;
5843
5844 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
5845 if (breakpoint_enabled (b) && b->type == bp_watchpoint && b->loc != NULL)
5846 return 1;
5847 return 0;
5848}
5849
5850int
5851bpstat_causes_stop (bpstat bs)
5852{
5853 for (; bs != NULL; bs = bs->next)
5854 if (bs->stop)
5855 return 1;
5856
5857 return 0;
5858}
5859
5860\f
5861
5862/* Compute a string of spaces suitable to indent the next line
5863 so it starts at the position corresponding to the table column
5864 named COL_NAME in the currently active table of UIOUT. */
5865
5866static char *
5867wrap_indent_at_field (struct ui_out *uiout, const char *col_name)
5868{
5869 static char wrap_indent[80];
5870 int i, total_width, width, align;
5871 char *text;
5872
5873 total_width = 0;
5874 for (i = 1; ui_out_query_field (uiout, i, &width, &align, &text); i++)
5875 {
5876 if (strcmp (text, col_name) == 0)
5877 {
5878 gdb_assert (total_width < sizeof wrap_indent);
5879 memset (wrap_indent, ' ', total_width);
5880 wrap_indent[total_width] = 0;
5881
5882 return wrap_indent;
5883 }
5884
5885 total_width += width + 1;
5886 }
5887
5888 return NULL;
5889}
5890
5891/* Determine if the locations of this breakpoint will have their conditions
5892 evaluated by the target, host or a mix of both. Returns the following:
5893
5894 "host": Host evals condition.
5895 "host or target": Host or Target evals condition.
5896 "target": Target evals condition.
5897*/
5898
5899static const char *
5900bp_condition_evaluator (struct breakpoint *b)
5901{
5902 struct bp_location *bl;
5903 char host_evals = 0;
5904 char target_evals = 0;
5905
5906 if (!b)
5907 return NULL;
5908
5909 if (!is_breakpoint (b))
5910 return NULL;
5911
5912 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5913 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5914 return condition_evaluation_host;
5915
5916 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
5917 {
5918 if (bl->cond_bytecode)
5919 target_evals++;
5920 else
5921 host_evals++;
5922 }
5923
5924 if (host_evals && target_evals)
5925 return condition_evaluation_both;
5926 else if (target_evals)
5927 return condition_evaluation_target;
5928 else
5929 return condition_evaluation_host;
5930}
5931
5932/* Determine the breakpoint location's condition evaluator. This is
5933 similar to bp_condition_evaluator, but for locations. */
5934
5935static const char *
5936bp_location_condition_evaluator (struct bp_location *bl)
5937{
5938 if (bl && !is_breakpoint (bl->owner))
5939 return NULL;
5940
5941 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
5942 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
5943 return condition_evaluation_host;
5944
5945 if (bl && bl->cond_bytecode)
5946 return condition_evaluation_target;
5947 else
5948 return condition_evaluation_host;
5949}
5950
5951/* Print the LOC location out of the list of B->LOC locations. */
5952
5953static void
5954print_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
5955 struct bp_location *loc)
5956{
5957 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
5958 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
5959
5960 if (loc != NULL && loc->shlib_disabled)
5961 loc = NULL;
5962
5963 if (loc != NULL)
5964 set_current_program_space (loc->pspace);
5965
5966 if (b->display_canonical)
5967 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", b->addr_string);
5968 else if (loc && loc->symtab)
5969 {
5970 struct symbol *sym
5971 = find_pc_sect_function (loc->address, loc->section);
5972 if (sym)
5973 {
5974 ui_out_text (uiout, "in ");
5975 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
5976 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
5977 ui_out_text (uiout, " ");
5978 ui_out_wrap_hint (uiout, wrap_indent_at_field (uiout, "what"));
5979 ui_out_text (uiout, "at ");
5980 }
5981 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
5982 symtab_to_filename_for_display (loc->symtab));
5983 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
5984
5985 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
5986 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname",
5987 symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab));
5988
5989 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", loc->line_number);
5990 }
5991 else if (loc)
5992 {
5993 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
5994 struct cleanup *stb_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
5995
5996 print_address_symbolic (loc->gdbarch, loc->address, stb,
5997 demangle, "");
5998 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "at", stb);
5999
6000 do_cleanups (stb_chain);
6001 }
6002 else
6003 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "pending", b->addr_string);
6004
6005 if (loc && is_breakpoint (b)
6006 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode () == condition_evaluation_target
6007 && bp_condition_evaluator (b) == condition_evaluation_both)
6008 {
6009 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6010 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6011 bp_location_condition_evaluator (loc));
6012 ui_out_text (uiout, ")");
6013 }
6014
6015 do_cleanups (old_chain);
6016}
6017
6018static const char *
6019bptype_string (enum bptype type)
6020{
6021 struct ep_type_description
6022 {
6023 enum bptype type;
6024 char *description;
6025 };
6026 static struct ep_type_description bptypes[] =
6027 {
6028 {bp_none, "?deleted?"},
6029 {bp_breakpoint, "breakpoint"},
6030 {bp_hardware_breakpoint, "hw breakpoint"},
6031 {bp_single_step, "sw single-step"},
6032 {bp_until, "until"},
6033 {bp_finish, "finish"},
6034 {bp_watchpoint, "watchpoint"},
6035 {bp_hardware_watchpoint, "hw watchpoint"},
6036 {bp_read_watchpoint, "read watchpoint"},
6037 {bp_access_watchpoint, "acc watchpoint"},
6038 {bp_longjmp, "longjmp"},
6039 {bp_longjmp_resume, "longjmp resume"},
6040 {bp_longjmp_call_dummy, "longjmp for call dummy"},
6041 {bp_exception, "exception"},
6042 {bp_exception_resume, "exception resume"},
6043 {bp_step_resume, "step resume"},
6044 {bp_hp_step_resume, "high-priority step resume"},
6045 {bp_watchpoint_scope, "watchpoint scope"},
6046 {bp_call_dummy, "call dummy"},
6047 {bp_std_terminate, "std::terminate"},
6048 {bp_shlib_event, "shlib events"},
6049 {bp_thread_event, "thread events"},
6050 {bp_overlay_event, "overlay events"},
6051 {bp_longjmp_master, "longjmp master"},
6052 {bp_std_terminate_master, "std::terminate master"},
6053 {bp_exception_master, "exception master"},
6054 {bp_catchpoint, "catchpoint"},
6055 {bp_tracepoint, "tracepoint"},
6056 {bp_fast_tracepoint, "fast tracepoint"},
6057 {bp_static_tracepoint, "static tracepoint"},
6058 {bp_dprintf, "dprintf"},
6059 {bp_jit_event, "jit events"},
6060 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver"},
6061 {bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return, "STT_GNU_IFUNC resolver return"},
6062 };
6063
6064 if (((int) type >= (sizeof (bptypes) / sizeof (bptypes[0])))
6065 || ((int) type != bptypes[(int) type].type))
6066 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6067 _("bptypes table does not describe type #%d."),
6068 (int) type);
6069
6070 return bptypes[(int) type].description;
6071}
6072
6073/* For MI, output a field named 'thread-groups' with a list as the value.
6074 For CLI, prefix the list with the string 'inf'. */
6075
6076static void
6077output_thread_groups (struct ui_out *uiout,
6078 const char *field_name,
6079 VEC(int) *inf_num,
6080 int mi_only)
6081{
6082 struct cleanup *back_to;
6083 int is_mi = ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout);
6084 int inf;
6085 int i;
6086
6087 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6088 there are several. Always display them for MI. */
6089 if (!is_mi && mi_only)
6090 return;
6091
6092 back_to = make_cleanup_ui_out_list_begin_end (uiout, field_name);
6093
6094 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (int, inf_num, i, inf); ++i)
6095 {
6096 if (is_mi)
6097 {
6098 char mi_group[10];
6099
6100 xsnprintf (mi_group, sizeof (mi_group), "i%d", inf);
6101 ui_out_field_string (uiout, NULL, mi_group);
6102 }
6103 else
6104 {
6105 if (i == 0)
6106 ui_out_text (uiout, " inf ");
6107 else
6108 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
6109
6110 ui_out_text (uiout, plongest (inf));
6111 }
6112 }
6113
6114 do_cleanups (back_to);
6115}
6116
6117/* Print B to gdb_stdout. */
6118
6119static void
6120print_one_breakpoint_location (struct breakpoint *b,
6121 struct bp_location *loc,
6122 int loc_number,
6123 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6124 int allflag)
6125{
6126 struct command_line *l;
6127 static char bpenables[] = "nynny";
6128
6129 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6130 int header_of_multiple = 0;
6131 int part_of_multiple = (loc != NULL);
6132 struct value_print_options opts;
6133
6134 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6135
6136 gdb_assert (!loc || loc_number != 0);
6137 /* See comment in print_one_breakpoint concerning treatment of
6138 breakpoints with single disabled location. */
6139 if (loc == NULL
6140 && (b->loc != NULL
6141 && (b->loc->next != NULL || !b->loc->enabled)))
6142 header_of_multiple = 1;
6143 if (loc == NULL)
6144 loc = b->loc;
6145
6146 annotate_record ();
6147
6148 /* 1 */
6149 annotate_field (0);
6150 if (part_of_multiple)
6151 {
6152 char *formatted;
6153 formatted = xstrprintf ("%d.%d", b->number, loc_number);
6154 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "number", formatted);
6155 xfree (formatted);
6156 }
6157 else
6158 {
6159 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
6160 }
6161
6162 /* 2 */
6163 annotate_field (1);
6164 if (part_of_multiple)
6165 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "type");
6166 else
6167 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "type", bptype_string (b->type));
6168
6169 /* 3 */
6170 annotate_field (2);
6171 if (part_of_multiple)
6172 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "disp");
6173 else
6174 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
6175
6176
6177 /* 4 */
6178 annotate_field (3);
6179 if (part_of_multiple)
6180 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "enabled", loc->enabled ? "y" : "n");
6181 else
6182 ui_out_field_fmt (uiout, "enabled", "%c",
6183 bpenables[(int) b->enable_state]);
6184 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 2);
6185
6186
6187 /* 5 and 6 */
6188 if (b->ops != NULL && b->ops->print_one != NULL)
6189 {
6190 /* Although the print_one can possibly print all locations,
6191 calling it here is not likely to get any nice result. So,
6192 make sure there's just one location. */
6193 gdb_assert (b->loc == NULL || b->loc->next == NULL);
6194 b->ops->print_one (b, last_loc);
6195 }
6196 else
6197 switch (b->type)
6198 {
6199 case bp_none:
6200 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
6201 _("print_one_breakpoint: bp_none encountered\n"));
6202 break;
6203
6204 case bp_watchpoint:
6205 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
6206 case bp_read_watchpoint:
6207 case bp_access_watchpoint:
6208 {
6209 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6210
6211 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
6212 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
6213 is relatively readable). */
6214 if (opts.addressprint)
6215 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
6216 annotate_field (5);
6217 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", w->exp_string);
6218 }
6219 break;
6220
6221 case bp_breakpoint:
6222 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
6223 case bp_single_step:
6224 case bp_until:
6225 case bp_finish:
6226 case bp_longjmp:
6227 case bp_longjmp_resume:
6228 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
6229 case bp_exception:
6230 case bp_exception_resume:
6231 case bp_step_resume:
6232 case bp_hp_step_resume:
6233 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
6234 case bp_call_dummy:
6235 case bp_std_terminate:
6236 case bp_shlib_event:
6237 case bp_thread_event:
6238 case bp_overlay_event:
6239 case bp_longjmp_master:
6240 case bp_std_terminate_master:
6241 case bp_exception_master:
6242 case bp_tracepoint:
6243 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
6244 case bp_static_tracepoint:
6245 case bp_dprintf:
6246 case bp_jit_event:
6247 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
6248 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
6249 if (opts.addressprint)
6250 {
6251 annotate_field (4);
6252 if (header_of_multiple)
6253 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<MULTIPLE>");
6254 else if (b->loc == NULL || loc->shlib_disabled)
6255 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "addr", "<PENDING>");
6256 else
6257 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "addr",
6258 loc->gdbarch, loc->address);
6259 }
6260 annotate_field (5);
6261 if (!header_of_multiple)
6262 print_breakpoint_location (b, loc);
6263 if (b->loc)
6264 *last_loc = b->loc;
6265 break;
6266 }
6267
6268
6269 if (loc != NULL && !header_of_multiple)
6270 {
6271 struct inferior *inf;
6272 VEC(int) *inf_num = NULL;
6273 int mi_only = 1;
6274
6275 ALL_INFERIORS (inf)
6276 {
6277 if (inf->pspace == loc->pspace)
6278 VEC_safe_push (int, inf_num, inf->num);
6279 }
6280
6281 /* For backward compatibility, don't display inferiors in CLI unless
6282 there are several. Always display for MI. */
6283 if (allflag
6284 || (!gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6285 && (number_of_program_spaces () > 1
6286 || number_of_inferiors () > 1)
6287 /* LOC is for existing B, it cannot be in
6288 moribund_locations and thus having NULL OWNER. */
6289 && loc->owner->type != bp_catchpoint))
6290 mi_only = 0;
6291 output_thread_groups (uiout, "thread-groups", inf_num, mi_only);
6292 VEC_free (int, inf_num);
6293 }
6294
6295 if (!part_of_multiple)
6296 {
6297 if (b->thread != -1)
6298 {
6299 /* FIXME: This seems to be redundant and lost here; see the
6300 "stop only in" line a little further down. */
6301 ui_out_text (uiout, " thread ");
6302 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6303 }
6304 else if (b->task != 0)
6305 {
6306 ui_out_text (uiout, " task ");
6307 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "task", b->task);
6308 }
6309 }
6310
6311 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6312
6313 if (!part_of_multiple)
6314 b->ops->print_one_detail (b, uiout);
6315
6316 if (part_of_multiple && frame_id_p (b->frame_id))
6317 {
6318 annotate_field (6);
6319 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in stack frame at ");
6320 /* FIXME: cagney/2002-12-01: Shouldn't be poking around inside
6321 the frame ID. */
6322 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "frame",
6323 b->gdbarch, b->frame_id.stack_addr);
6324 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6325 }
6326
6327 if (!part_of_multiple && b->cond_string)
6328 {
6329 annotate_field (7);
6330 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6331 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace only if ");
6332 else
6333 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only if ");
6334 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "cond", b->cond_string);
6335
6336 /* Print whether the target is doing the breakpoint's condition
6337 evaluation. If GDB is doing the evaluation, don't print anything. */
6338 if (is_breakpoint (b)
6339 && breakpoint_condition_evaluation_mode ()
6340 == condition_evaluation_target)
6341 {
6342 ui_out_text (uiout, " (");
6343 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "evaluated-by",
6344 bp_condition_evaluator (b));
6345 ui_out_text (uiout, " evals)");
6346 }
6347 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6348 }
6349
6350 if (!part_of_multiple && b->thread != -1)
6351 {
6352 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6353 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tstop only in thread ");
6354 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "thread", b->thread);
6355 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
6356 }
6357
6358 if (!part_of_multiple)
6359 {
6360 if (b->hit_count)
6361 {
6362 /* FIXME should make an annotation for this. */
6363 if (is_catchpoint (b))
6364 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tcatchpoint");
6365 else if (is_tracepoint (b))
6366 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttracepoint");
6367 else
6368 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tbreakpoint");
6369 ui_out_text (uiout, " already hit ");
6370 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6371 if (b->hit_count == 1)
6372 ui_out_text (uiout, " time\n");
6373 else
6374 ui_out_text (uiout, " times\n");
6375 }
6376 else
6377 {
6378 /* Output the count also if it is zero, but only if this is mi. */
6379 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6380 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "times", b->hit_count);
6381 }
6382 }
6383
6384 if (!part_of_multiple && b->ignore_count)
6385 {
6386 annotate_field (8);
6387 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tignore next ");
6388 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "ignore", b->ignore_count);
6389 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6390 }
6391
6392 /* Note that an enable count of 1 corresponds to "enable once"
6393 behavior, which is reported by the combination of enablement and
6394 disposition, so we don't need to mention it here. */
6395 if (!part_of_multiple && b->enable_count > 1)
6396 {
6397 annotate_field (8);
6398 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tdisable after ");
6399 /* Tweak the wording to clarify that ignore and enable counts
6400 are distinct, and have additive effect. */
6401 if (b->ignore_count)
6402 ui_out_text (uiout, "additional ");
6403 else
6404 ui_out_text (uiout, "next ");
6405 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "enable", b->enable_count);
6406 ui_out_text (uiout, " hits\n");
6407 }
6408
6409 if (!part_of_multiple && is_tracepoint (b))
6410 {
6411 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6412
6413 if (tp->traceframe_usage)
6414 {
6415 ui_out_text (uiout, "\ttrace buffer usage ");
6416 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "traceframe-usage", tp->traceframe_usage);
6417 ui_out_text (uiout, " bytes\n");
6418 }
6419 }
6420
6421 l = b->commands ? b->commands->commands : NULL;
6422 if (!part_of_multiple && l)
6423 {
6424 struct cleanup *script_chain;
6425
6426 annotate_field (9);
6427 script_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "script");
6428 print_command_lines (uiout, l, 4);
6429 do_cleanups (script_chain);
6430 }
6431
6432 if (is_tracepoint (b))
6433 {
6434 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
6435
6436 if (!part_of_multiple && t->pass_count)
6437 {
6438 annotate_field (10);
6439 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tpass count ");
6440 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "pass", t->pass_count);
6441 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6442 }
6443
6444 /* Don't display it when tracepoint or tracepoint location is
6445 pending. */
6446 if (!header_of_multiple && loc != NULL && !loc->shlib_disabled)
6447 {
6448 annotate_field (11);
6449
6450 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
6451 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "installed",
6452 loc->inserted ? "y" : "n");
6453 else
6454 {
6455 if (loc->inserted)
6456 ui_out_text (uiout, "\t");
6457 else
6458 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tnot ");
6459 ui_out_text (uiout, "installed on target\n");
6460 }
6461 }
6462 }
6463
6464 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout) && !part_of_multiple)
6465 {
6466 if (is_watchpoint (b))
6467 {
6468 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
6469
6470 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", w->exp_string);
6471 }
6472 else if (b->addr_string)
6473 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "original-location", b->addr_string);
6474 }
6475}
6476
6477static void
6478print_one_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
6479 struct bp_location **last_loc,
6480 int allflag)
6481{
6482 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain;
6483 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6484
6485 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "bkpt");
6486
6487 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, NULL, 0, last_loc, allflag);
6488 do_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
6489
6490 /* If this breakpoint has custom print function,
6491 it's already printed. Otherwise, print individual
6492 locations, if any. */
6493 if (b->ops == NULL || b->ops->print_one == NULL)
6494 {
6495 /* If breakpoint has a single location that is disabled, we
6496 print it as if it had several locations, since otherwise it's
6497 hard to represent "breakpoint enabled, location disabled"
6498 situation.
6499
6500 Note that while hardware watchpoints have several locations
6501 internally, that's not a property exposed to user. */
6502 if (b->loc
6503 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
6504 && (b->loc->next || !b->loc->enabled))
6505 {
6506 struct bp_location *loc;
6507 int n = 1;
6508
6509 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next, ++n)
6510 {
6511 struct cleanup *inner2 =
6512 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, NULL);
6513 print_one_breakpoint_location (b, loc, n, last_loc, allflag);
6514 do_cleanups (inner2);
6515 }
6516 }
6517 }
6518}
6519
6520static int
6521breakpoint_address_bits (struct breakpoint *b)
6522{
6523 int print_address_bits = 0;
6524 struct bp_location *loc;
6525
6526 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
6527 {
6528 int addr_bit;
6529
6530 /* Software watchpoints that aren't watching memory don't have
6531 an address to print. */
6532 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && loc->watchpoint_type == -1)
6533 continue;
6534
6535 addr_bit = gdbarch_addr_bit (loc->gdbarch);
6536 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6537 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6538 }
6539
6540 return print_address_bits;
6541}
6542
6543struct captured_breakpoint_query_args
6544 {
6545 int bnum;
6546 };
6547
6548static int
6549do_captured_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, void *data)
6550{
6551 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args *args = data;
6552 struct breakpoint *b;
6553 struct bp_location *dummy_loc = NULL;
6554
6555 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6556 {
6557 if (args->bnum == b->number)
6558 {
6559 print_one_breakpoint (b, &dummy_loc, 0);
6560 return GDB_RC_OK;
6561 }
6562 }
6563 return GDB_RC_NONE;
6564}
6565
6566enum gdb_rc
6567gdb_breakpoint_query (struct ui_out *uiout, int bnum,
6568 char **error_message)
6569{
6570 struct captured_breakpoint_query_args args;
6571
6572 args.bnum = bnum;
6573 /* For the moment we don't trust print_one_breakpoint() to not throw
6574 an error. */
6575 if (catch_exceptions_with_msg (uiout, do_captured_breakpoint_query, &args,
6576 error_message, RETURN_MASK_ALL) < 0)
6577 return GDB_RC_FAIL;
6578 else
6579 return GDB_RC_OK;
6580}
6581
6582/* Return true if this breakpoint was set by the user, false if it is
6583 internal or momentary. */
6584
6585int
6586user_breakpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
6587{
6588 return b->number > 0;
6589}
6590
6591/* Print information on user settable breakpoint (watchpoint, etc)
6592 number BNUM. If BNUM is -1 print all user-settable breakpoints.
6593 If ALLFLAG is non-zero, include non-user-settable breakpoints. If
6594 FILTER is non-NULL, call it on each breakpoint and only include the
6595 ones for which it returns non-zero. Return the total number of
6596 breakpoints listed. */
6597
6598static int
6599breakpoint_1 (char *args, int allflag,
6600 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
6601{
6602 struct breakpoint *b;
6603 struct bp_location *last_loc = NULL;
6604 int nr_printable_breakpoints;
6605 struct cleanup *bkpttbl_chain;
6606 struct value_print_options opts;
6607 int print_address_bits = 0;
6608 int print_type_col_width = 14;
6609 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6610
6611 get_user_print_options (&opts);
6612
6613 /* Compute the number of rows in the table, as well as the size
6614 required for address fields. */
6615 nr_printable_breakpoints = 0;
6616 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6617 {
6618 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6619 if (filter && !filter (b))
6620 continue;
6621
6622 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6623 accept. Skip the others. */
6624 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6625 {
6626 if (allflag && parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6627 continue;
6628 if (!allflag && !number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6629 continue;
6630 }
6631
6632 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6633 {
6634 int addr_bit, type_len;
6635
6636 addr_bit = breakpoint_address_bits (b);
6637 if (addr_bit > print_address_bits)
6638 print_address_bits = addr_bit;
6639
6640 type_len = strlen (bptype_string (b->type));
6641 if (type_len > print_type_col_width)
6642 print_type_col_width = type_len;
6643
6644 nr_printable_breakpoints++;
6645 }
6646 }
6647
6648 if (opts.addressprint)
6649 bkpttbl_chain
6650 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 6,
6651 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6652 "BreakpointTable");
6653 else
6654 bkpttbl_chain
6655 = make_cleanup_ui_out_table_begin_end (uiout, 5,
6656 nr_printable_breakpoints,
6657 "BreakpointTable");
6658
6659 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6660 annotate_breakpoints_headers ();
6661 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6662 annotate_field (0);
6663 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 7, ui_left, "number", "Num"); /* 1 */
6664 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6665 annotate_field (1);
6666 ui_out_table_header (uiout, print_type_col_width, ui_left,
6667 "type", "Type"); /* 2 */
6668 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6669 annotate_field (2);
6670 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 4, ui_left, "disp", "Disp"); /* 3 */
6671 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6672 annotate_field (3);
6673 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 3, ui_left, "enabled", "Enb"); /* 4 */
6674 if (opts.addressprint)
6675 {
6676 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6677 annotate_field (4);
6678 if (print_address_bits <= 32)
6679 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 10, ui_left,
6680 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6681 else
6682 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 18, ui_left,
6683 "addr", "Address"); /* 5 */
6684 }
6685 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6686 annotate_field (5);
6687 ui_out_table_header (uiout, 40, ui_noalign, "what", "What"); /* 6 */
6688 ui_out_table_body (uiout);
6689 if (nr_printable_breakpoints > 0)
6690 annotate_breakpoints_table ();
6691
6692 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6693 {
6694 QUIT;
6695 /* If we have a filter, only list the breakpoints it accepts. */
6696 if (filter && !filter (b))
6697 continue;
6698
6699 /* If we have an "args" string, it is a list of breakpoints to
6700 accept. Skip the others. */
6701
6702 if (args != NULL && *args != '\0')
6703 {
6704 if (allflag) /* maintenance info breakpoint */
6705 {
6706 if (parse_and_eval_long (args) != b->number)
6707 continue;
6708 }
6709 else /* all others */
6710 {
6711 if (!number_is_in_list (args, b->number))
6712 continue;
6713 }
6714 }
6715 /* We only print out user settable breakpoints unless the
6716 allflag is set. */
6717 if (allflag || user_breakpoint_p (b))
6718 print_one_breakpoint (b, &last_loc, allflag);
6719 }
6720
6721 do_cleanups (bkpttbl_chain);
6722
6723 if (nr_printable_breakpoints == 0)
6724 {
6725 /* If there's a filter, let the caller decide how to report
6726 empty list. */
6727 if (!filter)
6728 {
6729 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6730 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No breakpoints or watchpoints.\n");
6731 else
6732 ui_out_message (uiout, 0,
6733 "No breakpoint or watchpoint matching '%s'.\n",
6734 args);
6735 }
6736 }
6737 else
6738 {
6739 if (last_loc && !server_command)
6740 set_next_address (last_loc->gdbarch, last_loc->address);
6741 }
6742
6743 /* FIXME? Should this be moved up so that it is only called when
6744 there have been breakpoints? */
6745 annotate_breakpoints_table_end ();
6746
6747 return nr_printable_breakpoints;
6748}
6749
6750/* Display the value of default-collect in a way that is generally
6751 compatible with the breakpoint list. */
6752
6753static void
6754default_collect_info (void)
6755{
6756 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6757
6758 /* If it has no value (which is frequently the case), say nothing; a
6759 message like "No default-collect." gets in user's face when it's
6760 not wanted. */
6761 if (!*default_collect)
6762 return;
6763
6764 /* The following phrase lines up nicely with per-tracepoint collect
6765 actions. */
6766 ui_out_text (uiout, "default collect ");
6767 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "default-collect", default_collect);
6768 ui_out_text (uiout, " \n");
6769}
6770
6771static void
6772breakpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
6773{
6774 breakpoint_1 (args, 0, NULL);
6775
6776 default_collect_info ();
6777}
6778
6779static void
6780watchpoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
6781{
6782 int num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_watchpoint);
6783 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
6784
6785 if (num_printed == 0)
6786 {
6787 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
6788 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoints.\n");
6789 else
6790 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No watchpoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
6791 }
6792}
6793
6794static void
6795maintenance_info_breakpoints (char *args, int from_tty)
6796{
6797 breakpoint_1 (args, 1, NULL);
6798
6799 default_collect_info ();
6800}
6801
6802static int
6803breakpoint_has_pc (struct breakpoint *b,
6804 struct program_space *pspace,
6805 CORE_ADDR pc, struct obj_section *section)
6806{
6807 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
6808
6809 for (; bl; bl = bl->next)
6810 {
6811 if (bl->pspace == pspace
6812 && bl->address == pc
6813 && (!overlay_debugging || bl->section == section))
6814 return 1;
6815 }
6816 return 0;
6817}
6818
6819/* Print a message describing any user-breakpoints set at PC. This
6820 concerns with logical breakpoints, so we match program spaces, not
6821 address spaces. */
6822
6823static void
6824describe_other_breakpoints (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
6825 struct program_space *pspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
6826 struct obj_section *section, int thread)
6827{
6828 int others = 0;
6829 struct breakpoint *b;
6830
6831 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6832 others += (user_breakpoint_p (b)
6833 && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section));
6834 if (others > 0)
6835 {
6836 if (others == 1)
6837 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoint "));
6838 else /* if (others == ???) */
6839 printf_filtered (_("Note: breakpoints "));
6840 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
6841 if (user_breakpoint_p (b) && breakpoint_has_pc (b, pspace, pc, section))
6842 {
6843 others--;
6844 printf_filtered ("%d", b->number);
6845 if (b->thread == -1 && thread != -1)
6846 printf_filtered (" (all threads)");
6847 else if (b->thread != -1)
6848 printf_filtered (" (thread %d)", b->thread);
6849 printf_filtered ("%s%s ",
6850 ((b->enable_state == bp_disabled
6851 || b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
6852 ? " (disabled)"
6853 : ""),
6854 (others > 1) ? ","
6855 : ((others == 1) ? " and" : ""));
6856 }
6857 printf_filtered (_("also set at pc "));
6858 fputs_filtered (paddress (gdbarch, pc), gdb_stdout);
6859 printf_filtered (".\n");
6860 }
6861}
6862\f
6863
6864/* Return true iff it is meaningful to use the address member of
6865 BPT. For some breakpoint types, the address member is irrelevant
6866 and it makes no sense to attempt to compare it to other addresses
6867 (or use it for any other purpose either).
6868
6869 More specifically, each of the following breakpoint types will
6870 always have a zero valued address and we don't want to mark
6871 breakpoints of any of these types to be a duplicate of an actual
6872 breakpoint at address zero:
6873
6874 bp_watchpoint
6875 bp_catchpoint
6876
6877*/
6878
6879static int
6880breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (struct breakpoint *bpt)
6881{
6882 enum bptype type = bpt->type;
6883
6884 return (type != bp_watchpoint && type != bp_catchpoint);
6885}
6886
6887/* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's owners are hardware watchpoints, returns
6888 true if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same watchpoint location. */
6889
6890static int
6891watchpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6892 struct bp_location *loc2)
6893{
6894 struct watchpoint *w1 = (struct watchpoint *) loc1->owner;
6895 struct watchpoint *w2 = (struct watchpoint *) loc2->owner;
6896
6897 /* Both of them must exist. */
6898 gdb_assert (w1 != NULL);
6899 gdb_assert (w2 != NULL);
6900
6901 /* If the target can evaluate the condition expression in hardware,
6902 then we we need to insert both watchpoints even if they are at
6903 the same place. Otherwise the watchpoint will only trigger when
6904 the condition of whichever watchpoint was inserted evaluates to
6905 true, not giving a chance for GDB to check the condition of the
6906 other watchpoint. */
6907 if ((w1->cond_exp
6908 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc1->address,
6909 loc1->length,
6910 loc1->watchpoint_type,
6911 w1->cond_exp))
6912 || (w2->cond_exp
6913 && target_can_accel_watchpoint_condition (loc2->address,
6914 loc2->length,
6915 loc2->watchpoint_type,
6916 w2->cond_exp)))
6917 return 0;
6918
6919 /* Note that this checks the owner's type, not the location's. In
6920 case the target does not support read watchpoints, but does
6921 support access watchpoints, we'll have bp_read_watchpoint
6922 watchpoints with hw_access locations. Those should be considered
6923 duplicates of hw_read locations. The hw_read locations will
6924 become hw_access locations later. */
6925 return (loc1->owner->type == loc2->owner->type
6926 && loc1->pspace->aspace == loc2->pspace->aspace
6927 && loc1->address == loc2->address
6928 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
6929}
6930
6931/* See breakpoint.h. */
6932
6933int
6934breakpoint_address_match (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6935 struct address_space *aspace2, CORE_ADDR addr2)
6936{
6937 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6938 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6939 && addr1 == addr2);
6940}
6941
6942/* Returns true if {ASPACE2,ADDR2} falls within the range determined by
6943 {ASPACE1,ADDR1,LEN1}. In most targets, this can only be true if ASPACE1
6944 matches ASPACE2. On targets that have global breakpoints, the address
6945 space doesn't really matter. */
6946
6947static int
6948breakpoint_address_match_range (struct address_space *aspace1, CORE_ADDR addr1,
6949 int len1, struct address_space *aspace2,
6950 CORE_ADDR addr2)
6951{
6952 return ((gdbarch_has_global_breakpoints (target_gdbarch ())
6953 || aspace1 == aspace2)
6954 && addr2 >= addr1 && addr2 < addr1 + len1);
6955}
6956
6957/* Returns true if {ASPACE,ADDR} matches the breakpoint BL. BL may be
6958 a ranged breakpoint. In most targets, a match happens only if ASPACE
6959 matches the breakpoint's address space. On targets that have global
6960 breakpoints, the address space doesn't really matter. */
6961
6962static int
6963breakpoint_location_address_match (struct bp_location *bl,
6964 struct address_space *aspace,
6965 CORE_ADDR addr)
6966{
6967 return (breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
6968 aspace, addr)
6969 || (bl->length
6970 && breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace,
6971 bl->address, bl->length,
6972 aspace, addr)));
6973}
6974
6975/* If LOC1 and LOC2's owners are not tracepoints, returns false directly.
6976 Then, if LOC1 and LOC2 represent the same tracepoint location, returns
6977 true, otherwise returns false. */
6978
6979static int
6980tracepoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6981 struct bp_location *loc2)
6982{
6983 if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) && is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
6984 /* Since tracepoint locations are never duplicated with others', tracepoint
6985 locations at the same address of different tracepoints are regarded as
6986 different locations. */
6987 return (loc1->address == loc2->address && loc1->owner == loc2->owner);
6988 else
6989 return 0;
6990}
6991
6992/* Assuming LOC1 and LOC2's types' have meaningful target addresses
6993 (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful), returns true if LOC1 and LOC2
6994 represent the same location. */
6995
6996static int
6997breakpoint_locations_match (struct bp_location *loc1,
6998 struct bp_location *loc2)
6999{
7000 int hw_point1, hw_point2;
7001
7002 /* Both of them must not be in moribund_locations. */
7003 gdb_assert (loc1->owner != NULL);
7004 gdb_assert (loc2->owner != NULL);
7005
7006 hw_point1 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc1->owner);
7007 hw_point2 = is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner);
7008
7009 if (hw_point1 != hw_point2)
7010 return 0;
7011 else if (hw_point1)
7012 return watchpoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7013 else if (is_tracepoint (loc1->owner) || is_tracepoint (loc2->owner))
7014 return tracepoint_locations_match (loc1, loc2);
7015 else
7016 /* We compare bp_location.length in order to cover ranged breakpoints. */
7017 return (breakpoint_address_match (loc1->pspace->aspace, loc1->address,
7018 loc2->pspace->aspace, loc2->address)
7019 && loc1->length == loc2->length);
7020}
7021
7022static void
7023breakpoint_adjustment_warning (CORE_ADDR from_addr, CORE_ADDR to_addr,
7024 int bnum, int have_bnum)
7025{
7026 /* The longest string possibly returned by hex_string_custom
7027 is 50 chars. These must be at least that big for safety. */
7028 char astr1[64];
7029 char astr2[64];
7030
7031 strcpy (astr1, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) from_addr, 8));
7032 strcpy (astr2, hex_string_custom ((unsigned long) to_addr, 8));
7033 if (have_bnum)
7034 warning (_("Breakpoint %d address previously adjusted from %s to %s."),
7035 bnum, astr1, astr2);
7036 else
7037 warning (_("Breakpoint address adjusted from %s to %s."), astr1, astr2);
7038}
7039
7040/* Adjust a breakpoint's address to account for architectural
7041 constraints on breakpoint placement. Return the adjusted address.
7042 Note: Very few targets require this kind of adjustment. For most
7043 targets, this function is simply the identity function. */
7044
7045static CORE_ADDR
7046adjust_breakpoint_address (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7047 CORE_ADDR bpaddr, enum bptype bptype)
7048{
7049 if (!gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address_p (gdbarch))
7050 {
7051 /* Very few targets need any kind of breakpoint adjustment. */
7052 return bpaddr;
7053 }
7054 else if (bptype == bp_watchpoint
7055 || bptype == bp_hardware_watchpoint
7056 || bptype == bp_read_watchpoint
7057 || bptype == bp_access_watchpoint
7058 || bptype == bp_catchpoint)
7059 {
7060 /* Watchpoints and the various bp_catch_* eventpoints should not
7061 have their addresses modified. */
7062 return bpaddr;
7063 }
7064 else if (bptype == bp_single_step)
7065 {
7066 /* Single-step breakpoints should not have their addresses
7067 modified. If there's any architectural constrain that
7068 applies to this address, then it should have already been
7069 taken into account when the breakpoint was created in the
7070 first place. If we didn't do this, stepping through e.g.,
7071 Thumb-2 IT blocks would break. */
7072 return bpaddr;
7073 }
7074 else
7075 {
7076 CORE_ADDR adjusted_bpaddr;
7077
7078 /* Some targets have architectural constraints on the placement
7079 of breakpoint instructions. Obtain the adjusted address. */
7080 adjusted_bpaddr = gdbarch_adjust_breakpoint_address (gdbarch, bpaddr);
7081
7082 /* An adjusted breakpoint address can significantly alter
7083 a user's expectations. Print a warning if an adjustment
7084 is required. */
7085 if (adjusted_bpaddr != bpaddr)
7086 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bpaddr, adjusted_bpaddr, 0, 0);
7087
7088 return adjusted_bpaddr;
7089 }
7090}
7091
7092void
7093init_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc, const struct bp_location_ops *ops,
7094 struct breakpoint *owner)
7095{
7096 memset (loc, 0, sizeof (*loc));
7097
7098 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7099
7100 loc->ops = ops;
7101 loc->owner = owner;
7102 loc->cond = NULL;
7103 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
7104 loc->shlib_disabled = 0;
7105 loc->enabled = 1;
7106
7107 switch (owner->type)
7108 {
7109 case bp_breakpoint:
7110 case bp_single_step:
7111 case bp_until:
7112 case bp_finish:
7113 case bp_longjmp:
7114 case bp_longjmp_resume:
7115 case bp_longjmp_call_dummy:
7116 case bp_exception:
7117 case bp_exception_resume:
7118 case bp_step_resume:
7119 case bp_hp_step_resume:
7120 case bp_watchpoint_scope:
7121 case bp_call_dummy:
7122 case bp_std_terminate:
7123 case bp_shlib_event:
7124 case bp_thread_event:
7125 case bp_overlay_event:
7126 case bp_jit_event:
7127 case bp_longjmp_master:
7128 case bp_std_terminate_master:
7129 case bp_exception_master:
7130 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
7131 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver_return:
7132 case bp_dprintf:
7133 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_software_breakpoint;
7134 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7135 break;
7136 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
7137 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint;
7138 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7139 break;
7140 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
7141 case bp_read_watchpoint:
7142 case bp_access_watchpoint:
7143 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint;
7144 break;
7145 case bp_watchpoint:
7146 case bp_catchpoint:
7147 case bp_tracepoint:
7148 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
7149 case bp_static_tracepoint:
7150 loc->loc_type = bp_loc_other;
7151 break;
7152 default:
7153 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__, _("unknown breakpoint type"));
7154 }
7155
7156 loc->refc = 1;
7157}
7158
7159/* Allocate a struct bp_location. */
7160
7161static struct bp_location *
7162allocate_bp_location (struct breakpoint *bpt)
7163{
7164 return bpt->ops->allocate_location (bpt);
7165}
7166
7167static void
7168free_bp_location (struct bp_location *loc)
7169{
7170 loc->ops->dtor (loc);
7171 xfree (loc);
7172}
7173
7174/* Increment reference count. */
7175
7176static void
7177incref_bp_location (struct bp_location *bl)
7178{
7179 ++bl->refc;
7180}
7181
7182/* Decrement reference count. If the reference count reaches 0,
7183 destroy the bp_location. Sets *BLP to NULL. */
7184
7185static void
7186decref_bp_location (struct bp_location **blp)
7187{
7188 gdb_assert ((*blp)->refc > 0);
7189
7190 if (--(*blp)->refc == 0)
7191 free_bp_location (*blp);
7192 *blp = NULL;
7193}
7194
7195/* Add breakpoint B at the end of the global breakpoint chain. */
7196
7197static void
7198add_to_breakpoint_chain (struct breakpoint *b)
7199{
7200 struct breakpoint *b1;
7201
7202 /* Add this breakpoint to the end of the chain so that a list of
7203 breakpoints will come out in order of increasing numbers. */
7204
7205 b1 = breakpoint_chain;
7206 if (b1 == 0)
7207 breakpoint_chain = b;
7208 else
7209 {
7210 while (b1->next)
7211 b1 = b1->next;
7212 b1->next = b;
7213 }
7214}
7215
7216/* Initializes breakpoint B with type BPTYPE and no locations yet. */
7217
7218static void
7219init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct breakpoint *b,
7220 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7221 enum bptype bptype,
7222 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7223{
7224 memset (b, 0, sizeof (*b));
7225
7226 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
7227
7228 b->ops = ops;
7229 b->type = bptype;
7230 b->gdbarch = gdbarch;
7231 b->language = current_language->la_language;
7232 b->input_radix = input_radix;
7233 b->thread = -1;
7234 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7235 b->next = 0;
7236 b->silent = 0;
7237 b->ignore_count = 0;
7238 b->commands = NULL;
7239 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
7240 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
7241 b->py_bp_object = NULL;
7242 b->related_breakpoint = b;
7243}
7244
7245/* Helper to set_raw_breakpoint below. Creates a breakpoint
7246 that has type BPTYPE and has no locations as yet. */
7247
7248static struct breakpoint *
7249set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7250 enum bptype bptype,
7251 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7252{
7253 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
7254
7255 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7256 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7257 return b;
7258}
7259
7260/* Initialize loc->function_name. EXPLICIT_LOC says no indirect function
7261 resolutions should be made as the user specified the location explicitly
7262 enough. */
7263
7264static void
7265set_breakpoint_location_function (struct bp_location *loc, int explicit_loc)
7266{
7267 gdb_assert (loc->owner != NULL);
7268
7269 if (loc->owner->type == bp_breakpoint
7270 || loc->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
7271 || is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
7272 {
7273 int is_gnu_ifunc;
7274 const char *function_name;
7275 CORE_ADDR func_addr;
7276
7277 find_pc_partial_function_gnu_ifunc (loc->address, &function_name,
7278 &func_addr, NULL, &is_gnu_ifunc);
7279
7280 if (is_gnu_ifunc && !explicit_loc)
7281 {
7282 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7283
7284 gdb_assert (loc->pspace == current_program_space);
7285 if (gnu_ifunc_resolve_name (function_name,
7286 &loc->requested_address))
7287 {
7288 /* Recalculate ADDRESS based on new REQUESTED_ADDRESS. */
7289 loc->address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc->gdbarch,
7290 loc->requested_address,
7291 b->type);
7292 }
7293 else if (b->type == bp_breakpoint && b->loc == loc
7294 && loc->next == NULL && b->related_breakpoint == b)
7295 {
7296 /* Create only the whole new breakpoint of this type but do not
7297 mess more complicated breakpoints with multiple locations. */
7298 b->type = bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver;
7299 /* Remember the resolver's address for use by the return
7300 breakpoint. */
7301 loc->related_address = func_addr;
7302 }
7303 }
7304
7305 if (function_name)
7306 loc->function_name = xstrdup (function_name);
7307 }
7308}
7309
7310/* Attempt to determine architecture of location identified by SAL. */
7311struct gdbarch *
7312get_sal_arch (struct symtab_and_line sal)
7313{
7314 if (sal.section)
7315 return get_objfile_arch (sal.section->objfile);
7316 if (sal.symtab)
7317 return get_objfile_arch (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal.symtab));
7318
7319 return NULL;
7320}
7321
7322/* Low level routine for partially initializing a breakpoint of type
7323 BPTYPE. The newly created breakpoint's address, section, source
7324 file name, and line number are provided by SAL.
7325
7326 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7327 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7328 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. */
7329
7330static void
7331init_raw_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7332 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7333 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7334{
7335 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bptype, ops);
7336
7337 add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
7338
7339 if (bptype != bp_catchpoint)
7340 gdb_assert (sal.pspace != NULL);
7341
7342 /* Store the program space that was used to set the breakpoint,
7343 except for ordinary breakpoints, which are independent of the
7344 program space. */
7345 if (bptype != bp_breakpoint && bptype != bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7346 b->pspace = sal.pspace;
7347}
7348
7349/* set_raw_breakpoint is a low level routine for allocating and
7350 partially initializing a breakpoint of type BPTYPE. The newly
7351 created breakpoint's address, section, source file name, and line
7352 number are provided by SAL. The newly created and partially
7353 initialized breakpoint is added to the breakpoint chain and
7354 is also returned as the value of this function.
7355
7356 It is expected that the caller will complete the initialization of
7357 the newly created breakpoint struct as well as output any status
7358 information regarding the creation of a new breakpoint. In
7359 particular, set_raw_breakpoint does NOT set the breakpoint
7360 number! Care should be taken to not allow an error to occur
7361 prior to completing the initialization of the breakpoint. If this
7362 should happen, a bogus breakpoint will be left on the chain. */
7363
7364struct breakpoint *
7365set_raw_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
7366 struct symtab_and_line sal, enum bptype bptype,
7367 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
7368{
7369 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
7370
7371 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bptype, ops);
7372 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
7373 return b;
7374}
7375
7376
7377/* Note that the breakpoint object B describes a permanent breakpoint
7378 instruction, hard-wired into the inferior's code. */
7379void
7380make_breakpoint_permanent (struct breakpoint *b)
7381{
7382 struct bp_location *bl;
7383
7384 /* By definition, permanent breakpoints are already present in the
7385 code. Mark all locations as inserted. For now,
7386 make_breakpoint_permanent is called in just one place, so it's
7387 hard to say if it's reasonable to have permanent breakpoint with
7388 multiple locations or not, but it's easy to implement. */
7389 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
7390 {
7391 bl->permanent = 1;
7392 bl->inserted = 1;
7393 }
7394}
7395
7396/* Call this routine when stepping and nexting to enable a breakpoint
7397 if we do a longjmp() or 'throw' in TP. FRAME is the frame which
7398 initiated the operation. */
7399
7400void
7401set_longjmp_breakpoint (struct thread_info *tp, struct frame_id frame)
7402{
7403 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7404 int thread = tp->num;
7405
7406 /* To avoid having to rescan all objfile symbols at every step,
7407 we maintain a list of continually-inserted but always disabled
7408 longjmp "master" breakpoints. Here, we simply create momentary
7409 clones of those and enable them for the requested thread. */
7410 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7411 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7412 && (b->type == bp_longjmp_master
7413 || b->type == bp_exception_master))
7414 {
7415 enum bptype type = b->type == bp_longjmp_master ? bp_longjmp : bp_exception;
7416 struct breakpoint *clone;
7417
7418 /* longjmp_breakpoint_ops ensures INITIATING_FRAME is cleared again
7419 after their removal. */
7420 clone = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, type,
7421 &longjmp_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7422 clone->thread = thread;
7423 }
7424
7425 tp->initiating_frame = frame;
7426}
7427
7428/* Delete all longjmp breakpoints from THREAD. */
7429void
7430delete_longjmp_breakpoint (int thread)
7431{
7432 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7433
7434 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7435 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7436 {
7437 if (b->thread == thread)
7438 delete_breakpoint (b);
7439 }
7440}
7441
7442void
7443delete_longjmp_breakpoint_at_next_stop (int thread)
7444{
7445 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7446
7447 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7448 if (b->type == bp_longjmp || b->type == bp_exception)
7449 {
7450 if (b->thread == thread)
7451 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7452 }
7453}
7454
7455/* Place breakpoints of type bp_longjmp_call_dummy to catch longjmp for
7456 INFERIOR_PTID thread. Chain them all by RELATED_BREAKPOINT and return
7457 pointer to any of them. Return NULL if this system cannot place longjmp
7458 breakpoints. */
7459
7460struct breakpoint *
7461set_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (void)
7462{
7463 struct breakpoint *b, *retval = NULL;
7464
7465 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7466 if (b->pspace == current_program_space && b->type == bp_longjmp_master)
7467 {
7468 struct breakpoint *new_b;
7469
7470 new_b = momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_longjmp_call_dummy,
7471 &momentary_breakpoint_ops,
7472 1);
7473 new_b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
7474
7475 /* Link NEW_B into the chain of RETVAL breakpoints. */
7476
7477 gdb_assert (new_b->related_breakpoint == new_b);
7478 if (retval == NULL)
7479 retval = new_b;
7480 new_b->related_breakpoint = retval;
7481 while (retval->related_breakpoint != new_b->related_breakpoint)
7482 retval = retval->related_breakpoint;
7483 retval->related_breakpoint = new_b;
7484 }
7485
7486 return retval;
7487}
7488
7489/* Verify all existing dummy frames and their associated breakpoints for
7490 TP. Remove those which can no longer be found in the current frame
7491 stack.
7492
7493 You should call this function only at places where it is safe to currently
7494 unwind the whole stack. Failed stack unwind would discard live dummy
7495 frames. */
7496
7497void
7498check_longjmp_breakpoint_for_call_dummy (struct thread_info *tp)
7499{
7500 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7501
7502 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7503 if (b->type == bp_longjmp_call_dummy && b->thread == tp->num)
7504 {
7505 struct breakpoint *dummy_b = b->related_breakpoint;
7506
7507 while (dummy_b != b && dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy)
7508 dummy_b = dummy_b->related_breakpoint;
7509 if (dummy_b->type != bp_call_dummy
7510 || frame_find_by_id (dummy_b->frame_id) != NULL)
7511 continue;
7512
7513 dummy_frame_discard (dummy_b->frame_id, tp->ptid);
7514
7515 while (b->related_breakpoint != b)
7516 {
7517 if (b_tmp == b->related_breakpoint)
7518 b_tmp = b->related_breakpoint->next;
7519 delete_breakpoint (b->related_breakpoint);
7520 }
7521 delete_breakpoint (b);
7522 }
7523}
7524
7525void
7526enable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7527{
7528 struct breakpoint *b;
7529
7530 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7531 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7532 {
7533 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7534 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7535 overlay_events_enabled = 1;
7536 }
7537}
7538
7539void
7540disable_overlay_breakpoints (void)
7541{
7542 struct breakpoint *b;
7543
7544 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7545 if (b->type == bp_overlay_event)
7546 {
7547 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
7548 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
7549 overlay_events_enabled = 0;
7550 }
7551}
7552
7553/* Set an active std::terminate breakpoint for each std::terminate
7554 master breakpoint. */
7555void
7556set_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7557{
7558 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7559
7560 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7561 if (b->pspace == current_program_space
7562 && b->type == bp_std_terminate_master)
7563 {
7564 momentary_breakpoint_from_master (b, bp_std_terminate,
7565 &momentary_breakpoint_ops, 1);
7566 }
7567}
7568
7569/* Delete all the std::terminate breakpoints. */
7570void
7571delete_std_terminate_breakpoint (void)
7572{
7573 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7574
7575 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7576 if (b->type == bp_std_terminate)
7577 delete_breakpoint (b);
7578}
7579
7580struct breakpoint *
7581create_thread_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7582{
7583 struct breakpoint *b;
7584
7585 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_thread_event,
7586 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7587
7588 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
7589 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete me. */
7590 b->addr_string
7591 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
7592
7593 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7594
7595 return b;
7596}
7597
7598void
7599remove_thread_event_breakpoints (void)
7600{
7601 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7602
7603 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7604 if (b->type == bp_thread_event
7605 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7606 delete_breakpoint (b);
7607}
7608
7609struct lang_and_radix
7610 {
7611 enum language lang;
7612 int radix;
7613 };
7614
7615/* Create a breakpoint for JIT code registration and unregistration. */
7616
7617struct breakpoint *
7618create_jit_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7619{
7620 struct breakpoint *b;
7621
7622 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_jit_event,
7623 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7624 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7625 return b;
7626}
7627
7628/* Remove JIT code registration and unregistration breakpoint(s). */
7629
7630void
7631remove_jit_event_breakpoints (void)
7632{
7633 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7634
7635 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7636 if (b->type == bp_jit_event
7637 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7638 delete_breakpoint (b);
7639}
7640
7641void
7642remove_solib_event_breakpoints (void)
7643{
7644 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7645
7646 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7647 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7648 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7649 delete_breakpoint (b);
7650}
7651
7652/* See breakpoint.h. */
7653
7654void
7655remove_solib_event_breakpoints_at_next_stop (void)
7656{
7657 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
7658
7659 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
7660 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event
7661 && b->loc->pspace == current_program_space)
7662 b->disposition = disp_del_at_next_stop;
7663}
7664
7665/* Helper for create_solib_event_breakpoint /
7666 create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint. Allows specifying which
7667 INSERT_MODE to pass through to update_global_location_list. */
7668
7669static struct breakpoint *
7670create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address,
7671 enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
7672{
7673 struct breakpoint *b;
7674
7675 b = create_internal_breakpoint (gdbarch, address, bp_shlib_event,
7676 &internal_breakpoint_ops);
7677 update_global_location_list_nothrow (insert_mode);
7678 return b;
7679}
7680
7681struct breakpoint *
7682create_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7683{
7684 return create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
7685}
7686
7687/* See breakpoint.h. */
7688
7689struct breakpoint *
7690create_and_insert_solib_event_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR address)
7691{
7692 struct breakpoint *b;
7693
7694 /* Explicitly tell update_global_location_list to insert
7695 locations. */
7696 b = create_solib_event_breakpoint_1 (gdbarch, address, UGLL_INSERT);
7697 if (!b->loc->inserted)
7698 {
7699 delete_breakpoint (b);
7700 return NULL;
7701 }
7702 return b;
7703}
7704
7705/* Disable any breakpoints that are on code in shared libraries. Only
7706 apply to enabled breakpoints, disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7707
7708void
7709disable_breakpoints_in_shlibs (void)
7710{
7711 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7712
7713 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7714 {
7715 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7716 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7717
7718 /* We apply the check to all breakpoints, including disabled for
7719 those with loc->duplicate set. This is so that when breakpoint
7720 becomes enabled, or the duplicate is removed, gdb will try to
7721 insert all breakpoints. If we don't set shlib_disabled here,
7722 we'll try to insert those breakpoints and fail. */
7723 if (((b->type == bp_breakpoint)
7724 || (b->type == bp_jit_event)
7725 || (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7726 || (is_tracepoint (b)))
7727 && loc->pspace == current_program_space
7728 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7729 && solib_name_from_address (loc->pspace, loc->address)
7730 )
7731 {
7732 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7733 }
7734 }
7735}
7736
7737/* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints that are in SOLIB upon
7738 notification of unloaded_shlib. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7739 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7740
7741static void
7742disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib (struct so_list *solib)
7743{
7744 struct bp_location *loc, **locp_tmp;
7745 int disabled_shlib_breaks = 0;
7746
7747 /* SunOS a.out shared libraries are always mapped, so do not
7748 disable breakpoints; they will only be reported as unloaded
7749 through clear_solib when GDB discards its shared library
7750 list. See clear_solib for more information. */
7751 if (exec_bfd != NULL
7752 && bfd_get_flavour (exec_bfd) == bfd_target_aout_flavour)
7753 return;
7754
7755 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp_tmp)
7756 {
7757 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always non-NULL. */
7758 struct breakpoint *b = loc->owner;
7759
7760 if (solib->pspace == loc->pspace
7761 && !loc->shlib_disabled
7762 && (((b->type == bp_breakpoint
7763 || b->type == bp_jit_event
7764 || b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
7765 && (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7766 || loc->loc_type == bp_loc_software_breakpoint))
7767 || is_tracepoint (b))
7768 && solib_contains_address_p (solib, loc->address))
7769 {
7770 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7771 /* At this point, we cannot rely on remove_breakpoint
7772 succeeding so we must mark the breakpoint as not inserted
7773 to prevent future errors occurring in remove_breakpoints. */
7774 loc->inserted = 0;
7775
7776 /* This may cause duplicate notifications for the same breakpoint. */
7777 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7778
7779 if (!disabled_shlib_breaks)
7780 {
7781 target_terminal_ours_for_output ();
7782 warning (_("Temporarily disabling breakpoints "
7783 "for unloaded shared library \"%s\""),
7784 solib->so_name);
7785 }
7786 disabled_shlib_breaks = 1;
7787 }
7788 }
7789}
7790
7791/* Disable any breakpoints and tracepoints in OBJFILE upon
7792 notification of free_objfile. Only apply to enabled breakpoints,
7793 disabled ones can just stay disabled. */
7794
7795static void
7796disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
7797{
7798 struct breakpoint *b;
7799
7800 if (objfile == NULL)
7801 return;
7802
7803 /* OBJF_SHARED|OBJF_USERLOADED objfiles are dynamic modules manually
7804 managed by the user with add-symbol-file/remove-symbol-file.
7805 Similarly to how breakpoints in shared libraries are handled in
7806 response to "nosharedlibrary", mark breakpoints in such modules
7807 shlib_disabled so they end up uninserted on the next global
7808 location list update. Shared libraries not loaded by the user
7809 aren't handled here -- they're already handled in
7810 disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib, called by solib.c's
7811 solib_unloaded observer. We skip objfiles that are not
7812 OBJF_SHARED as those aren't considered dynamic objects (e.g. the
7813 main objfile). */
7814 if ((objfile->flags & OBJF_SHARED) == 0
7815 || (objfile->flags & OBJF_USERLOADED) == 0)
7816 return;
7817
7818 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
7819 {
7820 struct bp_location *loc;
7821 int bp_modified = 0;
7822
7823 if (!is_breakpoint (b) && !is_tracepoint (b))
7824 continue;
7825
7826 for (loc = b->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
7827 {
7828 CORE_ADDR loc_addr = loc->address;
7829
7830 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7831 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7832 continue;
7833
7834 if (loc->shlib_disabled != 0)
7835 continue;
7836
7837 if (objfile->pspace != loc->pspace)
7838 continue;
7839
7840 if (loc->loc_type != bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint
7841 && loc->loc_type != bp_loc_software_breakpoint)
7842 continue;
7843
7844 if (is_addr_in_objfile (loc_addr, objfile))
7845 {
7846 loc->shlib_disabled = 1;
7847 /* At this point, we don't know whether the object was
7848 unmapped from the inferior or not, so leave the
7849 inserted flag alone. We'll handle failure to
7850 uninsert quietly, in case the object was indeed
7851 unmapped. */
7852
7853 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
7854
7855 bp_modified = 1;
7856 }
7857 }
7858
7859 if (bp_modified)
7860 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
7861 }
7862}
7863
7864/* FORK & VFORK catchpoints. */
7865
7866/* An instance of this type is used to represent a fork or vfork
7867 catchpoint. It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base
7868 class; users downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A
7869 breakpoint is really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
7870 CATCH_FORK_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
7871
7872struct fork_catchpoint
7873{
7874 /* The base class. */
7875 struct breakpoint base;
7876
7877 /* Process id of a child process whose forking triggered this
7878 catchpoint. This field is only valid immediately after this
7879 catchpoint has triggered. */
7880 ptid_t forked_inferior_pid;
7881};
7882
7883/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7884 catchpoints. */
7885
7886static int
7887insert_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7888{
7889 return target_insert_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7890}
7891
7892/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7893 catchpoints. */
7894
7895static int
7896remove_catch_fork (struct bp_location *bl)
7897{
7898 return target_remove_fork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
7899}
7900
7901/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7902 catchpoints. */
7903
7904static int
7905breakpoint_hit_catch_fork (const struct bp_location *bl,
7906 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
7907 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
7908{
7909 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
7910
7911 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_FORKED)
7912 return 0;
7913
7914 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
7915 return 1;
7916}
7917
7918/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7919 catchpoints. */
7920
7921static enum print_stop_action
7922print_it_catch_fork (bpstat bs)
7923{
7924 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7925 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
7926 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
7927
7928 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
7929 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
7930 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
7931 else
7932 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
7933 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7934 {
7935 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
7936 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FORK));
7937 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
7938 }
7939 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
7940 ui_out_text (uiout, " (forked process ");
7941 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7942 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
7943 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
7944}
7945
7946/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7947 catchpoints. */
7948
7949static void
7950print_one_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
7951{
7952 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
7953 struct value_print_options opts;
7954 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
7955
7956 get_user_print_options (&opts);
7957
7958 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
7959 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
7960 readable). */
7961 if (opts.addressprint)
7962 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
7963 annotate_field (5);
7964 ui_out_text (uiout, "fork");
7965 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
7966 {
7967 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
7968 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
7969 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
7970 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
7971 }
7972
7973 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
7974 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "fork");
7975}
7976
7977/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7978 catchpoints. */
7979
7980static void
7981print_mention_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b)
7982{
7983 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (fork)"), b->number);
7984}
7985
7986/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for fork
7987 catchpoints. */
7988
7989static void
7990print_recreate_catch_fork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
7991{
7992 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch fork");
7993 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
7994}
7995
7996/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in fork catchpoints. */
7997
7998static struct breakpoint_ops catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
7999
8000/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8001 catchpoints. */
8002
8003static int
8004insert_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
8005{
8006 return target_insert_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8007}
8008
8009/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8010 catchpoints. */
8011
8012static int
8013remove_catch_vfork (struct bp_location *bl)
8014{
8015 return target_remove_vfork_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8016}
8017
8018/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8019 catchpoints. */
8020
8021static int
8022breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork (const struct bp_location *bl,
8023 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8024 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8025{
8026 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8027
8028 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_VFORKED)
8029 return 0;
8030
8031 c->forked_inferior_pid = ws->value.related_pid;
8032 return 1;
8033}
8034
8035/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8036 catchpoints. */
8037
8038static enum print_stop_action
8039print_it_catch_vfork (bpstat bs)
8040{
8041 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8042 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8043 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8044
8045 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8046 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8047 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8048 else
8049 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8050 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8051 {
8052 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8053 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_VFORK));
8054 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8055 }
8056 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8057 ui_out_text (uiout, " (vforked process ");
8058 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "newpid", ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8059 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8060 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8061}
8062
8063/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8064 catchpoints. */
8065
8066static void
8067print_one_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8068{
8069 struct fork_catchpoint *c = (struct fork_catchpoint *) b;
8070 struct value_print_options opts;
8071 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8072
8073 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8074 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8075 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8076 readable). */
8077 if (opts.addressprint)
8078 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8079 annotate_field (5);
8080 ui_out_text (uiout, "vfork");
8081 if (!ptid_equal (c->forked_inferior_pid, null_ptid))
8082 {
8083 ui_out_text (uiout, ", process ");
8084 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "what",
8085 ptid_get_pid (c->forked_inferior_pid));
8086 ui_out_spaces (uiout, 1);
8087 }
8088
8089 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8090 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "vfork");
8091}
8092
8093/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8094 catchpoints. */
8095
8096static void
8097print_mention_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b)
8098{
8099 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (vfork)"), b->number);
8100}
8101
8102/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for vfork
8103 catchpoints. */
8104
8105static void
8106print_recreate_catch_vfork (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8107{
8108 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch vfork");
8109 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8110}
8111
8112/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in vfork catchpoints. */
8113
8114static struct breakpoint_ops catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
8115
8116/* An instance of this type is used to represent an solib catchpoint.
8117 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8118 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8119 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8120 CATCH_SOLIB_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8121
8122struct solib_catchpoint
8123{
8124 /* The base class. */
8125 struct breakpoint base;
8126
8127 /* True for "catch load", false for "catch unload". */
8128 unsigned char is_load;
8129
8130 /* Regular expression to match, if any. COMPILED is only valid when
8131 REGEX is non-NULL. */
8132 char *regex;
8133 regex_t compiled;
8134};
8135
8136static void
8137dtor_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8138{
8139 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8140
8141 if (self->regex)
8142 regfree (&self->compiled);
8143 xfree (self->regex);
8144
8145 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8146}
8147
8148static int
8149insert_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8150{
8151 return 0;
8152}
8153
8154static int
8155remove_catch_solib (struct bp_location *ignore)
8156{
8157 return 0;
8158}
8159
8160static int
8161breakpoint_hit_catch_solib (const struct bp_location *bl,
8162 struct address_space *aspace,
8163 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8164 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8165{
8166 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8167 struct breakpoint *other;
8168
8169 if (ws->kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_LOADED)
8170 return 1;
8171
8172 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (other)
8173 {
8174 struct bp_location *other_bl;
8175
8176 if (other == bl->owner)
8177 continue;
8178
8179 if (other->type != bp_shlib_event)
8180 continue;
8181
8182 if (self->base.pspace != NULL && other->pspace != self->base.pspace)
8183 continue;
8184
8185 for (other_bl = other->loc; other_bl != NULL; other_bl = other_bl->next)
8186 {
8187 if (other->ops->breakpoint_hit (other_bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws))
8188 return 1;
8189 }
8190 }
8191
8192 return 0;
8193}
8194
8195static void
8196check_status_catch_solib (struct bpstats *bs)
8197{
8198 struct solib_catchpoint *self
8199 = (struct solib_catchpoint *) bs->breakpoint_at;
8200 int ix;
8201
8202 if (self->is_load)
8203 {
8204 struct so_list *iter;
8205
8206 for (ix = 0;
8207 VEC_iterate (so_list_ptr, current_program_space->added_solibs,
8208 ix, iter);
8209 ++ix)
8210 {
8211 if (!self->regex
8212 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter->so_name, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8213 return;
8214 }
8215 }
8216 else
8217 {
8218 char *iter;
8219
8220 for (ix = 0;
8221 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, current_program_space->deleted_solibs,
8222 ix, iter);
8223 ++ix)
8224 {
8225 if (!self->regex
8226 || regexec (&self->compiled, iter, 0, NULL, 0) == 0)
8227 return;
8228 }
8229 }
8230
8231 bs->stop = 0;
8232 bs->print_it = print_it_noop;
8233}
8234
8235static enum print_stop_action
8236print_it_catch_solib (bpstat bs)
8237{
8238 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8239 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8240
8241 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8242 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8243 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8244 else
8245 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8246 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8247 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
8248 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8249 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8250 print_solib_event (1);
8251 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8252}
8253
8254static void
8255print_one_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **locs)
8256{
8257 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8258 struct value_print_options opts;
8259 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8260 char *msg;
8261
8262 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8263 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8264 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8265 readable). */
8266 if (opts.addressprint)
8267 {
8268 annotate_field (4);
8269 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8270 }
8271
8272 annotate_field (5);
8273 if (self->is_load)
8274 {
8275 if (self->regex)
8276 msg = xstrprintf (_("load of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8277 else
8278 msg = xstrdup (_("load of library"));
8279 }
8280 else
8281 {
8282 if (self->regex)
8283 msg = xstrprintf (_("unload of library matching %s"), self->regex);
8284 else
8285 msg = xstrdup (_("unload of library"));
8286 }
8287 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", msg);
8288 xfree (msg);
8289
8290 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8291 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type",
8292 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8293}
8294
8295static void
8296print_mention_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b)
8297{
8298 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8299
8300 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (%s)"), b->number,
8301 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8302}
8303
8304static void
8305print_recreate_catch_solib (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8306{
8307 struct solib_catchpoint *self = (struct solib_catchpoint *) b;
8308
8309 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "%s %s",
8310 b->disposition == disp_del ? "tcatch" : "catch",
8311 self->is_load ? "load" : "unload");
8312 if (self->regex)
8313 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->regex);
8314 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
8315}
8316
8317static struct breakpoint_ops catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
8318
8319/* Shared helper function (MI and CLI) for creating and installing
8320 a shared object event catchpoint. If IS_LOAD is non-zero then
8321 the events to be caught are load events, otherwise they are
8322 unload events. If IS_TEMP is non-zero the catchpoint is a
8323 temporary one. If ENABLED is non-zero the catchpoint is
8324 created in an enabled state. */
8325
8326void
8327add_solib_catchpoint (char *arg, int is_load, int is_temp, int enabled)
8328{
8329 struct solib_catchpoint *c;
8330 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8331 struct cleanup *cleanup;
8332
8333 if (!arg)
8334 arg = "";
8335 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
8336
8337 c = XCNEW (struct solib_catchpoint);
8338 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, c);
8339
8340 if (*arg != '\0')
8341 {
8342 int errcode;
8343
8344 errcode = regcomp (&c->compiled, arg, REG_NOSUB);
8345 if (errcode != 0)
8346 {
8347 char *err = get_regcomp_error (errcode, &c->compiled);
8348
8349 make_cleanup (xfree, err);
8350 error (_("Invalid regexp (%s): %s"), err, arg);
8351 }
8352 c->regex = xstrdup (arg);
8353 }
8354
8355 c->is_load = is_load;
8356 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, is_temp, NULL,
8357 &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops);
8358
8359 c->base.enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
8360
8361 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
8362 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8363}
8364
8365/* A helper function that does all the work for "catch load" and
8366 "catch unload". */
8367
8368static void
8369catch_load_or_unload (char *arg, int from_tty, int is_load,
8370 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8371{
8372 int tempflag;
8373 const int enabled = 1;
8374
8375 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
8376
8377 add_solib_catchpoint (arg, is_load, tempflag, enabled);
8378}
8379
8380static void
8381catch_load_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8382 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8383{
8384 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 1, command);
8385}
8386
8387static void
8388catch_unload_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
8389 struct cmd_list_element *command)
8390{
8391 catch_load_or_unload (arg, from_tty, 0, command);
8392}
8393
8394/* An instance of this type is used to represent a syscall catchpoint.
8395 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8396 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8397 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8398 CATCH_SYSCALL_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8399
8400struct syscall_catchpoint
8401{
8402 /* The base class. */
8403 struct breakpoint base;
8404
8405 /* Syscall numbers used for the 'catch syscall' feature. If no
8406 syscall has been specified for filtering, its value is NULL.
8407 Otherwise, it holds a list of all syscalls to be caught. The
8408 list elements are allocated with xmalloc. */
8409 VEC(int) *syscalls_to_be_caught;
8410};
8411
8412/* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8413 catchpoints. */
8414
8415static void
8416dtor_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
8417{
8418 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
8419
8420 VEC_free (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught);
8421
8422 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8423}
8424
8425static const struct inferior_data *catch_syscall_inferior_data = NULL;
8426
8427struct catch_syscall_inferior_data
8428{
8429 /* We keep a count of the number of times the user has requested a
8430 particular syscall to be tracked, and pass this information to the
8431 target. This lets capable targets implement filtering directly. */
8432
8433 /* Number of times that "any" syscall is requested. */
8434 int any_syscall_count;
8435
8436 /* Count of each system call. */
8437 VEC(int) *syscalls_counts;
8438
8439 /* This counts all syscall catch requests, so we can readily determine
8440 if any catching is necessary. */
8441 int total_syscalls_count;
8442};
8443
8444static struct catch_syscall_inferior_data*
8445get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (struct inferior *inf)
8446{
8447 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data;
8448
8449 inf_data = inferior_data (inf, catch_syscall_inferior_data);
8450 if (inf_data == NULL)
8451 {
8452 inf_data = XCNEW (struct catch_syscall_inferior_data);
8453 set_inferior_data (inf, catch_syscall_inferior_data, inf_data);
8454 }
8455
8456 return inf_data;
8457}
8458
8459static void
8460catch_syscall_inferior_data_cleanup (struct inferior *inf, void *arg)
8461{
8462 xfree (arg);
8463}
8464
8465
8466/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8467 catchpoints. */
8468
8469static int
8470insert_catch_syscall (struct bp_location *bl)
8471{
8472 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8473 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
8474 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
8475 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (inf);
8476
8477 ++inf_data->total_syscalls_count;
8478 if (!c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8479 ++inf_data->any_syscall_count;
8480 else
8481 {
8482 int i, iter;
8483
8484 for (i = 0;
8485 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8486 i++)
8487 {
8488 int elem;
8489
8490 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts))
8491 {
8492 int old_size = VEC_length (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts);
8493 uintptr_t vec_addr_offset
8494 = old_size * ((uintptr_t) sizeof (int));
8495 uintptr_t vec_addr;
8496 VEC_safe_grow (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter + 1);
8497 vec_addr = ((uintptr_t) VEC_address (int,
8498 inf_data->syscalls_counts)
8499 + vec_addr_offset);
8500 memset ((void *) vec_addr, 0,
8501 (iter + 1 - old_size) * sizeof (int));
8502 }
8503 elem = VEC_index (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter);
8504 VEC_replace (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter, ++elem);
8505 }
8506 }
8507
8508 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid),
8509 inf_data->total_syscalls_count != 0,
8510 inf_data->any_syscall_count,
8511 VEC_length (int,
8512 inf_data->syscalls_counts),
8513 VEC_address (int,
8514 inf_data->syscalls_counts));
8515}
8516
8517/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8518 catchpoints. */
8519
8520static int
8521remove_catch_syscall (struct bp_location *bl)
8522{
8523 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8524 struct inferior *inf = current_inferior ();
8525 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
8526 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (inf);
8527
8528 --inf_data->total_syscalls_count;
8529 if (!c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8530 --inf_data->any_syscall_count;
8531 else
8532 {
8533 int i, iter;
8534
8535 for (i = 0;
8536 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8537 i++)
8538 {
8539 int elem;
8540 if (iter >= VEC_length (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts))
8541 /* Shouldn't happen. */
8542 continue;
8543 elem = VEC_index (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter);
8544 VEC_replace (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts, iter, --elem);
8545 }
8546 }
8547
8548 return target_set_syscall_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid),
8549 inf_data->total_syscalls_count != 0,
8550 inf_data->any_syscall_count,
8551 VEC_length (int,
8552 inf_data->syscalls_counts),
8553 VEC_address (int,
8554 inf_data->syscalls_counts));
8555}
8556
8557/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8558 catchpoints. */
8559
8560static int
8561breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall (const struct bp_location *bl,
8562 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8563 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8564{
8565 /* We must check if we are catching specific syscalls in this
8566 breakpoint. If we are, then we must guarantee that the called
8567 syscall is the same syscall we are catching. */
8568 int syscall_number = 0;
8569 const struct syscall_catchpoint *c
8570 = (const struct syscall_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8571
8572 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
8573 && ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN)
8574 return 0;
8575
8576 syscall_number = ws->value.syscall_number;
8577
8578 /* Now, checking if the syscall is the same. */
8579 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8580 {
8581 int i, iter;
8582
8583 for (i = 0;
8584 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8585 i++)
8586 if (syscall_number == iter)
8587 return 1;
8588
8589 return 0;
8590 }
8591
8592 return 1;
8593}
8594
8595/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8596 catchpoints. */
8597
8598static enum print_stop_action
8599print_it_catch_syscall (bpstat bs)
8600{
8601 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8602 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8603 /* These are needed because we want to know in which state a
8604 syscall is. It can be in the TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
8605 or TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_RETURN, and depending on it we
8606 must print "called syscall" or "returned from syscall". */
8607 ptid_t ptid;
8608 struct target_waitstatus last;
8609 struct syscall s;
8610
8611 get_last_target_status (&ptid, &last);
8612
8613 get_syscall_by_number (last.value.syscall_number, &s);
8614
8615 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8616
8617 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8618 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8619 else
8620 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8621 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8622 {
8623 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8624 async_reason_lookup (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY
8625 ? EXEC_ASYNC_SYSCALL_ENTRY
8626 : EXEC_ASYNC_SYSCALL_RETURN));
8627 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8628 }
8629 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8630
8631 if (last.kind == TARGET_WAITKIND_SYSCALL_ENTRY)
8632 ui_out_text (uiout, " (call to syscall ");
8633 else
8634 ui_out_text (uiout, " (returned from syscall ");
8635
8636 if (s.name == NULL || ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8637 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "syscall-number", last.value.syscall_number);
8638 if (s.name != NULL)
8639 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "syscall-name", s.name);
8640
8641 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8642
8643 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8644}
8645
8646/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8647 catchpoints. */
8648
8649static void
8650print_one_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b,
8651 struct bp_location **last_loc)
8652{
8653 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
8654 struct value_print_options opts;
8655 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8656
8657 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8658 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns not
8659 line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect is relatively
8660 readable). */
8661 if (opts.addressprint)
8662 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8663 annotate_field (5);
8664
8665 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught
8666 && VEC_length (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
8667 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscalls \"");
8668 else
8669 ui_out_text (uiout, "syscall \"");
8670
8671 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8672 {
8673 int i, iter;
8674 char *text = xstrprintf ("%s", "");
8675
8676 for (i = 0;
8677 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8678 i++)
8679 {
8680 char *x = text;
8681 struct syscall s;
8682 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
8683
8684 if (s.name != NULL)
8685 text = xstrprintf ("%s%s, ", text, s.name);
8686 else
8687 text = xstrprintf ("%s%d, ", text, iter);
8688
8689 /* We have to xfree the last 'text' (now stored at 'x')
8690 because xstrprintf dynamically allocates new space for it
8691 on every call. */
8692 xfree (x);
8693 }
8694 /* Remove the last comma. */
8695 text[strlen (text) - 2] = '\0';
8696 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", text);
8697 }
8698 else
8699 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", "<any syscall>");
8700 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
8701
8702 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8703 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "syscall");
8704}
8705
8706/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8707 catchpoints. */
8708
8709static void
8710print_mention_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b)
8711{
8712 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
8713
8714 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8715 {
8716 int i, iter;
8717
8718 if (VEC_length (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught) > 1)
8719 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscalls"), b->number);
8720 else
8721 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (syscall"), b->number);
8722
8723 for (i = 0;
8724 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8725 i++)
8726 {
8727 struct syscall s;
8728 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
8729
8730 if (s.name)
8731 printf_filtered (" '%s' [%d]", s.name, s.number);
8732 else
8733 printf_filtered (" %d", s.number);
8734 }
8735 printf_filtered (")");
8736 }
8737 else
8738 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (any syscall)"),
8739 b->number);
8740}
8741
8742/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for syscall
8743 catchpoints. */
8744
8745static void
8746print_recreate_catch_syscall (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8747{
8748 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) b;
8749
8750 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch syscall");
8751
8752 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
8753 {
8754 int i, iter;
8755
8756 for (i = 0;
8757 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
8758 i++)
8759 {
8760 struct syscall s;
8761
8762 get_syscall_by_number (iter, &s);
8763 if (s.name)
8764 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", s.name);
8765 else
8766 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %d", s.number);
8767 }
8768 }
8769 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8770}
8771
8772/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in syscall catchpoints. */
8773
8774static struct breakpoint_ops catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops;
8775
8776/* Returns non-zero if 'b' is a syscall catchpoint. */
8777
8778static int
8779syscall_catchpoint_p (struct breakpoint *b)
8780{
8781 return (b->ops == &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
8782}
8783
8784/* Initialize a new breakpoint of the bp_catchpoint kind. If TEMPFLAG
8785 is non-zero, then make the breakpoint temporary. If COND_STRING is
8786 not NULL, then store it in the breakpoint. OPS, if not NULL, is
8787 the breakpoint_ops structure associated to the catchpoint. */
8788
8789void
8790init_catchpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
8791 struct gdbarch *gdbarch, int tempflag,
8792 char *cond_string,
8793 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8794{
8795 struct symtab_and_line sal;
8796
8797 init_sal (&sal);
8798 sal.pspace = current_program_space;
8799
8800 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_catchpoint, ops);
8801
8802 b->cond_string = (cond_string == NULL) ? NULL : xstrdup (cond_string);
8803 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
8804}
8805
8806void
8807install_breakpoint (int internal, struct breakpoint *b, int update_gll)
8808{
8809 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
8810 set_breakpoint_number (internal, b);
8811 if (is_tracepoint (b))
8812 set_tracepoint_count (breakpoint_count);
8813 if (!internal)
8814 mention (b);
8815 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
8816
8817 if (update_gll)
8818 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
8819}
8820
8821static void
8822create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
8823 int tempflag, char *cond_string,
8824 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8825{
8826 struct fork_catchpoint *c = XNEW (struct fork_catchpoint);
8827
8828 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string, ops);
8829
8830 c->forked_inferior_pid = null_ptid;
8831
8832 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8833}
8834
8835/* Exec catchpoints. */
8836
8837/* An instance of this type is used to represent an exec catchpoint.
8838 It includes a "struct breakpoint" as a kind of base class; users
8839 downcast to "struct breakpoint *" when needed. A breakpoint is
8840 really of this type iff its ops pointer points to
8841 CATCH_EXEC_BREAKPOINT_OPS. */
8842
8843struct exec_catchpoint
8844{
8845 /* The base class. */
8846 struct breakpoint base;
8847
8848 /* Filename of a program whose exec triggered this catchpoint.
8849 This field is only valid immediately after this catchpoint has
8850 triggered. */
8851 char *exec_pathname;
8852};
8853
8854/* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8855 catchpoints. */
8856
8857static void
8858dtor_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8859{
8860 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8861
8862 xfree (c->exec_pathname);
8863
8864 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (b);
8865}
8866
8867static int
8868insert_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8869{
8870 return target_insert_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8871}
8872
8873static int
8874remove_catch_exec (struct bp_location *bl)
8875{
8876 return target_remove_exec_catchpoint (ptid_get_pid (inferior_ptid));
8877}
8878
8879static int
8880breakpoint_hit_catch_exec (const struct bp_location *bl,
8881 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
8882 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
8883{
8884 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) bl->owner;
8885
8886 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_EXECD)
8887 return 0;
8888
8889 c->exec_pathname = xstrdup (ws->value.execd_pathname);
8890 return 1;
8891}
8892
8893static enum print_stop_action
8894print_it_catch_exec (bpstat bs)
8895{
8896 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8897 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
8898 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8899
8900 annotate_catchpoint (b->number);
8901 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
8902 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary catchpoint ");
8903 else
8904 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nCatchpoint ");
8905 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8906 {
8907 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
8908 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_EXEC));
8909 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
8910 }
8911 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
8912 ui_out_text (uiout, " (exec'd ");
8913 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "new-exec", c->exec_pathname);
8914 ui_out_text (uiout, "), ");
8915
8916 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
8917}
8918
8919static void
8920print_one_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct bp_location **last_loc)
8921{
8922 struct exec_catchpoint *c = (struct exec_catchpoint *) b;
8923 struct value_print_options opts;
8924 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
8925
8926 get_user_print_options (&opts);
8927
8928 /* Field 4, the address, is omitted (which makes the columns
8929 not line up too nicely with the headers, but the effect
8930 is relatively readable). */
8931 if (opts.addressprint)
8932 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
8933 annotate_field (5);
8934 ui_out_text (uiout, "exec");
8935 if (c->exec_pathname != NULL)
8936 {
8937 ui_out_text (uiout, ", program \"");
8938 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "what", c->exec_pathname);
8939 ui_out_text (uiout, "\" ");
8940 }
8941
8942 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
8943 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "catch-type", "exec");
8944}
8945
8946static void
8947print_mention_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b)
8948{
8949 printf_filtered (_("Catchpoint %d (exec)"), b->number);
8950}
8951
8952/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for exec
8953 catchpoints. */
8954
8955static void
8956print_recreate_catch_exec (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
8957{
8958 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "catch exec");
8959 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
8960}
8961
8962static struct breakpoint_ops catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
8963
8964static void
8965create_syscall_event_catchpoint (int tempflag, VEC(int) *filter,
8966 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops)
8967{
8968 struct syscall_catchpoint *c;
8969 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
8970
8971 c = XNEW (struct syscall_catchpoint);
8972 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, NULL, ops);
8973 c->syscalls_to_be_caught = filter;
8974
8975 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
8976}
8977
8978static int
8979hw_breakpoint_used_count (void)
8980{
8981 int i = 0;
8982 struct breakpoint *b;
8983 struct bp_location *bl;
8984
8985 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
8986 {
8987 if (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint && breakpoint_enabled (b))
8988 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
8989 {
8990 /* Special types of hardware breakpoints may use more than
8991 one register. */
8992 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
8993 }
8994 }
8995
8996 return i;
8997}
8998
8999/* Returns the resources B would use if it were a hardware
9000 watchpoint. */
9001
9002static int
9003hw_watchpoint_use_count (struct breakpoint *b)
9004{
9005 int i = 0;
9006 struct bp_location *bl;
9007
9008 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
9009 return 0;
9010
9011 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
9012 {
9013 /* Special types of hardware watchpoints may use more than
9014 one register. */
9015 i += b->ops->resources_needed (bl);
9016 }
9017
9018 return i;
9019}
9020
9021/* Returns the sum the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of
9022 type TYPE in the breakpoints list. Also returns in OTHER_TYPE_USED
9023 the sum of the used resources of all hardware watchpoints of other
9024 types _not_ TYPE. */
9025
9026static int
9027hw_watchpoint_used_count_others (struct breakpoint *except,
9028 enum bptype type, int *other_type_used)
9029{
9030 int i = 0;
9031 struct breakpoint *b;
9032
9033 *other_type_used = 0;
9034 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9035 {
9036 if (b == except)
9037 continue;
9038 if (!breakpoint_enabled (b))
9039 continue;
9040
9041 if (b->type == type)
9042 i += hw_watchpoint_use_count (b);
9043 else if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b))
9044 *other_type_used = 1;
9045 }
9046
9047 return i;
9048}
9049
9050void
9051disable_watchpoints_before_interactive_call_start (void)
9052{
9053 struct breakpoint *b;
9054
9055 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9056 {
9057 if (is_watchpoint (b) && breakpoint_enabled (b))
9058 {
9059 b->enable_state = bp_call_disabled;
9060 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
9061 }
9062 }
9063}
9064
9065void
9066enable_watchpoints_after_interactive_call_stop (void)
9067{
9068 struct breakpoint *b;
9069
9070 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9071 {
9072 if (is_watchpoint (b) && b->enable_state == bp_call_disabled)
9073 {
9074 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9075 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9076 }
9077 }
9078}
9079
9080void
9081disable_breakpoints_before_startup (void)
9082{
9083 current_program_space->executing_startup = 1;
9084 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
9085}
9086
9087void
9088enable_breakpoints_after_startup (void)
9089{
9090 current_program_space->executing_startup = 0;
9091 breakpoint_re_set ();
9092}
9093
9094/* Create a new single-step breakpoint for thread THREAD, with no
9095 locations. */
9096
9097static struct breakpoint *
9098new_single_step_breakpoint (int thread, struct gdbarch *gdbarch)
9099{
9100 struct breakpoint *b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
9101
9102 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, bp_single_step,
9103 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
9104
9105 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9106 b->frame_id = null_frame_id;
9107
9108 b->thread = thread;
9109 gdb_assert (b->thread != 0);
9110
9111 add_to_breakpoint_chain (b);
9112
9113 return b;
9114}
9115
9116/* Set a momentary breakpoint of type TYPE at address specified by
9117 SAL. If FRAME_ID is valid, the breakpoint is restricted to that
9118 frame. */
9119
9120struct breakpoint *
9121set_momentary_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, struct symtab_and_line sal,
9122 struct frame_id frame_id, enum bptype type)
9123{
9124 struct breakpoint *b;
9125
9126 /* If FRAME_ID is valid, it should be a real frame, not an inlined or
9127 tail-called one. */
9128 gdb_assert (!frame_id_artificial_p (frame_id));
9129
9130 b = set_raw_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, type, &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
9131 b->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9132 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9133 b->frame_id = frame_id;
9134
9135 /* If we're debugging a multi-threaded program, then we want
9136 momentary breakpoints to be active in only a single thread of
9137 control. */
9138 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
9139 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
9140
9141 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
9142
9143 return b;
9144}
9145
9146/* Make a momentary breakpoint based on the master breakpoint ORIG.
9147 The new breakpoint will have type TYPE, use OPS as its
9148 breakpoint_ops, and will set enabled to LOC_ENABLED. */
9149
9150static struct breakpoint *
9151momentary_breakpoint_from_master (struct breakpoint *orig,
9152 enum bptype type,
9153 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9154 int loc_enabled)
9155{
9156 struct breakpoint *copy;
9157
9158 copy = set_raw_breakpoint_without_location (orig->gdbarch, type, ops);
9159 copy->loc = allocate_bp_location (copy);
9160 set_breakpoint_location_function (copy->loc, 1);
9161
9162 copy->loc->gdbarch = orig->loc->gdbarch;
9163 copy->loc->requested_address = orig->loc->requested_address;
9164 copy->loc->address = orig->loc->address;
9165 copy->loc->section = orig->loc->section;
9166 copy->loc->pspace = orig->loc->pspace;
9167 copy->loc->probe = orig->loc->probe;
9168 copy->loc->line_number = orig->loc->line_number;
9169 copy->loc->symtab = orig->loc->symtab;
9170 copy->loc->enabled = loc_enabled;
9171 copy->frame_id = orig->frame_id;
9172 copy->thread = orig->thread;
9173 copy->pspace = orig->pspace;
9174
9175 copy->enable_state = bp_enabled;
9176 copy->disposition = disp_donttouch;
9177 copy->number = internal_breakpoint_number--;
9178
9179 update_global_location_list_nothrow (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
9180 return copy;
9181}
9182
9183/* Make a deep copy of momentary breakpoint ORIG. Returns NULL if
9184 ORIG is NULL. */
9185
9186struct breakpoint *
9187clone_momentary_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *orig)
9188{
9189 /* If there's nothing to clone, then return nothing. */
9190 if (orig == NULL)
9191 return NULL;
9192
9193 return momentary_breakpoint_from_master (orig, orig->type, orig->ops, 0);
9194}
9195
9196struct breakpoint *
9197set_momentary_breakpoint_at_pc (struct gdbarch *gdbarch, CORE_ADDR pc,
9198 enum bptype type)
9199{
9200 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9201
9202 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9203 sal.pc = pc;
9204 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
9205 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9206
9207 return set_momentary_breakpoint (gdbarch, sal, null_frame_id, type);
9208}
9209\f
9210
9211/* Tell the user we have just set a breakpoint B. */
9212
9213static void
9214mention (struct breakpoint *b)
9215{
9216 b->ops->print_mention (b);
9217 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
9218 return;
9219 printf_filtered ("\n");
9220}
9221\f
9222
9223static int bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc);
9224
9225static struct bp_location *
9226add_location_to_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
9227 const struct symtab_and_line *sal)
9228{
9229 struct bp_location *loc, **tmp;
9230 CORE_ADDR adjusted_address;
9231 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9232
9233 if (loc_gdbarch == NULL)
9234 loc_gdbarch = b->gdbarch;
9235
9236 /* Adjust the breakpoint's address prior to allocating a location.
9237 Once we call allocate_bp_location(), that mostly uninitialized
9238 location will be placed on the location chain. Adjustment of the
9239 breakpoint may cause target_read_memory() to be called and we do
9240 not want its scan of the location chain to find a breakpoint and
9241 location that's only been partially initialized. */
9242 adjusted_address = adjust_breakpoint_address (loc_gdbarch,
9243 sal->pc, b->type);
9244
9245 /* Sort the locations by their ADDRESS. */
9246 loc = allocate_bp_location (b);
9247 for (tmp = &(b->loc); *tmp != NULL && (*tmp)->address <= adjusted_address;
9248 tmp = &((*tmp)->next))
9249 ;
9250 loc->next = *tmp;
9251 *tmp = loc;
9252
9253 loc->requested_address = sal->pc;
9254 loc->address = adjusted_address;
9255 loc->pspace = sal->pspace;
9256 loc->probe.probe = sal->probe;
9257 loc->probe.objfile = sal->objfile;
9258 gdb_assert (loc->pspace != NULL);
9259 loc->section = sal->section;
9260 loc->gdbarch = loc_gdbarch;
9261 loc->line_number = sal->line;
9262 loc->symtab = sal->symtab;
9263
9264 set_breakpoint_location_function (loc,
9265 sal->explicit_pc || sal->explicit_line);
9266
9267 if (bp_loc_is_permanent (loc))
9268 {
9269 loc->inserted = 1;
9270 loc->permanent = 1;
9271 }
9272
9273 return loc;
9274}
9275\f
9276
9277/* Return 1 if LOC is pointing to a permanent breakpoint,
9278 return 0 otherwise. */
9279
9280static int
9281bp_loc_is_permanent (struct bp_location *loc)
9282{
9283 int len;
9284 CORE_ADDR addr;
9285 const gdb_byte *bpoint;
9286 gdb_byte *target_mem;
9287 struct cleanup *cleanup;
9288 int retval = 0;
9289
9290 gdb_assert (loc != NULL);
9291
9292 addr = loc->address;
9293 bpoint = gdbarch_breakpoint_from_pc (loc->gdbarch, &addr, &len);
9294
9295 /* Software breakpoints unsupported? */
9296 if (bpoint == NULL)
9297 return 0;
9298
9299 target_mem = alloca (len);
9300
9301 /* Enable the automatic memory restoration from breakpoints while
9302 we read the memory. Otherwise we could say about our temporary
9303 breakpoints they are permanent. */
9304 cleanup = save_current_space_and_thread ();
9305
9306 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (loc->pspace);
9307 make_show_memory_breakpoints_cleanup (0);
9308
9309 if (target_read_memory (loc->address, target_mem, len) == 0
9310 && memcmp (target_mem, bpoint, len) == 0)
9311 retval = 1;
9312
9313 do_cleanups (cleanup);
9314
9315 return retval;
9316}
9317
9318/* Build a command list for the dprintf corresponding to the current
9319 settings of the dprintf style options. */
9320
9321static void
9322update_dprintf_command_list (struct breakpoint *b)
9323{
9324 char *dprintf_args = b->extra_string;
9325 char *printf_line = NULL;
9326
9327 if (!dprintf_args)
9328 return;
9329
9330 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9331
9332 /* Allow a comma, as it may have terminated a location, but don't
9333 insist on it. */
9334 if (*dprintf_args == ',')
9335 ++dprintf_args;
9336 dprintf_args = skip_spaces (dprintf_args);
9337
9338 if (*dprintf_args != '"')
9339 error (_("Bad format string, missing '\"'."));
9340
9341 if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_gdb) == 0)
9342 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9343 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_call) == 0)
9344 {
9345 if (!dprintf_function)
9346 error (_("No function supplied for dprintf call"));
9347
9348 if (dprintf_channel && strlen (dprintf_channel) > 0)
9349 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s,%s)",
9350 dprintf_function,
9351 dprintf_channel,
9352 dprintf_args);
9353 else
9354 printf_line = xstrprintf ("call (void) %s (%s)",
9355 dprintf_function,
9356 dprintf_args);
9357 }
9358 else if (strcmp (dprintf_style, dprintf_style_agent) == 0)
9359 {
9360 if (target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
9361 printf_line = xstrprintf ("agent-printf %s", dprintf_args);
9362 else
9363 {
9364 warning (_("Target cannot run dprintf commands, falling back to GDB printf"));
9365 printf_line = xstrprintf ("printf %s", dprintf_args);
9366 }
9367 }
9368 else
9369 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
9370 _("Invalid dprintf style."));
9371
9372 gdb_assert (printf_line != NULL);
9373 /* Manufacture a printf sequence. */
9374 {
9375 struct command_line *printf_cmd_line
9376 = xmalloc (sizeof (struct command_line));
9377
9378 printf_cmd_line = xmalloc (sizeof (struct command_line));
9379 printf_cmd_line->control_type = simple_control;
9380 printf_cmd_line->body_count = 0;
9381 printf_cmd_line->body_list = NULL;
9382 printf_cmd_line->next = NULL;
9383 printf_cmd_line->line = printf_line;
9384
9385 breakpoint_set_commands (b, printf_cmd_line);
9386 }
9387}
9388
9389/* Update all dprintf commands, making their command lists reflect
9390 current style settings. */
9391
9392static void
9393update_dprintf_commands (char *args, int from_tty,
9394 struct cmd_list_element *c)
9395{
9396 struct breakpoint *b;
9397
9398 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
9399 {
9400 if (b->type == bp_dprintf)
9401 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9402 }
9403}
9404
9405/* Create a breakpoint with SAL as location. Use ADDR_STRING
9406 as textual description of the location, and COND_STRING
9407 as condition expression. */
9408
9409static void
9410init_breakpoint_sal (struct breakpoint *b, struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9411 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
9412 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9413 char *extra_string,
9414 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9415 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9416 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9417 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9418 int display_canonical)
9419{
9420 int i;
9421
9422 if (type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
9423 {
9424 int target_resources_ok;
9425
9426 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
9427 target_resources_ok =
9428 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
9429 i + 1, 0);
9430 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
9431 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
9432 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
9433 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
9434 }
9435
9436 gdb_assert (sals.nelts > 0);
9437
9438 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
9439 {
9440 struct symtab_and_line sal = sals.sals[i];
9441 struct bp_location *loc;
9442
9443 if (from_tty)
9444 {
9445 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
9446 if (!loc_gdbarch)
9447 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
9448
9449 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
9450 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, thread);
9451 }
9452
9453 if (i == 0)
9454 {
9455 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, type, ops);
9456 b->thread = thread;
9457 b->task = task;
9458
9459 b->cond_string = cond_string;
9460 b->extra_string = extra_string;
9461 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
9462 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
9463 b->disposition = disposition;
9464
9465 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9466 b->loc->inserted = 1;
9467
9468 if (type == bp_static_tracepoint)
9469 {
9470 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
9471 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
9472
9473 if (strace_marker_p (b))
9474 {
9475 /* We already know the marker exists, otherwise, we
9476 wouldn't see a sal for it. */
9477 char *p = &addr_string[3];
9478 char *endp;
9479 char *marker_str;
9480
9481 p = skip_spaces (p);
9482
9483 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9484
9485 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9486 t->static_trace_marker_id = marker_str;
9487
9488 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9489 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
9490 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9491 }
9492 else if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (sal.pc, &marker))
9493 {
9494 t->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
9495 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
9496
9497 printf_filtered (_("Probed static tracepoint "
9498 "marker \"%s\"\n"),
9499 t->static_trace_marker_id);
9500 }
9501 else
9502 warning (_("Couldn't determine the static "
9503 "tracepoint marker to probe"));
9504 }
9505
9506 loc = b->loc;
9507 }
9508 else
9509 {
9510 loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &sal);
9511 if ((flags & CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED) != 0)
9512 loc->inserted = 1;
9513 }
9514
9515 if (b->cond_string)
9516 {
9517 const char *arg = b->cond_string;
9518
9519 loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&arg, loc->address,
9520 block_for_pc (loc->address), 0);
9521 if (*arg)
9522 error (_("Garbage '%s' follows condition"), arg);
9523 }
9524
9525 /* Dynamic printf requires and uses additional arguments on the
9526 command line, otherwise it's an error. */
9527 if (type == bp_dprintf)
9528 {
9529 if (b->extra_string)
9530 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
9531 else
9532 error (_("Format string required"));
9533 }
9534 else if (b->extra_string)
9535 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of command"), b->extra_string);
9536 }
9537
9538 b->display_canonical = display_canonical;
9539 if (addr_string)
9540 b->addr_string = addr_string;
9541 else
9542 /* addr_string has to be used or breakpoint_re_set will delete
9543 me. */
9544 b->addr_string
9545 = xstrprintf ("*%s", paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address));
9546 b->filter = filter;
9547}
9548
9549static void
9550create_breakpoint_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9551 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, char *addr_string,
9552 char *filter, char *cond_string,
9553 char *extra_string,
9554 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9555 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9556 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9557 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags,
9558 int display_canonical)
9559{
9560 struct breakpoint *b;
9561 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9562
9563 if (is_tracepoint_type (type))
9564 {
9565 struct tracepoint *t;
9566
9567 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
9568 b = &t->base;
9569 }
9570 else
9571 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
9572
9573 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, b);
9574
9575 init_breakpoint_sal (b, gdbarch,
9576 sals, addr_string,
9577 filter, cond_string, extra_string,
9578 type, disposition,
9579 thread, task, ignore_count,
9580 ops, from_tty,
9581 enabled, internal, flags,
9582 display_canonical);
9583 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
9584
9585 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
9586}
9587
9588/* Add SALS.nelts breakpoints to the breakpoint table. For each
9589 SALS.sal[i] breakpoint, include the corresponding ADDR_STRING[i]
9590 value. COND_STRING, if not NULL, specified the condition to be
9591 used for all breakpoints. Essentially the only case where
9592 SALS.nelts is not 1 is when we set a breakpoint on an overloaded
9593 function. In that case, it's still not possible to specify
9594 separate conditions for different overloaded functions, so
9595 we take just a single condition string.
9596
9597 NOTE: If the function succeeds, the caller is expected to cleanup
9598 the arrays ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING, and SALS (but not the
9599 array contents). If the function fails (error() is called), the
9600 caller is expected to cleanups both the ADDR_STRING, COND_STRING,
9601 COND and SALS arrays and each of those arrays contents. */
9602
9603static void
9604create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9605 struct linespec_result *canonical,
9606 char *cond_string, char *extra_string,
9607 enum bptype type, enum bpdisp disposition,
9608 int thread, int task, int ignore_count,
9609 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops, int from_tty,
9610 int enabled, int internal, unsigned flags)
9611{
9612 int i;
9613 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
9614
9615 if (canonical->pre_expanded)
9616 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical->sals) == 1);
9617
9618 for (i = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, i, lsal); ++i)
9619 {
9620 /* Note that 'addr_string' can be NULL in the case of a plain
9621 'break', without arguments. */
9622 char *addr_string = (canonical->addr_string
9623 ? xstrdup (canonical->addr_string)
9624 : NULL);
9625 char *filter_string = lsal->canonical ? xstrdup (lsal->canonical) : NULL;
9626 struct cleanup *inner = make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
9627
9628 make_cleanup (xfree, filter_string);
9629 create_breakpoint_sal (gdbarch, lsal->sals,
9630 addr_string,
9631 filter_string,
9632 cond_string, extra_string,
9633 type, disposition,
9634 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
9635 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
9636 canonical->special_display);
9637 discard_cleanups (inner);
9638 }
9639}
9640
9641/* Parse ADDRESS which is assumed to be a SAL specification possibly
9642 followed by conditionals. On return, SALS contains an array of SAL
9643 addresses found. ADDR_STRING contains a vector of (canonical)
9644 address strings. ADDRESS points to the end of the SAL.
9645
9646 The array and the line spec strings are allocated on the heap, it is
9647 the caller's responsibility to free them. */
9648
9649static void
9650parse_breakpoint_sals (char **address,
9651 struct linespec_result *canonical)
9652{
9653 /* If no arg given, or if first arg is 'if ', use the default
9654 breakpoint. */
9655 if ((*address) == NULL
9656 || (strncmp ((*address), "if", 2) == 0 && isspace ((*address)[2])))
9657 {
9658 /* The last displayed codepoint, if it's valid, is our default breakpoint
9659 address. */
9660 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
9661 {
9662 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9663 struct symtab_and_line sal;
9664 CORE_ADDR pc;
9665
9666 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
9667 lsal.sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
9668 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
9669
9670 /* Set sal's pspace, pc, symtab, and line to the values
9671 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info.
9672 Be sure to reinitialize LINE with NOTCURRENT == 0
9673 as the breakpoint line number is inappropriate otherwise.
9674 find_pc_line would adjust PC, re-set it back. */
9675 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
9676 pc = sal.pc;
9677 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
9678
9679 /* "break" without arguments is equivalent to "break *PC"
9680 where PC is the last displayed codepoint's address. So
9681 make sure to set sal.explicit_pc to prevent GDB from
9682 trying to expand the list of sals to include all other
9683 instances with the same symtab and line. */
9684 sal.pc = pc;
9685 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
9686
9687 lsal.sals.sals[0] = sal;
9688 lsal.sals.nelts = 1;
9689 lsal.canonical = NULL;
9690
9691 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
9692 }
9693 else
9694 error (_("No default breakpoint address now."));
9695 }
9696 else
9697 {
9698 struct symtab_and_line cursal = get_current_source_symtab_and_line ();
9699
9700 /* Force almost all breakpoints to be in terms of the
9701 current_source_symtab (which is decode_line_1's default).
9702 This should produce the results we want almost all of the
9703 time while leaving default_breakpoint_* alone.
9704
9705 ObjC: However, don't match an Objective-C method name which
9706 may have a '+' or '-' succeeded by a '['. */
9707 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ()
9708 && (!cursal.symtab
9709 || ((strchr ("+-", (*address)[0]) != NULL)
9710 && ((*address)[1] != '['))))
9711 decode_line_full (address, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
9712 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
9713 get_last_displayed_line (),
9714 canonical, NULL, NULL);
9715 else
9716 decode_line_full (address, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
9717 cursal.symtab, cursal.line, canonical, NULL, NULL);
9718 }
9719}
9720
9721
9722/* Convert each SAL into a real PC. Verify that the PC can be
9723 inserted as a breakpoint. If it can't throw an error. */
9724
9725static void
9726breakpoint_sals_to_pc (struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9727{
9728 int i;
9729
9730 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9731 resolve_sal_pc (&sals->sals[i]);
9732}
9733
9734/* Fast tracepoints may have restrictions on valid locations. For
9735 instance, a fast tracepoint using a jump instead of a trap will
9736 likely have to overwrite more bytes than a trap would, and so can
9737 only be placed where the instruction is longer than the jump, or a
9738 multi-instruction sequence does not have a jump into the middle of
9739 it, etc. */
9740
9741static void
9742check_fast_tracepoint_sals (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9743 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
9744{
9745 int i, rslt;
9746 struct symtab_and_line *sal;
9747 char *msg;
9748 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9749
9750 for (i = 0; i < sals->nelts; i++)
9751 {
9752 struct gdbarch *sarch;
9753
9754 sal = &sals->sals[i];
9755
9756 sarch = get_sal_arch (*sal);
9757 /* We fall back to GDBARCH if there is no architecture
9758 associated with SAL. */
9759 if (sarch == NULL)
9760 sarch = gdbarch;
9761 rslt = gdbarch_fast_tracepoint_valid_at (sarch, sal->pc,
9762 NULL, &msg);
9763 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, msg);
9764
9765 if (!rslt)
9766 error (_("May not have a fast tracepoint at 0x%s%s"),
9767 paddress (sarch, sal->pc), (msg ? msg : ""));
9768
9769 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9770 }
9771}
9772
9773/* Issue an invalid thread ID error. */
9774
9775static void ATTRIBUTE_NORETURN
9776invalid_thread_id_error (int id)
9777{
9778 error (_("Unknown thread %d."), id);
9779}
9780
9781/* Given TOK, a string specification of condition and thread, as
9782 accepted by the 'break' command, extract the condition
9783 string and thread number and set *COND_STRING and *THREAD.
9784 PC identifies the context at which the condition should be parsed.
9785 If no condition is found, *COND_STRING is set to NULL.
9786 If no thread is found, *THREAD is set to -1. */
9787
9788static void
9789find_condition_and_thread (const char *tok, CORE_ADDR pc,
9790 char **cond_string, int *thread, int *task,
9791 char **rest)
9792{
9793 *cond_string = NULL;
9794 *thread = -1;
9795 *task = 0;
9796 *rest = NULL;
9797
9798 while (tok && *tok)
9799 {
9800 const char *end_tok;
9801 int toklen;
9802 const char *cond_start = NULL;
9803 const char *cond_end = NULL;
9804
9805 tok = skip_spaces_const (tok);
9806
9807 if ((*tok == '"' || *tok == ',') && rest)
9808 {
9809 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9810 return;
9811 }
9812
9813 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
9814
9815 toklen = end_tok - tok;
9816
9817 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
9818 {
9819 struct expression *expr;
9820
9821 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
9822 expr = parse_exp_1 (&tok, pc, block_for_pc (pc), 0);
9823 xfree (expr);
9824 cond_end = tok;
9825 *cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
9826 }
9827 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "thread", toklen) == 0)
9828 {
9829 char *tmptok;
9830
9831 tok = end_tok + 1;
9832 *thread = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9833 if (tok == tmptok)
9834 error (_("Junk after thread keyword."));
9835 if (!valid_thread_id (*thread))
9836 invalid_thread_id_error (*thread);
9837 tok = tmptok;
9838 }
9839 else if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "task", toklen) == 0)
9840 {
9841 char *tmptok;
9842
9843 tok = end_tok + 1;
9844 *task = strtol (tok, &tmptok, 0);
9845 if (tok == tmptok)
9846 error (_("Junk after task keyword."));
9847 if (!valid_task_id (*task))
9848 error (_("Unknown task %d."), *task);
9849 tok = tmptok;
9850 }
9851 else if (rest)
9852 {
9853 *rest = savestring (tok, strlen (tok));
9854 return;
9855 }
9856 else
9857 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
9858 }
9859}
9860
9861/* Decode a static tracepoint marker spec. */
9862
9863static struct symtabs_and_lines
9864decode_static_tracepoint_spec (char **arg_p)
9865{
9866 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers = NULL;
9867 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
9868 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9869 char *p = &(*arg_p)[3];
9870 char *endp;
9871 char *marker_str;
9872 int i;
9873
9874 p = skip_spaces (p);
9875
9876 endp = skip_to_space (p);
9877
9878 marker_str = savestring (p, endp - p);
9879 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, marker_str);
9880
9881 markers = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (marker_str);
9882 if (VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
9883 error (_("No known static tracepoint marker named %s"), marker_str);
9884
9885 sals.nelts = VEC_length(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers);
9886 sals.sals = xmalloc (sizeof *sals.sals * sals.nelts);
9887
9888 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
9889 {
9890 struct static_tracepoint_marker *marker;
9891
9892 marker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, i);
9893
9894 init_sal (&sals.sals[i]);
9895
9896 sals.sals[i] = find_pc_line (marker->address, 0);
9897 sals.sals[i].pc = marker->address;
9898
9899 release_static_tracepoint_marker (marker);
9900 }
9901
9902 do_cleanups (old_chain);
9903
9904 *arg_p = endp;
9905 return sals;
9906}
9907
9908/* Set a breakpoint. This function is shared between CLI and MI
9909 functions for setting a breakpoint. This function has two major
9910 modes of operations, selected by the PARSE_ARG parameter. If
9911 non-zero, the function will parse ARG, extracting location,
9912 condition, thread and extra string. Otherwise, ARG is just the
9913 breakpoint's location, with condition, thread, and extra string
9914 specified by the COND_STRING, THREAD and EXTRA_STRING parameters.
9915 If INTERNAL is non-zero, the breakpoint number will be allocated
9916 from the internal breakpoint count. Returns true if any breakpoint
9917 was created; false otherwise. */
9918
9919int
9920create_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
9921 char *arg, char *cond_string,
9922 int thread, char *extra_string,
9923 int parse_arg,
9924 int tempflag, enum bptype type_wanted,
9925 int ignore_count,
9926 enum auto_boolean pending_break_support,
9927 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
9928 int from_tty, int enabled, int internal,
9929 unsigned flags)
9930{
9931 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
9932 char *copy_arg = NULL;
9933 char *addr_start = arg;
9934 struct linespec_result canonical;
9935 struct cleanup *old_chain;
9936 struct cleanup *bkpt_chain = NULL;
9937 int pending = 0;
9938 int task = 0;
9939 int prev_bkpt_count = breakpoint_count;
9940
9941 gdb_assert (ops != NULL);
9942
9943 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
9944
9945 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
9946 {
9947 ops->create_sals_from_address (&arg, &canonical, type_wanted,
9948 addr_start, &copy_arg);
9949 }
9950
9951 /* If caller is interested in rc value from parse, set value. */
9952 switch (e.reason)
9953 {
9954 case GDB_NO_ERROR:
9955 if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical.sals))
9956 return 0;
9957 break;
9958 case RETURN_ERROR:
9959 switch (e.error)
9960 {
9961 case NOT_FOUND_ERROR:
9962
9963 /* If pending breakpoint support is turned off, throw
9964 error. */
9965
9966 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_FALSE)
9967 throw_exception (e);
9968
9969 exception_print (gdb_stderr, e);
9970
9971 /* If pending breakpoint support is auto query and the user
9972 selects no, then simply return the error code. */
9973 if (pending_break_support == AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO
9974 && !nquery (_("Make %s pending on future shared library load? "),
9975 bptype_string (type_wanted)))
9976 return 0;
9977
9978 /* At this point, either the user was queried about setting
9979 a pending breakpoint and selected yes, or pending
9980 breakpoint behavior is on and thus a pending breakpoint
9981 is defaulted on behalf of the user. */
9982 {
9983 struct linespec_sals lsal;
9984
9985 copy_arg = xstrdup (addr_start);
9986 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (copy_arg);
9987 lsal.sals.nelts = 1;
9988 lsal.sals.sals = XNEW (struct symtab_and_line);
9989 init_sal (&lsal.sals.sals[0]);
9990 pending = 1;
9991 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, &lsal);
9992 }
9993 break;
9994 default:
9995 throw_exception (e);
9996 }
9997 break;
9998 default:
9999 throw_exception (e);
10000 }
10001
10002 /* Create a chain of things that always need to be cleaned up. */
10003 old_chain = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
10004
10005 /* ----------------------------- SNIP -----------------------------
10006 Anything added to the cleanup chain beyond this point is assumed
10007 to be part of a breakpoint. If the breakpoint create succeeds
10008 then the memory is not reclaimed. */
10009 bkpt_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, 0);
10010
10011 /* Resolve all line numbers to PC's and verify that the addresses
10012 are ok for the target. */
10013 if (!pending)
10014 {
10015 int ix;
10016 struct linespec_sals *iter;
10017
10018 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
10019 breakpoint_sals_to_pc (&iter->sals);
10020 }
10021
10022 /* Fast tracepoints may have additional restrictions on location. */
10023 if (!pending && type_wanted == bp_fast_tracepoint)
10024 {
10025 int ix;
10026 struct linespec_sals *iter;
10027
10028 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, ix, iter); ++ix)
10029 check_fast_tracepoint_sals (gdbarch, &iter->sals);
10030 }
10031
10032 /* Verify that condition can be parsed, before setting any
10033 breakpoints. Allocate a separate condition expression for each
10034 breakpoint. */
10035 if (!pending)
10036 {
10037 if (parse_arg)
10038 {
10039 char *rest;
10040 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
10041
10042 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
10043
10044 /* Here we only parse 'arg' to separate condition
10045 from thread number, so parsing in context of first
10046 sal is OK. When setting the breakpoint we'll
10047 re-parse it in context of each sal. */
10048
10049 find_condition_and_thread (arg, lsal->sals.sals[0].pc, &cond_string,
10050 &thread, &task, &rest);
10051 if (cond_string)
10052 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
10053 if (rest)
10054 make_cleanup (xfree, rest);
10055 if (rest)
10056 extra_string = rest;
10057 }
10058 else
10059 {
10060 if (*arg != '\0')
10061 error (_("Garbage '%s' at end of location"), arg);
10062
10063 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
10064 if (cond_string)
10065 {
10066 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
10067 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
10068 }
10069 /* Create a private copy of any extra string. */
10070 if (extra_string)
10071 {
10072 extra_string = xstrdup (extra_string);
10073 make_cleanup (xfree, extra_string);
10074 }
10075 }
10076
10077 ops->create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, &canonical,
10078 cond_string, extra_string, type_wanted,
10079 tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch,
10080 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
10081 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags);
10082 }
10083 else
10084 {
10085 struct breakpoint *b;
10086
10087 make_cleanup (xfree, copy_arg);
10088
10089 if (is_tracepoint_type (type_wanted))
10090 {
10091 struct tracepoint *t;
10092
10093 t = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
10094 b = &t->base;
10095 }
10096 else
10097 b = XNEW (struct breakpoint);
10098
10099 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, gdbarch, type_wanted, ops);
10100
10101 b->addr_string = copy_arg;
10102 if (parse_arg)
10103 b->cond_string = NULL;
10104 else
10105 {
10106 /* Create a private copy of condition string. */
10107 if (cond_string)
10108 {
10109 cond_string = xstrdup (cond_string);
10110 make_cleanup (xfree, cond_string);
10111 }
10112 b->cond_string = cond_string;
10113 }
10114 b->extra_string = NULL;
10115 b->ignore_count = ignore_count;
10116 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
10117 b->condition_not_parsed = 1;
10118 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
10119 if ((type_wanted != bp_breakpoint
10120 && type_wanted != bp_hardware_breakpoint) || thread != -1)
10121 b->pspace = current_program_space;
10122
10123 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 0);
10124 }
10125
10126 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 1)
10127 {
10128 warning (_("Multiple breakpoints were set.\nUse the "
10129 "\"delete\" command to delete unwanted breakpoints."));
10130 prev_breakpoint_count = prev_bkpt_count;
10131 }
10132
10133 /* That's it. Discard the cleanups for data inserted into the
10134 breakpoint. */
10135 discard_cleanups (bkpt_chain);
10136 /* But cleanup everything else. */
10137 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10138
10139 /* error call may happen here - have BKPT_CHAIN already discarded. */
10140 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
10141
10142 return 1;
10143}
10144
10145/* Set a breakpoint.
10146 ARG is a string describing breakpoint address,
10147 condition, and thread.
10148 FLAG specifies if a breakpoint is hardware on,
10149 and if breakpoint is temporary, using BP_HARDWARE_FLAG
10150 and BP_TEMPFLAG. */
10151
10152static void
10153break_command_1 (char *arg, int flag, int from_tty)
10154{
10155 int tempflag = flag & BP_TEMPFLAG;
10156 enum bptype type_wanted = (flag & BP_HARDWAREFLAG
10157 ? bp_hardware_breakpoint
10158 : bp_breakpoint);
10159 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
10160 const char *arg_cp = arg;
10161
10162 /* Matching breakpoints on probes. */
10163 if (arg && probe_linespec_to_ops (&arg_cp) != NULL)
10164 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
10165 else
10166 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
10167
10168 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10169 arg,
10170 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
10171 tempflag, type_wanted,
10172 0 /* Ignore count */,
10173 pending_break_support,
10174 ops,
10175 from_tty,
10176 1 /* enabled */,
10177 0 /* internal */,
10178 0);
10179}
10180
10181/* Helper function for break_command_1 and disassemble_command. */
10182
10183void
10184resolve_sal_pc (struct symtab_and_line *sal)
10185{
10186 CORE_ADDR pc;
10187
10188 if (sal->pc == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
10189 {
10190 if (!find_line_pc (sal->symtab, sal->line, &pc))
10191 error (_("No line %d in file \"%s\"."),
10192 sal->line, symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal->symtab));
10193 sal->pc = pc;
10194
10195 /* If this SAL corresponds to a breakpoint inserted using a line
10196 number, then skip the function prologue if necessary. */
10197 if (sal->explicit_line)
10198 skip_prologue_sal (sal);
10199 }
10200
10201 if (sal->section == 0 && sal->symtab != NULL)
10202 {
10203 const struct blockvector *bv;
10204 const struct block *b;
10205 struct symbol *sym;
10206
10207 bv = blockvector_for_pc_sect (sal->pc, 0, &b, sal->symtab);
10208 if (bv != NULL)
10209 {
10210 sym = block_linkage_function (b);
10211 if (sym != NULL)
10212 {
10213 fixup_symbol_section (sym, SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab));
10214 sal->section = SYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (SYMTAB_OBJFILE (sal->symtab),
10215 sym);
10216 }
10217 else
10218 {
10219 /* It really is worthwhile to have the section, so we'll
10220 just have to look harder. This case can be executed
10221 if we have line numbers but no functions (as can
10222 happen in assembly source). */
10223
10224 struct bound_minimal_symbol msym;
10225 struct cleanup *old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
10226
10227 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sal->pspace);
10228
10229 msym = lookup_minimal_symbol_by_pc (sal->pc);
10230 if (msym.minsym)
10231 sal->section = MSYMBOL_OBJ_SECTION (msym.objfile, msym.minsym);
10232
10233 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10234 }
10235 }
10236 }
10237}
10238
10239void
10240break_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10241{
10242 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10243}
10244
10245void
10246tbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10247{
10248 break_command_1 (arg, BP_TEMPFLAG, from_tty);
10249}
10250
10251static void
10252hbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10253{
10254 break_command_1 (arg, BP_HARDWAREFLAG, from_tty);
10255}
10256
10257static void
10258thbreak_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10259{
10260 break_command_1 (arg, (BP_TEMPFLAG | BP_HARDWAREFLAG), from_tty);
10261}
10262
10263static void
10264stop_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10265{
10266 printf_filtered (_("Specify the type of breakpoint to set.\n\
10267Usage: stop in <function | address>\n\
10268 stop at <line>\n"));
10269}
10270
10271static void
10272stopin_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10273{
10274 int badInput = 0;
10275
10276 if (arg == (char *) NULL)
10277 badInput = 1;
10278 else if (*arg != '*')
10279 {
10280 char *argptr = arg;
10281 int hasColon = 0;
10282
10283 /* Look for a ':'. If this is a line number specification, then
10284 say it is bad, otherwise, it should be an address or
10285 function/method name. */
10286 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10287 {
10288 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10289 argptr++;
10290 }
10291
10292 if (hasColon)
10293 badInput = (*argptr != ':'); /* Not a class::method */
10294 else
10295 badInput = isdigit (*arg); /* a simple line number */
10296 }
10297
10298 if (badInput)
10299 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop in <function | address>\n"));
10300 else
10301 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10302}
10303
10304static void
10305stopat_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10306{
10307 int badInput = 0;
10308
10309 if (arg == (char *) NULL || *arg == '*') /* no line number */
10310 badInput = 1;
10311 else
10312 {
10313 char *argptr = arg;
10314 int hasColon = 0;
10315
10316 /* Look for a ':'. If there is a '::' then get out, otherwise
10317 it is probably a line number. */
10318 while (*argptr && !hasColon)
10319 {
10320 hasColon = (*argptr == ':');
10321 argptr++;
10322 }
10323
10324 if (hasColon)
10325 badInput = (*argptr == ':'); /* we have class::method */
10326 else
10327 badInput = !isdigit (*arg); /* not a line number */
10328 }
10329
10330 if (badInput)
10331 printf_filtered (_("Usage: stop at <line>\n"));
10332 else
10333 break_command_1 (arg, 0, from_tty);
10334}
10335
10336/* The dynamic printf command is mostly like a regular breakpoint, but
10337 with a prewired command list consisting of a single output command,
10338 built from extra arguments supplied on the dprintf command
10339 line. */
10340
10341static void
10342dprintf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10343{
10344 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
10345 arg,
10346 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
10347 0, bp_dprintf,
10348 0 /* Ignore count */,
10349 pending_break_support,
10350 &dprintf_breakpoint_ops,
10351 from_tty,
10352 1 /* enabled */,
10353 0 /* internal */,
10354 0);
10355}
10356
10357static void
10358agent_printf_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10359{
10360 error (_("May only run agent-printf on the target"));
10361}
10362
10363/* Implement the "breakpoint_hit" breakpoint_ops method for
10364 ranged breakpoints. */
10365
10366static int
10367breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10368 struct address_space *aspace,
10369 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10370 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10371{
10372 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
10373 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
10374 return 0;
10375
10376 return breakpoint_address_match_range (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
10377 bl->length, aspace, bp_addr);
10378}
10379
10380/* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10381 ranged breakpoints. */
10382
10383static int
10384resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10385{
10386 return target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10387}
10388
10389/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
10390 ranged breakpoints. */
10391
10392static enum print_stop_action
10393print_it_ranged_breakpoint (bpstat bs)
10394{
10395 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10396 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10397 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10398
10399 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10400
10401 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10402 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10403
10404 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
10405 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
10406 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary ranged breakpoint ");
10407 else
10408 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nRanged breakpoint ");
10409 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10410 {
10411 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
10412 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
10413 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
10414 }
10415 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
10416 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
10417
10418 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
10419}
10420
10421/* Implement the "print_one" breakpoint_ops method for
10422 ranged breakpoints. */
10423
10424static void
10425print_one_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
10426 struct bp_location **last_loc)
10427{
10428 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10429 struct value_print_options opts;
10430 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10431
10432 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one location. */
10433 gdb_assert (bl && bl->next == NULL);
10434
10435 get_user_print_options (&opts);
10436
10437 if (opts.addressprint)
10438 /* We don't print the address range here, it will be printed later
10439 by print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint. */
10440 ui_out_field_skip (uiout, "addr");
10441 annotate_field (5);
10442 print_breakpoint_location (b, bl);
10443 *last_loc = bl;
10444}
10445
10446/* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
10447 ranged breakpoints. */
10448
10449static void
10450print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
10451 struct ui_out *uiout)
10452{
10453 CORE_ADDR address_start, address_end;
10454 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10455 struct ui_file *stb = mem_fileopen ();
10456 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10457
10458 gdb_assert (bl);
10459
10460 address_start = bl->address;
10461 address_end = address_start + bl->length - 1;
10462
10463 ui_out_text (uiout, "\taddress range: ");
10464 fprintf_unfiltered (stb, "[%s, %s]",
10465 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_start),
10466 print_core_address (bl->gdbarch, address_end));
10467 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "addr", stb);
10468 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10469
10470 do_cleanups (cleanup);
10471}
10472
10473/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
10474 ranged breakpoints. */
10475
10476static void
10477print_mention_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10478{
10479 struct bp_location *bl = b->loc;
10480 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10481
10482 gdb_assert (bl);
10483 gdb_assert (b->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
10484
10485 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10486 return;
10487
10488 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted ranged breakpoint %d from %s to %s."),
10489 b->number, paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address),
10490 paddress (bl->gdbarch, bl->address + bl->length - 1));
10491}
10492
10493/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
10494 ranged breakpoints. */
10495
10496static void
10497print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
10498{
10499 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break-range %s, %s", b->addr_string,
10500 b->addr_string_range_end);
10501 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
10502}
10503
10504/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in ranged breakpoints. */
10505
10506static struct breakpoint_ops ranged_breakpoint_ops;
10507
10508/* Find the address where the end of the breakpoint range should be
10509 placed, given the SAL of the end of the range. This is so that if
10510 the user provides a line number, the end of the range is set to the
10511 last instruction of the given line. */
10512
10513static CORE_ADDR
10514find_breakpoint_range_end (struct symtab_and_line sal)
10515{
10516 CORE_ADDR end;
10517
10518 /* If the user provided a PC value, use it. Otherwise,
10519 find the address of the end of the given location. */
10520 if (sal.explicit_pc)
10521 end = sal.pc;
10522 else
10523 {
10524 int ret;
10525 CORE_ADDR start;
10526
10527 ret = find_line_pc_range (sal, &start, &end);
10528 if (!ret)
10529 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10530
10531 /* find_line_pc_range returns the start of the next line. */
10532 end--;
10533 }
10534
10535 return end;
10536}
10537
10538/* Implement the "break-range" CLI command. */
10539
10540static void
10541break_range_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
10542{
10543 char *arg_start, *addr_string_start, *addr_string_end;
10544 struct linespec_result canonical_start, canonical_end;
10545 int bp_count, can_use_bp, length;
10546 CORE_ADDR end;
10547 struct breakpoint *b;
10548 struct symtab_and_line sal_start, sal_end;
10549 struct cleanup *cleanup_bkpt;
10550 struct linespec_sals *lsal_start, *lsal_end;
10551
10552 /* We don't support software ranged breakpoints. */
10553 if (target_ranged_break_num_registers () < 0)
10554 error (_("This target does not support hardware ranged breakpoints."));
10555
10556 bp_count = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
10557 bp_count += target_ranged_break_num_registers ();
10558 can_use_bp = target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
10559 bp_count, 0);
10560 if (can_use_bp < 0)
10561 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
10562
10563 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10564 if (arg == NULL || arg[0] == '\0')
10565 error(_("No address range specified."));
10566
10567 init_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10568
10569 arg_start = arg;
10570 parse_breakpoint_sals (&arg, &canonical_start);
10571
10572 cleanup_bkpt = make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_start);
10573
10574 if (arg[0] != ',')
10575 error (_("Too few arguments."));
10576 else if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals))
10577 error (_("Could not find location of the beginning of the range."));
10578
10579 lsal_start = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals, 0);
10580
10581 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_start.sals) > 1
10582 || lsal_start->sals.nelts != 1)
10583 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10584
10585 sal_start = lsal_start->sals.sals[0];
10586 addr_string_start = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
10587 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_start);
10588
10589 arg++; /* Skip the comma. */
10590 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
10591
10592 /* Parse the end location. */
10593
10594 init_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10595 arg_start = arg;
10596
10597 /* We call decode_line_full directly here instead of using
10598 parse_breakpoint_sals because we need to specify the start location's
10599 symtab and line as the default symtab and line for the end of the
10600 range. This makes it possible to have ranges like "foo.c:27, +14",
10601 where +14 means 14 lines from the start location. */
10602 decode_line_full (&arg, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
10603 sal_start.symtab, sal_start.line,
10604 &canonical_end, NULL, NULL);
10605
10606 make_cleanup_destroy_linespec_result (&canonical_end);
10607
10608 if (VEC_empty (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals))
10609 error (_("Could not find location of the end of the range."));
10610
10611 lsal_end = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals, 0);
10612 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical_end.sals) > 1
10613 || lsal_end->sals.nelts != 1)
10614 error (_("Cannot create a ranged breakpoint with multiple locations."));
10615
10616 sal_end = lsal_end->sals.sals[0];
10617 addr_string_end = savestring (arg_start, arg - arg_start);
10618 make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string_end);
10619
10620 end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sal_end);
10621 if (sal_start.pc > end)
10622 error (_("Invalid address range, end precedes start."));
10623
10624 length = end - sal_start.pc + 1;
10625 if (length < 0)
10626 /* Length overflowed. */
10627 error (_("Address range too large."));
10628 else if (length == 1)
10629 {
10630 /* This range is simple enough to be handled by
10631 the `hbreak' command. */
10632 hbreak_command (addr_string_start, 1);
10633
10634 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10635
10636 return;
10637 }
10638
10639 /* Now set up the breakpoint. */
10640 b = set_raw_breakpoint (get_current_arch (), sal_start,
10641 bp_hardware_breakpoint, &ranged_breakpoint_ops);
10642 set_breakpoint_count (breakpoint_count + 1);
10643 b->number = breakpoint_count;
10644 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
10645 b->addr_string = xstrdup (addr_string_start);
10646 b->addr_string_range_end = xstrdup (addr_string_end);
10647 b->loc->length = length;
10648
10649 do_cleanups (cleanup_bkpt);
10650
10651 mention (b);
10652 observer_notify_breakpoint_created (b);
10653 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
10654}
10655
10656/* Return non-zero if EXP is verified as constant. Returned zero
10657 means EXP is variable. Also the constant detection may fail for
10658 some constant expressions and in such case still falsely return
10659 zero. */
10660
10661static int
10662watchpoint_exp_is_const (const struct expression *exp)
10663{
10664 int i = exp->nelts;
10665
10666 while (i > 0)
10667 {
10668 int oplenp, argsp;
10669
10670 /* We are only interested in the descriptor of each element. */
10671 operator_length (exp, i, &oplenp, &argsp);
10672 i -= oplenp;
10673
10674 switch (exp->elts[i].opcode)
10675 {
10676 case BINOP_ADD:
10677 case BINOP_SUB:
10678 case BINOP_MUL:
10679 case BINOP_DIV:
10680 case BINOP_REM:
10681 case BINOP_MOD:
10682 case BINOP_LSH:
10683 case BINOP_RSH:
10684 case BINOP_LOGICAL_AND:
10685 case BINOP_LOGICAL_OR:
10686 case BINOP_BITWISE_AND:
10687 case BINOP_BITWISE_IOR:
10688 case BINOP_BITWISE_XOR:
10689 case BINOP_EQUAL:
10690 case BINOP_NOTEQUAL:
10691 case BINOP_LESS:
10692 case BINOP_GTR:
10693 case BINOP_LEQ:
10694 case BINOP_GEQ:
10695 case BINOP_REPEAT:
10696 case BINOP_COMMA:
10697 case BINOP_EXP:
10698 case BINOP_MIN:
10699 case BINOP_MAX:
10700 case BINOP_INTDIV:
10701 case BINOP_CONCAT:
10702 case TERNOP_COND:
10703 case TERNOP_SLICE:
10704
10705 case OP_LONG:
10706 case OP_DOUBLE:
10707 case OP_DECFLOAT:
10708 case OP_LAST:
10709 case OP_COMPLEX:
10710 case OP_STRING:
10711 case OP_ARRAY:
10712 case OP_TYPE:
10713 case OP_TYPEOF:
10714 case OP_DECLTYPE:
10715 case OP_TYPEID:
10716 case OP_NAME:
10717 case OP_OBJC_NSSTRING:
10718
10719 case UNOP_NEG:
10720 case UNOP_LOGICAL_NOT:
10721 case UNOP_COMPLEMENT:
10722 case UNOP_ADDR:
10723 case UNOP_HIGH:
10724 case UNOP_CAST:
10725
10726 case UNOP_CAST_TYPE:
10727 case UNOP_REINTERPRET_CAST:
10728 case UNOP_DYNAMIC_CAST:
10729 /* Unary, binary and ternary operators: We have to check
10730 their operands. If they are constant, then so is the
10731 result of that operation. For instance, if A and B are
10732 determined to be constants, then so is "A + B".
10733
10734 UNOP_IND is one exception to the rule above, because the
10735 value of *ADDR is not necessarily a constant, even when
10736 ADDR is. */
10737 break;
10738
10739 case OP_VAR_VALUE:
10740 /* Check whether the associated symbol is a constant.
10741
10742 We use SYMBOL_CLASS rather than TYPE_CONST because it's
10743 possible that a buggy compiler could mark a variable as
10744 constant even when it is not, and TYPE_CONST would return
10745 true in this case, while SYMBOL_CLASS wouldn't.
10746
10747 We also have to check for function symbols because they
10748 are always constant. */
10749 {
10750 struct symbol *s = exp->elts[i + 2].symbol;
10751
10752 if (SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_BLOCK
10753 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST
10754 && SYMBOL_CLASS (s) != LOC_CONST_BYTES)
10755 return 0;
10756 break;
10757 }
10758
10759 /* The default action is to return 0 because we are using
10760 the optimistic approach here: If we don't know something,
10761 then it is not a constant. */
10762 default:
10763 return 0;
10764 }
10765 }
10766
10767 return 1;
10768}
10769
10770/* Implement the "dtor" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10771
10772static void
10773dtor_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *self)
10774{
10775 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) self;
10776
10777 xfree (w->cond_exp);
10778 xfree (w->exp);
10779 xfree (w->exp_string);
10780 xfree (w->exp_string_reparse);
10781 value_free (w->val);
10782
10783 base_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
10784}
10785
10786/* Implement the "re_set" breakpoint_ops method for watchpoints. */
10787
10788static void
10789re_set_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10790{
10791 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10792
10793 /* Watchpoint can be either on expression using entirely global
10794 variables, or it can be on local variables.
10795
10796 Watchpoints of the first kind are never auto-deleted, and even
10797 persist across program restarts. Since they can use variables
10798 from shared libraries, we need to reparse expression as libraries
10799 are loaded and unloaded.
10800
10801 Watchpoints on local variables can also change meaning as result
10802 of solib event. For example, if a watchpoint uses both a local
10803 and a global variables in expression, it's a local watchpoint,
10804 but unloading of a shared library will make the expression
10805 invalid. This is not a very common use case, but we still
10806 re-evaluate expression, to avoid surprises to the user.
10807
10808 Note that for local watchpoints, we re-evaluate it only if
10809 watchpoints frame id is still valid. If it's not, it means the
10810 watchpoint is out of scope and will be deleted soon. In fact,
10811 I'm not sure we'll ever be called in this case.
10812
10813 If a local watchpoint's frame id is still valid, then
10814 w->exp_valid_block is likewise valid, and we can safely use it.
10815
10816 Don't do anything about disabled watchpoints, since they will be
10817 reevaluated again when enabled. */
10818 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
10819}
10820
10821/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10822
10823static int
10824insert_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10825{
10826 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10827 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10828
10829 return target_insert_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10830 w->cond_exp);
10831}
10832
10833/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for hardware watchpoints. */
10834
10835static int
10836remove_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
10837{
10838 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10839 int length = w->exact ? 1 : bl->length;
10840
10841 return target_remove_watchpoint (bl->address, length, bl->watchpoint_type,
10842 w->cond_exp);
10843}
10844
10845static int
10846breakpoint_hit_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl,
10847 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
10848 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
10849{
10850 struct breakpoint *b = bl->owner;
10851 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10852
10853 /* Continuable hardware watchpoints are treated as non-existent if the
10854 reason we stopped wasn't a hardware watchpoint (we didn't stop on
10855 some data address). Otherwise gdb won't stop on a break instruction
10856 in the code (not from a breakpoint) when a hardware watchpoint has
10857 been defined. Also skip watchpoints which we know did not trigger
10858 (did not match the data address). */
10859 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (b)
10860 && w->watchpoint_triggered == watch_triggered_no)
10861 return 0;
10862
10863 return 1;
10864}
10865
10866static void
10867check_status_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10868{
10869 gdb_assert (is_watchpoint (bs->breakpoint_at));
10870
10871 bpstat_check_watchpoint (bs);
10872}
10873
10874/* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
10875 hardware watchpoints. */
10876
10877static int
10878resources_needed_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
10879{
10880 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
10881 int length = w->exact? 1 : bl->length;
10882
10883 return target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (bl->address, length);
10884}
10885
10886/* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
10887 hardware watchpoints. */
10888
10889static int
10890works_in_software_mode_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
10891{
10892 /* Read and access watchpoints only work with hardware support. */
10893 return b->type == bp_watchpoint || b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint;
10894}
10895
10896static enum print_stop_action
10897print_it_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
10898{
10899 struct cleanup *old_chain;
10900 struct breakpoint *b;
10901 struct ui_file *stb;
10902 enum print_stop_action result;
10903 struct watchpoint *w;
10904 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10905
10906 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
10907
10908 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
10909 w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10910
10911 stb = mem_fileopen ();
10912 old_chain = make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (stb);
10913
10914 switch (b->type)
10915 {
10916 case bp_watchpoint:
10917 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
10918 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10919 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10920 ui_out_field_string
10921 (uiout, "reason",
10922 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10923 mention (b);
10924 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10925 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10926 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10927 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10928 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10929 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10930 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10931 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10932 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
10933 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10934 break;
10935
10936 case bp_read_watchpoint:
10937 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10938 ui_out_field_string
10939 (uiout, "reason",
10940 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10941 mention (b);
10942 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10943 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10944 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10945 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "value", stb);
10946 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10947 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10948 break;
10949
10950 case bp_access_watchpoint:
10951 if (bs->old_val != NULL)
10952 {
10953 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
10954 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10955 ui_out_field_string
10956 (uiout, "reason",
10957 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10958 mention (b);
10959 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10960 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nOld value = ");
10961 watchpoint_value_print (bs->old_val, stb);
10962 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "old", stb);
10963 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nNew value = ");
10964 }
10965 else
10966 {
10967 mention (b);
10968 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
10969 ui_out_field_string
10970 (uiout, "reason",
10971 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
10972 make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "value");
10973 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nValue = ");
10974 }
10975 watchpoint_value_print (w->val, stb);
10976 ui_out_field_stream (uiout, "new", stb);
10977 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
10978 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10979 break;
10980 default:
10981 result = PRINT_UNKNOWN;
10982 }
10983
10984 do_cleanups (old_chain);
10985 return result;
10986}
10987
10988/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for hardware
10989 watchpoints. */
10990
10991static void
10992print_mention_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
10993{
10994 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
10995 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
10996 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
10997
10998 switch (b->type)
10999 {
11000 case bp_watchpoint:
11001 ui_out_text (uiout, "Watchpoint ");
11002 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
11003 break;
11004 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11005 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware watchpoint ");
11006 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
11007 break;
11008 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11009 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware read watchpoint ");
11010 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
11011 break;
11012 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11013 ui_out_text (uiout, "Hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
11014 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
11015 break;
11016 default:
11017 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11018 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11019 }
11020
11021 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
11022 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
11023 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
11024 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
11025}
11026
11027/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
11028 watchpoints. */
11029
11030static void
11031print_recreate_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11032{
11033 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11034
11035 switch (b->type)
11036 {
11037 case bp_watchpoint:
11038 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11039 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11040 break;
11041 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11042 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
11043 break;
11044 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11045 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
11046 break;
11047 default:
11048 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11049 _("Invalid watchpoint type."));
11050 }
11051
11052 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", w->exp_string);
11053 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
11054}
11055
11056/* Implement the "explains_signal" breakpoint_ops method for
11057 watchpoints. */
11058
11059static int
11060explains_signal_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
11061{
11062 /* A software watchpoint cannot cause a signal other than
11063 GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP. */
11064 if (b->type == bp_watchpoint && sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
11065 return 0;
11066
11067 return 1;
11068}
11069
11070/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in hardware watchpoints. */
11071
11072static struct breakpoint_ops watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
11073
11074/* Implement the "insert" breakpoint_ops method for
11075 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11076
11077static int
11078insert_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
11079{
11080 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
11081
11082 return target_insert_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
11083 bl->watchpoint_type);
11084}
11085
11086/* Implement the "remove" breakpoint_ops method for
11087 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11088
11089static int
11090remove_masked_watchpoint (struct bp_location *bl)
11091{
11092 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
11093
11094 return target_remove_mask_watchpoint (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask,
11095 bl->watchpoint_type);
11096}
11097
11098/* Implement the "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method for
11099 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11100
11101static int
11102resources_needed_masked_watchpoint (const struct bp_location *bl)
11103{
11104 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bl->owner;
11105
11106 return target_masked_watch_num_registers (bl->address, w->hw_wp_mask);
11107}
11108
11109/* Implement the "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method for
11110 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11111
11112static int
11113works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
11114{
11115 return 0;
11116}
11117
11118/* Implement the "print_it" breakpoint_ops method for
11119 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11120
11121static enum print_stop_action
11122print_it_masked_watchpoint (bpstat bs)
11123{
11124 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
11125 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11126
11127 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
11128 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
11129
11130 switch (b->type)
11131 {
11132 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11133 annotate_watchpoint (b->number);
11134 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11135 ui_out_field_string
11136 (uiout, "reason",
11137 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11138 break;
11139
11140 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11141 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11142 ui_out_field_string
11143 (uiout, "reason",
11144 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_READ_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11145 break;
11146
11147 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11148 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
11149 ui_out_field_string
11150 (uiout, "reason",
11151 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_ACCESS_WATCHPOINT_TRIGGER));
11152 break;
11153 default:
11154 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11155 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11156 }
11157
11158 mention (b);
11159 ui_out_text (uiout, _("\n\
11160Check the underlying instruction at PC for the memory\n\
11161address and value which triggered this watchpoint.\n"));
11162 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
11163
11164 /* More than one watchpoint may have been triggered. */
11165 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
11166}
11167
11168/* Implement the "print_one_detail" breakpoint_ops method for
11169 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11170
11171static void
11172print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b,
11173 struct ui_out *uiout)
11174{
11175 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11176
11177 /* Masked watchpoints have only one location. */
11178 gdb_assert (b->loc && b->loc->next == NULL);
11179
11180 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmask ");
11181 ui_out_field_core_addr (uiout, "mask", b->loc->gdbarch, w->hw_wp_mask);
11182 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
11183}
11184
11185/* Implement the "print_mention" breakpoint_ops method for
11186 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11187
11188static void
11189print_mention_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
11190{
11191 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11192 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
11193 struct cleanup *ui_out_chain;
11194
11195 switch (b->type)
11196 {
11197 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11198 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware watchpoint ");
11199 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "wpt");
11200 break;
11201 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11202 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware read watchpoint ");
11203 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-rwpt");
11204 break;
11205 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11206 ui_out_text (uiout, "Masked hardware access (read/write) watchpoint ");
11207 ui_out_chain = make_cleanup_ui_out_tuple_begin_end (uiout, "hw-awpt");
11208 break;
11209 default:
11210 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11211 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11212 }
11213
11214 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "number", b->number);
11215 ui_out_text (uiout, ": ");
11216 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "exp", w->exp_string);
11217 do_cleanups (ui_out_chain);
11218}
11219
11220/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for
11221 masked hardware watchpoints. */
11222
11223static void
11224print_recreate_masked_watchpoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
11225{
11226 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) b;
11227 char tmp[40];
11228
11229 switch (b->type)
11230 {
11231 case bp_hardware_watchpoint:
11232 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "watch");
11233 break;
11234 case bp_read_watchpoint:
11235 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "rwatch");
11236 break;
11237 case bp_access_watchpoint:
11238 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "awatch");
11239 break;
11240 default:
11241 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
11242 _("Invalid hardware watchpoint type."));
11243 }
11244
11245 sprintf_vma (tmp, w->hw_wp_mask);
11246 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s mask 0x%s", w->exp_string, tmp);
11247 print_recreate_thread (b, fp);
11248}
11249
11250/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in masked hardware watchpoints. */
11251
11252static struct breakpoint_ops masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
11253
11254/* Tell whether the given watchpoint is a masked hardware watchpoint. */
11255
11256static int
11257is_masked_watchpoint (const struct breakpoint *b)
11258{
11259 return b->ops == &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
11260}
11261
11262/* accessflag: hw_write: watch write,
11263 hw_read: watch read,
11264 hw_access: watch access (read or write) */
11265static void
11266watch_command_1 (const char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty,
11267 int just_location, int internal)
11268{
11269 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
11270 struct breakpoint *b, *scope_breakpoint = NULL;
11271 struct expression *exp;
11272 const struct block *exp_valid_block = NULL, *cond_exp_valid_block = NULL;
11273 struct value *val, *mark, *result;
11274 int saved_bitpos = 0, saved_bitsize = 0;
11275 struct frame_info *frame;
11276 const char *exp_start = NULL;
11277 const char *exp_end = NULL;
11278 const char *tok, *end_tok;
11279 int toklen = -1;
11280 const char *cond_start = NULL;
11281 const char *cond_end = NULL;
11282 enum bptype bp_type;
11283 int thread = -1;
11284 int pc = 0;
11285 /* Flag to indicate whether we are going to use masks for
11286 the hardware watchpoint. */
11287 int use_mask = 0;
11288 CORE_ADDR mask = 0;
11289 struct watchpoint *w;
11290 char *expression;
11291 struct cleanup *back_to;
11292
11293 /* Make sure that we actually have parameters to parse. */
11294 if (arg != NULL && arg[0] != '\0')
11295 {
11296 const char *value_start;
11297
11298 exp_end = arg + strlen (arg);
11299
11300 /* Look for "parameter value" pairs at the end
11301 of the arguments string. */
11302 for (tok = exp_end - 1; tok > arg; tok--)
11303 {
11304 /* Skip whitespace at the end of the argument list. */
11305 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11306 tok--;
11307
11308 /* Find the beginning of the last token.
11309 This is the value of the parameter. */
11310 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11311 tok--;
11312 value_start = tok + 1;
11313
11314 /* Skip whitespace. */
11315 while (tok > arg && (*tok == ' ' || *tok == '\t'))
11316 tok--;
11317
11318 end_tok = tok;
11319
11320 /* Find the beginning of the second to last token.
11321 This is the parameter itself. */
11322 while (tok > arg && (*tok != ' ' && *tok != '\t'))
11323 tok--;
11324 tok++;
11325 toklen = end_tok - tok + 1;
11326
11327 if (toklen == 6 && !strncmp (tok, "thread", 6))
11328 {
11329 /* At this point we've found a "thread" token, which means
11330 the user is trying to set a watchpoint that triggers
11331 only in a specific thread. */
11332 char *endp;
11333
11334 if (thread != -1)
11335 error(_("You can specify only one thread."));
11336
11337 /* Extract the thread ID from the next token. */
11338 thread = strtol (value_start, &endp, 0);
11339
11340 /* Check if the user provided a valid numeric value for the
11341 thread ID. */
11342 if (*endp != ' ' && *endp != '\t' && *endp != '\0')
11343 error (_("Invalid thread ID specification %s."), value_start);
11344
11345 /* Check if the thread actually exists. */
11346 if (!valid_thread_id (thread))
11347 invalid_thread_id_error (thread);
11348 }
11349 else if (toklen == 4 && !strncmp (tok, "mask", 4))
11350 {
11351 /* We've found a "mask" token, which means the user wants to
11352 create a hardware watchpoint that is going to have the mask
11353 facility. */
11354 struct value *mask_value, *mark;
11355
11356 if (use_mask)
11357 error(_("You can specify only one mask."));
11358
11359 use_mask = just_location = 1;
11360
11361 mark = value_mark ();
11362 mask_value = parse_to_comma_and_eval (&value_start);
11363 mask = value_as_address (mask_value);
11364 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11365 }
11366 else
11367 /* We didn't recognize what we found. We should stop here. */
11368 break;
11369
11370 /* Truncate the string and get rid of the "parameter value" pair before
11371 the arguments string is parsed by the parse_exp_1 function. */
11372 exp_end = tok;
11373 }
11374 }
11375 else
11376 exp_end = arg;
11377
11378 /* Parse the rest of the arguments. From here on out, everything
11379 is in terms of a newly allocated string instead of the original
11380 ARG. */
11381 innermost_block = NULL;
11382 expression = savestring (arg, exp_end - arg);
11383 back_to = make_cleanup (xfree, expression);
11384 exp_start = arg = expression;
11385 exp = parse_exp_1 (&arg, 0, 0, 0);
11386 exp_end = arg;
11387 /* Remove trailing whitespace from the expression before saving it.
11388 This makes the eventual display of the expression string a bit
11389 prettier. */
11390 while (exp_end > exp_start && (exp_end[-1] == ' ' || exp_end[-1] == '\t'))
11391 --exp_end;
11392
11393 /* Checking if the expression is not constant. */
11394 if (watchpoint_exp_is_const (exp))
11395 {
11396 int len;
11397
11398 len = exp_end - exp_start;
11399 while (len > 0 && isspace (exp_start[len - 1]))
11400 len--;
11401 error (_("Cannot watch constant value `%.*s'."), len, exp_start);
11402 }
11403
11404 exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11405 mark = value_mark ();
11406 fetch_subexp_value (exp, &pc, &val, &result, NULL, just_location);
11407
11408 if (val != NULL && just_location)
11409 {
11410 saved_bitpos = value_bitpos (val);
11411 saved_bitsize = value_bitsize (val);
11412 }
11413
11414 if (just_location)
11415 {
11416 int ret;
11417
11418 exp_valid_block = NULL;
11419 val = value_addr (result);
11420 release_value (val);
11421 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11422
11423 if (use_mask)
11424 {
11425 ret = target_masked_watch_num_registers (value_as_address (val),
11426 mask);
11427 if (ret == -1)
11428 error (_("This target does not support masked watchpoints."));
11429 else if (ret == -2)
11430 error (_("Invalid mask or memory region."));
11431 }
11432 }
11433 else if (val != NULL)
11434 release_value (val);
11435
11436 tok = skip_spaces_const (arg);
11437 end_tok = skip_to_space_const (tok);
11438
11439 toklen = end_tok - tok;
11440 if (toklen >= 1 && strncmp (tok, "if", toklen) == 0)
11441 {
11442 struct expression *cond;
11443
11444 innermost_block = NULL;
11445 tok = cond_start = end_tok + 1;
11446 cond = parse_exp_1 (&tok, 0, 0, 0);
11447
11448 /* The watchpoint expression may not be local, but the condition
11449 may still be. E.g.: `watch global if local > 0'. */
11450 cond_exp_valid_block = innermost_block;
11451
11452 xfree (cond);
11453 cond_end = tok;
11454 }
11455 if (*tok)
11456 error (_("Junk at end of command."));
11457
11458 frame = block_innermost_frame (exp_valid_block);
11459
11460 /* If the expression is "local", then set up a "watchpoint scope"
11461 breakpoint at the point where we've left the scope of the watchpoint
11462 expression. Create the scope breakpoint before the watchpoint, so
11463 that we will encounter it first in bpstat_stop_status. */
11464 if (exp_valid_block && frame)
11465 {
11466 if (frame_id_p (frame_unwind_caller_id (frame)))
11467 {
11468 scope_breakpoint
11469 = create_internal_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
11470 frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame),
11471 bp_watchpoint_scope,
11472 &momentary_breakpoint_ops);
11473
11474 scope_breakpoint->enable_state = bp_enabled;
11475
11476 /* Automatically delete the breakpoint when it hits. */
11477 scope_breakpoint->disposition = disp_del;
11478
11479 /* Only break in the proper frame (help with recursion). */
11480 scope_breakpoint->frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11481
11482 /* Set the address at which we will stop. */
11483 scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch
11484 = frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame);
11485 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address
11486 = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11487 scope_breakpoint->loc->address
11488 = adjust_breakpoint_address (scope_breakpoint->loc->gdbarch,
11489 scope_breakpoint->loc->requested_address,
11490 scope_breakpoint->type);
11491 }
11492 }
11493
11494 /* Now set up the breakpoint. We create all watchpoints as hardware
11495 watchpoints here even if hardware watchpoints are turned off, a call
11496 to update_watchpoint later in this function will cause the type to
11497 drop back to bp_watchpoint (software watchpoint) if required. */
11498
11499 if (accessflag == hw_read)
11500 bp_type = bp_read_watchpoint;
11501 else if (accessflag == hw_access)
11502 bp_type = bp_access_watchpoint;
11503 else
11504 bp_type = bp_hardware_watchpoint;
11505
11506 w = XCNEW (struct watchpoint);
11507 b = &w->base;
11508 if (use_mask)
11509 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11510 &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11511 else
11512 init_raw_breakpoint_without_location (b, NULL, bp_type,
11513 &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops);
11514 b->thread = thread;
11515 b->disposition = disp_donttouch;
11516 b->pspace = current_program_space;
11517 w->exp = exp;
11518 w->exp_valid_block = exp_valid_block;
11519 w->cond_exp_valid_block = cond_exp_valid_block;
11520 if (just_location)
11521 {
11522 struct type *t = value_type (val);
11523 CORE_ADDR addr = value_as_address (val);
11524 char *name;
11525
11526 t = check_typedef (TYPE_TARGET_TYPE (check_typedef (t)));
11527 name = type_to_string (t);
11528
11529 w->exp_string_reparse = xstrprintf ("* (%s *) %s", name,
11530 core_addr_to_string (addr));
11531 xfree (name);
11532
11533 w->exp_string = xstrprintf ("-location %.*s",
11534 (int) (exp_end - exp_start), exp_start);
11535
11536 /* The above expression is in C. */
11537 b->language = language_c;
11538 }
11539 else
11540 w->exp_string = savestring (exp_start, exp_end - exp_start);
11541
11542 if (use_mask)
11543 {
11544 w->hw_wp_mask = mask;
11545 }
11546 else
11547 {
11548 w->val = val;
11549 w->val_bitpos = saved_bitpos;
11550 w->val_bitsize = saved_bitsize;
11551 w->val_valid = 1;
11552 }
11553
11554 if (cond_start)
11555 b->cond_string = savestring (cond_start, cond_end - cond_start);
11556 else
11557 b->cond_string = 0;
11558
11559 if (frame)
11560 {
11561 w->watchpoint_frame = get_frame_id (frame);
11562 w->watchpoint_thread = inferior_ptid;
11563 }
11564 else
11565 {
11566 w->watchpoint_frame = null_frame_id;
11567 w->watchpoint_thread = null_ptid;
11568 }
11569
11570 if (scope_breakpoint != NULL)
11571 {
11572 /* The scope breakpoint is related to the watchpoint. We will
11573 need to act on them together. */
11574 b->related_breakpoint = scope_breakpoint;
11575 scope_breakpoint->related_breakpoint = b;
11576 }
11577
11578 if (!just_location)
11579 value_free_to_mark (mark);
11580
11581 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
11582 {
11583 /* Finally update the new watchpoint. This creates the locations
11584 that should be inserted. */
11585 update_watchpoint (w, 1);
11586 }
11587 if (e.reason < 0)
11588 {
11589 delete_breakpoint (b);
11590 throw_exception (e);
11591 }
11592
11593 install_breakpoint (internal, b, 1);
11594 do_cleanups (back_to);
11595}
11596
11597/* Return count of debug registers needed to watch the given expression.
11598 If the watchpoint cannot be handled in hardware return zero. */
11599
11600static int
11601can_use_hardware_watchpoint (struct value *v)
11602{
11603 int found_memory_cnt = 0;
11604 struct value *head = v;
11605
11606 /* Did the user specifically forbid us to use hardware watchpoints? */
11607 if (!can_use_hw_watchpoints)
11608 return 0;
11609
11610 /* Make sure that the value of the expression depends only upon
11611 memory contents, and values computed from them within GDB. If we
11612 find any register references or function calls, we can't use a
11613 hardware watchpoint.
11614
11615 The idea here is that evaluating an expression generates a series
11616 of values, one holding the value of every subexpression. (The
11617 expression a*b+c has five subexpressions: a, b, a*b, c, and
11618 a*b+c.) GDB's values hold almost enough information to establish
11619 the criteria given above --- they identify memory lvalues,
11620 register lvalues, computed values, etcetera. So we can evaluate
11621 the expression, and then scan the chain of values that leaves
11622 behind to decide whether we can detect any possible change to the
11623 expression's final value using only hardware watchpoints.
11624
11625 However, I don't think that the values returned by inferior
11626 function calls are special in any way. So this function may not
11627 notice that an expression involving an inferior function call
11628 can't be watched with hardware watchpoints. FIXME. */
11629 for (; v; v = value_next (v))
11630 {
11631 if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_memory)
11632 {
11633 if (v != head && value_lazy (v))
11634 /* A lazy memory lvalue in the chain is one that GDB never
11635 needed to fetch; we either just used its address (e.g.,
11636 `a' in `a.b') or we never needed it at all (e.g., `a'
11637 in `a,b'). This doesn't apply to HEAD; if that is
11638 lazy then it was not readable, but watch it anyway. */
11639 ;
11640 else
11641 {
11642 /* Ahh, memory we actually used! Check if we can cover
11643 it with hardware watchpoints. */
11644 struct type *vtype = check_typedef (value_type (v));
11645
11646 /* We only watch structs and arrays if user asked for it
11647 explicitly, never if they just happen to appear in a
11648 middle of some value chain. */
11649 if (v == head
11650 || (TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_STRUCT
11651 && TYPE_CODE (vtype) != TYPE_CODE_ARRAY))
11652 {
11653 CORE_ADDR vaddr = value_address (v);
11654 int len;
11655 int num_regs;
11656
11657 len = (target_exact_watchpoints
11658 && is_scalar_type_recursive (vtype))?
11659 1 : TYPE_LENGTH (value_type (v));
11660
11661 num_regs = target_region_ok_for_hw_watchpoint (vaddr, len);
11662 if (!num_regs)
11663 return 0;
11664 else
11665 found_memory_cnt += num_regs;
11666 }
11667 }
11668 }
11669 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) != not_lval
11670 && deprecated_value_modifiable (v) == 0)
11671 return 0; /* These are values from the history (e.g., $1). */
11672 else if (VALUE_LVAL (v) == lval_register)
11673 return 0; /* Cannot watch a register with a HW watchpoint. */
11674 }
11675
11676 /* The expression itself looks suitable for using a hardware
11677 watchpoint, but give the target machine a chance to reject it. */
11678 return found_memory_cnt;
11679}
11680
11681void
11682watch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11683{
11684 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_write, from_tty, 0, internal);
11685}
11686
11687/* A helper function that looks for the "-location" argument and then
11688 calls watch_command_1. */
11689
11690static void
11691watch_maybe_just_location (char *arg, int accessflag, int from_tty)
11692{
11693 int just_location = 0;
11694
11695 if (arg
11696 && (check_for_argument (&arg, "-location", sizeof ("-location") - 1)
11697 || check_for_argument (&arg, "-l", sizeof ("-l") - 1)))
11698 {
11699 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11700 just_location = 1;
11701 }
11702
11703 watch_command_1 (arg, accessflag, from_tty, just_location, 0);
11704}
11705
11706static void
11707watch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11708{
11709 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_write, from_tty);
11710}
11711
11712void
11713rwatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11714{
11715 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_read, from_tty, 0, internal);
11716}
11717
11718static void
11719rwatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11720{
11721 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_read, from_tty);
11722}
11723
11724void
11725awatch_command_wrapper (char *arg, int from_tty, int internal)
11726{
11727 watch_command_1 (arg, hw_access, from_tty, 0, internal);
11728}
11729
11730static void
11731awatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
11732{
11733 watch_maybe_just_location (arg, hw_access, from_tty);
11734}
11735\f
11736
11737/* Helper routines for the until_command routine in infcmd.c. Here
11738 because it uses the mechanisms of breakpoints. */
11739
11740struct until_break_command_continuation_args
11741{
11742 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
11743 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2;
11744 int thread_num;
11745};
11746
11747/* This function is called by fetch_inferior_event via the
11748 cmd_continuation pointer, to complete the until command. It takes
11749 care of cleaning up the temporary breakpoints set up by the until
11750 command. */
11751static void
11752until_break_command_continuation (void *arg, int err)
11753{
11754 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *a = arg;
11755
11756 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint);
11757 if (a->breakpoint2)
11758 delete_breakpoint (a->breakpoint2);
11759 delete_longjmp_breakpoint (a->thread_num);
11760}
11761
11762void
11763until_break_command (char *arg, int from_tty, int anywhere)
11764{
11765 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
11766 struct symtab_and_line sal;
11767 struct frame_info *frame;
11768 struct gdbarch *frame_gdbarch;
11769 struct frame_id stack_frame_id;
11770 struct frame_id caller_frame_id;
11771 struct breakpoint *breakpoint;
11772 struct breakpoint *breakpoint2 = NULL;
11773 struct cleanup *old_chain;
11774 int thread;
11775 struct thread_info *tp;
11776
11777 clear_proceed_status (0);
11778
11779 /* Set a breakpoint where the user wants it and at return from
11780 this function. */
11781
11782 if (last_displayed_sal_is_valid ())
11783 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11784 get_last_displayed_symtab (),
11785 get_last_displayed_line ());
11786 else
11787 sals = decode_line_1 (&arg, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
11788 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0);
11789
11790 if (sals.nelts != 1)
11791 error (_("Couldn't get information on specified line."));
11792
11793 sal = sals.sals[0];
11794 xfree (sals.sals); /* malloc'd, so freed. */
11795
11796 if (*arg)
11797 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11798
11799 resolve_sal_pc (&sal);
11800
11801 tp = inferior_thread ();
11802 thread = tp->num;
11803
11804 old_chain = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
11805
11806 /* Note linespec handling above invalidates the frame chain.
11807 Installing a breakpoint also invalidates the frame chain (as it
11808 may need to switch threads), so do any frame handling before
11809 that. */
11810
11811 frame = get_selected_frame (NULL);
11812 frame_gdbarch = get_frame_arch (frame);
11813 stack_frame_id = get_stack_frame_id (frame);
11814 caller_frame_id = frame_unwind_caller_id (frame);
11815
11816 /* Keep within the current frame, or in frames called by the current
11817 one. */
11818
11819 if (frame_id_p (caller_frame_id))
11820 {
11821 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
11822
11823 sal2 = find_pc_line (frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame), 0);
11824 sal2.pc = frame_unwind_caller_pc (frame);
11825 breakpoint2 = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_unwind_caller_arch (frame),
11826 sal2,
11827 caller_frame_id,
11828 bp_until);
11829 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint2);
11830
11831 set_longjmp_breakpoint (tp, caller_frame_id);
11832 make_cleanup (delete_longjmp_breakpoint_cleanup, &thread);
11833 }
11834
11835 /* set_momentary_breakpoint could invalidate FRAME. */
11836 frame = NULL;
11837
11838 if (anywhere)
11839 /* If the user told us to continue until a specified location,
11840 we don't specify a frame at which we need to stop. */
11841 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11842 null_frame_id, bp_until);
11843 else
11844 /* Otherwise, specify the selected frame, because we want to stop
11845 only at the very same frame. */
11846 breakpoint = set_momentary_breakpoint (frame_gdbarch, sal,
11847 stack_frame_id, bp_until);
11848 make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (breakpoint);
11849
11850 proceed (-1, GDB_SIGNAL_DEFAULT, 0);
11851
11852 /* If we are running asynchronously, and proceed call above has
11853 actually managed to start the target, arrange for breakpoints to
11854 be deleted when the target stops. Otherwise, we're already
11855 stopped and delete breakpoints via cleanup chain. */
11856
11857 if (target_can_async_p () && is_running (inferior_ptid))
11858 {
11859 struct until_break_command_continuation_args *args;
11860 args = xmalloc (sizeof (*args));
11861
11862 args->breakpoint = breakpoint;
11863 args->breakpoint2 = breakpoint2;
11864 args->thread_num = thread;
11865
11866 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
11867 add_continuation (inferior_thread (),
11868 until_break_command_continuation, args,
11869 xfree);
11870 }
11871 else
11872 do_cleanups (old_chain);
11873}
11874
11875/* This function attempts to parse an optional "if <cond>" clause
11876 from the arg string. If one is not found, it returns NULL.
11877
11878 Else, it returns a pointer to the condition string. (It does not
11879 attempt to evaluate the string against a particular block.) And,
11880 it updates arg to point to the first character following the parsed
11881 if clause in the arg string. */
11882
11883char *
11884ep_parse_optional_if_clause (char **arg)
11885{
11886 char *cond_string;
11887
11888 if (((*arg)[0] != 'i') || ((*arg)[1] != 'f') || !isspace ((*arg)[2]))
11889 return NULL;
11890
11891 /* Skip the "if" keyword. */
11892 (*arg) += 2;
11893
11894 /* Skip any extra leading whitespace, and record the start of the
11895 condition string. */
11896 *arg = skip_spaces (*arg);
11897 cond_string = *arg;
11898
11899 /* Assume that the condition occupies the remainder of the arg
11900 string. */
11901 (*arg) += strlen (cond_string);
11902
11903 return cond_string;
11904}
11905
11906/* Commands to deal with catching events, such as signals, exceptions,
11907 process start/exit, etc. */
11908
11909typedef enum
11910{
11911 catch_fork_temporary, catch_vfork_temporary,
11912 catch_fork_permanent, catch_vfork_permanent
11913}
11914catch_fork_kind;
11915
11916static void
11917catch_fork_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11918 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11919{
11920 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11921 char *cond_string = NULL;
11922 catch_fork_kind fork_kind;
11923 int tempflag;
11924
11925 fork_kind = (catch_fork_kind) (uintptr_t) get_cmd_context (command);
11926 tempflag = (fork_kind == catch_fork_temporary
11927 || fork_kind == catch_vfork_temporary);
11928
11929 if (!arg)
11930 arg = "";
11931 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11932
11933 /* The allowed syntax is:
11934 catch [v]fork
11935 catch [v]fork if <cond>
11936
11937 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11938 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11939
11940 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11941 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11942
11943 /* If this target supports it, create a fork or vfork catchpoint
11944 and enable reporting of such events. */
11945 switch (fork_kind)
11946 {
11947 case catch_fork_temporary:
11948 case catch_fork_permanent:
11949 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11950 &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops);
11951 break;
11952 case catch_vfork_temporary:
11953 case catch_vfork_permanent:
11954 create_fork_vfork_event_catchpoint (gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11955 &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops);
11956 break;
11957 default:
11958 error (_("unsupported or unknown fork kind; cannot catch it"));
11959 break;
11960 }
11961}
11962
11963static void
11964catch_exec_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
11965 struct cmd_list_element *command)
11966{
11967 struct exec_catchpoint *c;
11968 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
11969 int tempflag;
11970 char *cond_string = NULL;
11971
11972 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
11973
11974 if (!arg)
11975 arg = "";
11976 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
11977
11978 /* The allowed syntax is:
11979 catch exec
11980 catch exec if <cond>
11981
11982 First, check if there's an if clause. */
11983 cond_string = ep_parse_optional_if_clause (&arg);
11984
11985 if ((*arg != '\0') && !isspace (*arg))
11986 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
11987
11988 c = XNEW (struct exec_catchpoint);
11989 init_catchpoint (&c->base, gdbarch, tempflag, cond_string,
11990 &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops);
11991 c->exec_pathname = NULL;
11992
11993 install_breakpoint (0, &c->base, 1);
11994}
11995
11996void
11997init_ada_exception_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b,
11998 struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
11999 struct symtab_and_line sal,
12000 char *addr_string,
12001 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
12002 int tempflag,
12003 int enabled,
12004 int from_tty)
12005{
12006 if (from_tty)
12007 {
12008 struct gdbarch *loc_gdbarch = get_sal_arch (sal);
12009 if (!loc_gdbarch)
12010 loc_gdbarch = gdbarch;
12011
12012 describe_other_breakpoints (loc_gdbarch,
12013 sal.pspace, sal.pc, sal.section, -1);
12014 /* FIXME: brobecker/2006-12-28: Actually, re-implement a special
12015 version for exception catchpoints, because two catchpoints
12016 used for different exception names will use the same address.
12017 In this case, a "breakpoint ... also set at..." warning is
12018 unproductive. Besides, the warning phrasing is also a bit
12019 inappropriate, we should use the word catchpoint, and tell
12020 the user what type of catchpoint it is. The above is good
12021 enough for now, though. */
12022 }
12023
12024 init_raw_breakpoint (b, gdbarch, sal, bp_breakpoint, ops);
12025
12026 b->enable_state = enabled ? bp_enabled : bp_disabled;
12027 b->disposition = tempflag ? disp_del : disp_donttouch;
12028 b->addr_string = addr_string;
12029 b->language = language_ada;
12030}
12031
12032/* Splits the argument using space as delimiter. Returns an xmalloc'd
12033 filter list, or NULL if no filtering is required. */
12034static VEC(int) *
12035catch_syscall_split_args (char *arg)
12036{
12037 VEC(int) *result = NULL;
12038 struct cleanup *cleanup = make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (int), &result);
12039
12040 while (*arg != '\0')
12041 {
12042 int i, syscall_number;
12043 char *endptr;
12044 char cur_name[128];
12045 struct syscall s;
12046
12047 /* Skip whitespace. */
12048 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
12049
12050 for (i = 0; i < 127 && arg[i] && !isspace (arg[i]); ++i)
12051 cur_name[i] = arg[i];
12052 cur_name[i] = '\0';
12053 arg += i;
12054
12055 /* Check if the user provided a syscall name or a number. */
12056 syscall_number = (int) strtol (cur_name, &endptr, 0);
12057 if (*endptr == '\0')
12058 get_syscall_by_number (syscall_number, &s);
12059 else
12060 {
12061 /* We have a name. Let's check if it's valid and convert it
12062 to a number. */
12063 get_syscall_by_name (cur_name, &s);
12064
12065 if (s.number == UNKNOWN_SYSCALL)
12066 /* Here we have to issue an error instead of a warning,
12067 because GDB cannot do anything useful if there's no
12068 syscall number to be caught. */
12069 error (_("Unknown syscall name '%s'."), cur_name);
12070 }
12071
12072 /* Ok, it's valid. */
12073 VEC_safe_push (int, result, s.number);
12074 }
12075
12076 discard_cleanups (cleanup);
12077 return result;
12078}
12079
12080/* Implement the "catch syscall" command. */
12081
12082static void
12083catch_syscall_command_1 (char *arg, int from_tty,
12084 struct cmd_list_element *command)
12085{
12086 int tempflag;
12087 VEC(int) *filter;
12088 struct syscall s;
12089 struct gdbarch *gdbarch = get_current_arch ();
12090
12091 /* Checking if the feature if supported. */
12092 if (gdbarch_get_syscall_number_p (gdbarch) == 0)
12093 error (_("The feature 'catch syscall' is not supported on \
12094this architecture yet."));
12095
12096 tempflag = get_cmd_context (command) == CATCH_TEMPORARY;
12097
12098 arg = skip_spaces (arg);
12099
12100 /* We need to do this first "dummy" translation in order
12101 to get the syscall XML file loaded or, most important,
12102 to display a warning to the user if there's no XML file
12103 for his/her architecture. */
12104 get_syscall_by_number (0, &s);
12105
12106 /* The allowed syntax is:
12107 catch syscall
12108 catch syscall <name | number> [<name | number> ... <name | number>]
12109
12110 Let's check if there's a syscall name. */
12111
12112 if (arg != NULL)
12113 filter = catch_syscall_split_args (arg);
12114 else
12115 filter = NULL;
12116
12117 create_syscall_event_catchpoint (tempflag, filter,
12118 &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops);
12119}
12120
12121static void
12122catch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12123{
12124 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
12125}
12126\f
12127
12128static void
12129tcatch_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12130{
12131 error (_("Catch requires an event name."));
12132}
12133
12134/* A qsort comparison function that sorts breakpoints in order. */
12135
12136static int
12137compare_breakpoints (const void *a, const void *b)
12138{
12139 const breakpoint_p *ba = a;
12140 uintptr_t ua = (uintptr_t) *ba;
12141 const breakpoint_p *bb = b;
12142 uintptr_t ub = (uintptr_t) *bb;
12143
12144 if ((*ba)->number < (*bb)->number)
12145 return -1;
12146 else if ((*ba)->number > (*bb)->number)
12147 return 1;
12148
12149 /* Now sort by address, in case we see, e..g, two breakpoints with
12150 the number 0. */
12151 if (ua < ub)
12152 return -1;
12153 return ua > ub ? 1 : 0;
12154}
12155
12156/* Delete breakpoints by address or line. */
12157
12158static void
12159clear_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
12160{
12161 struct breakpoint *b, *prev;
12162 VEC(breakpoint_p) *found = 0;
12163 int ix;
12164 int default_match;
12165 struct symtabs_and_lines sals;
12166 struct symtab_and_line sal;
12167 int i;
12168 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (null_cleanup, NULL);
12169
12170 if (arg)
12171 {
12172 sals = decode_line_with_current_source (arg,
12173 (DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE
12174 | DECODE_LINE_LIST_MODE));
12175 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
12176 default_match = 0;
12177 }
12178 else
12179 {
12180 sals.sals = (struct symtab_and_line *)
12181 xmalloc (sizeof (struct symtab_and_line));
12182 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
12183 init_sal (&sal); /* Initialize to zeroes. */
12184
12185 /* Set sal's line, symtab, pc, and pspace to the values
12186 corresponding to the last call to print_frame_info. If the
12187 codepoint is not valid, this will set all the fields to 0. */
12188 get_last_displayed_sal (&sal);
12189 if (sal.symtab == 0)
12190 error (_("No source file specified."));
12191
12192 sals.sals[0] = sal;
12193 sals.nelts = 1;
12194
12195 default_match = 1;
12196 }
12197
12198 /* We don't call resolve_sal_pc here. That's not as bad as it
12199 seems, because all existing breakpoints typically have both
12200 file/line and pc set. So, if clear is given file/line, we can
12201 match this to existing breakpoint without obtaining pc at all.
12202
12203 We only support clearing given the address explicitly
12204 present in breakpoint table. Say, we've set breakpoint
12205 at file:line. There were several PC values for that file:line,
12206 due to optimization, all in one block.
12207
12208 We've picked one PC value. If "clear" is issued with another
12209 PC corresponding to the same file:line, the breakpoint won't
12210 be cleared. We probably can still clear the breakpoint, but
12211 since the other PC value is never presented to user, user
12212 can only find it by guessing, and it does not seem important
12213 to support that. */
12214
12215 /* For each line spec given, delete bps which correspond to it. Do
12216 it in two passes, solely to preserve the current behavior that
12217 from_tty is forced true if we delete more than one
12218 breakpoint. */
12219
12220 found = NULL;
12221 make_cleanup (VEC_cleanup (breakpoint_p), &found);
12222 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; i++)
12223 {
12224 const char *sal_fullname;
12225
12226 /* If exact pc given, clear bpts at that pc.
12227 If line given (pc == 0), clear all bpts on specified line.
12228 If defaulting, clear all bpts on default line
12229 or at default pc.
12230
12231 defaulting sal.pc != 0 tests to do
12232
12233 0 1 pc
12234 1 1 pc _and_ line
12235 0 0 line
12236 1 0 <can't happen> */
12237
12238 sal = sals.sals[i];
12239 sal_fullname = (sal.symtab == NULL
12240 ? NULL : symtab_to_fullname (sal.symtab));
12241
12242 /* Find all matching breakpoints and add them to 'found'. */
12243 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12244 {
12245 int match = 0;
12246 /* Are we going to delete b? */
12247 if (b->type != bp_none && !is_watchpoint (b))
12248 {
12249 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
12250 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
12251 {
12252 /* If the user specified file:line, don't allow a PC
12253 match. This matches historical gdb behavior. */
12254 int pc_match = (!sal.explicit_line
12255 && sal.pc
12256 && (loc->pspace == sal.pspace)
12257 && (loc->address == sal.pc)
12258 && (!section_is_overlay (loc->section)
12259 || loc->section == sal.section));
12260 int line_match = 0;
12261
12262 if ((default_match || sal.explicit_line)
12263 && loc->symtab != NULL
12264 && sal_fullname != NULL
12265 && sal.pspace == loc->pspace
12266 && loc->line_number == sal.line
12267 && filename_cmp (symtab_to_fullname (loc->symtab),
12268 sal_fullname) == 0)
12269 line_match = 1;
12270
12271 if (pc_match || line_match)
12272 {
12273 match = 1;
12274 break;
12275 }
12276 }
12277 }
12278
12279 if (match)
12280 VEC_safe_push(breakpoint_p, found, b);
12281 }
12282 }
12283
12284 /* Now go thru the 'found' chain and delete them. */
12285 if (VEC_empty(breakpoint_p, found))
12286 {
12287 if (arg)
12288 error (_("No breakpoint at %s."), arg);
12289 else
12290 error (_("No breakpoint at this line."));
12291 }
12292
12293 /* Remove duplicates from the vec. */
12294 qsort (VEC_address (breakpoint_p, found),
12295 VEC_length (breakpoint_p, found),
12296 sizeof (breakpoint_p),
12297 compare_breakpoints);
12298 prev = VEC_index (breakpoint_p, found, 0);
12299 for (ix = 1; VEC_iterate (breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ++ix)
12300 {
12301 if (b == prev)
12302 {
12303 VEC_ordered_remove (breakpoint_p, found, ix);
12304 --ix;
12305 }
12306 }
12307
12308 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) > 1)
12309 from_tty = 1; /* Always report if deleted more than one. */
12310 if (from_tty)
12311 {
12312 if (VEC_length(breakpoint_p, found) == 1)
12313 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoint "));
12314 else
12315 printf_unfiltered (_("Deleted breakpoints "));
12316 }
12317
12318 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate(breakpoint_p, found, ix, b); ix++)
12319 {
12320 if (from_tty)
12321 printf_unfiltered ("%d ", b->number);
12322 delete_breakpoint (b);
12323 }
12324 if (from_tty)
12325 putchar_unfiltered ('\n');
12326
12327 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12328}
12329\f
12330/* Delete breakpoint in BS if they are `delete' breakpoints and
12331 all breakpoints that are marked for deletion, whether hit or not.
12332 This is called after any breakpoint is hit, or after errors. */
12333
12334void
12335breakpoint_auto_delete (bpstat bs)
12336{
12337 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
12338
12339 for (; bs; bs = bs->next)
12340 if (bs->breakpoint_at
12341 && bs->breakpoint_at->disposition == disp_del
12342 && bs->stop)
12343 delete_breakpoint (bs->breakpoint_at);
12344
12345 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
12346 {
12347 if (b->disposition == disp_del_at_next_stop)
12348 delete_breakpoint (b);
12349 }
12350}
12351
12352/* A comparison function for bp_location AP and BP being interfaced to
12353 qsort. Sort elements primarily by their ADDRESS (no matter what
12354 does breakpoint_address_is_meaningful say for its OWNER),
12355 secondarily by ordering first permanent elements and
12356 terciarily just ensuring the array is sorted stable way despite
12357 qsort being an unstable algorithm. */
12358
12359static int
12360bp_location_compare (const void *ap, const void *bp)
12361{
12362 struct bp_location *a = *(void **) ap;
12363 struct bp_location *b = *(void **) bp;
12364
12365 if (a->address != b->address)
12366 return (a->address > b->address) - (a->address < b->address);
12367
12368 /* Sort locations at the same address by their pspace number, keeping
12369 locations of the same inferior (in a multi-inferior environment)
12370 grouped. */
12371
12372 if (a->pspace->num != b->pspace->num)
12373 return ((a->pspace->num > b->pspace->num)
12374 - (a->pspace->num < b->pspace->num));
12375
12376 /* Sort permanent breakpoints first. */
12377 if (a->permanent != b->permanent)
12378 return (a->permanent < b->permanent) - (a->permanent > b->permanent);
12379
12380 /* Make the internal GDB representation stable across GDB runs
12381 where A and B memory inside GDB can differ. Breakpoint locations of
12382 the same type at the same address can be sorted in arbitrary order. */
12383
12384 if (a->owner->number != b->owner->number)
12385 return ((a->owner->number > b->owner->number)
12386 - (a->owner->number < b->owner->number));
12387
12388 return (a > b) - (a < b);
12389}
12390
12391/* Set bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max and
12392 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max according to the current
12393 content of the bp_location array. */
12394
12395static void
12396bp_location_target_extensions_update (void)
12397{
12398 struct bp_location *bl, **blp_tmp;
12399
12400 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = 0;
12401 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = 0;
12402
12403 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (bl, blp_tmp)
12404 {
12405 CORE_ADDR start, end, addr;
12406
12407 if (!bp_location_has_shadow (bl))
12408 continue;
12409
12410 start = bl->target_info.placed_address;
12411 end = start + bl->target_info.shadow_len;
12412
12413 gdb_assert (bl->address >= start);
12414 addr = bl->address - start;
12415 if (addr > bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max)
12416 bp_location_placed_address_before_address_max = addr;
12417
12418 /* Zero SHADOW_LEN would not pass bp_location_has_shadow. */
12419
12420 gdb_assert (bl->address < end);
12421 addr = end - bl->address;
12422 if (addr > bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max)
12423 bp_location_shadow_len_after_address_max = addr;
12424 }
12425}
12426
12427/* Download tracepoint locations if they haven't been. */
12428
12429static void
12430download_tracepoint_locations (void)
12431{
12432 struct breakpoint *b;
12433 struct cleanup *old_chain;
12434
12435 if (!target_can_download_tracepoint ())
12436 return;
12437
12438 old_chain = save_current_space_and_thread ();
12439
12440 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
12441 {
12442 struct bp_location *bl;
12443 struct tracepoint *t;
12444 int bp_location_downloaded = 0;
12445
12446 if ((b->type == bp_fast_tracepoint
12447 ? !may_insert_fast_tracepoints
12448 : !may_insert_tracepoints))
12449 continue;
12450
12451 for (bl = b->loc; bl; bl = bl->next)
12452 {
12453 /* In tracepoint, locations are _never_ duplicated, so
12454 should_be_inserted is equivalent to
12455 unduplicated_should_be_inserted. */
12456 if (!should_be_inserted (bl) || bl->inserted)
12457 continue;
12458
12459 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (bl->pspace);
12460
12461 target_download_tracepoint (bl);
12462
12463 bl->inserted = 1;
12464 bp_location_downloaded = 1;
12465 }
12466 t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
12467 t->number_on_target = b->number;
12468 if (bp_location_downloaded)
12469 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
12470 }
12471
12472 do_cleanups (old_chain);
12473}
12474
12475/* Swap the insertion/duplication state between two locations. */
12476
12477static void
12478swap_insertion (struct bp_location *left, struct bp_location *right)
12479{
12480 const int left_inserted = left->inserted;
12481 const int left_duplicate = left->duplicate;
12482 const int left_needs_update = left->needs_update;
12483 const struct bp_target_info left_target_info = left->target_info;
12484
12485 /* Locations of tracepoints can never be duplicated. */
12486 if (is_tracepoint (left->owner))
12487 gdb_assert (!left->duplicate);
12488 if (is_tracepoint (right->owner))
12489 gdb_assert (!right->duplicate);
12490
12491 left->inserted = right->inserted;
12492 left->duplicate = right->duplicate;
12493 left->needs_update = right->needs_update;
12494 left->target_info = right->target_info;
12495 right->inserted = left_inserted;
12496 right->duplicate = left_duplicate;
12497 right->needs_update = left_needs_update;
12498 right->target_info = left_target_info;
12499}
12500
12501/* Force the re-insertion of the locations at ADDRESS. This is called
12502 once a new/deleted/modified duplicate location is found and we are evaluating
12503 conditions on the target's side. Such conditions need to be updated on
12504 the target. */
12505
12506static void
12507force_breakpoint_reinsertion (struct bp_location *bl)
12508{
12509 struct bp_location **locp = NULL, **loc2p;
12510 struct bp_location *loc;
12511 CORE_ADDR address = 0;
12512 int pspace_num;
12513
12514 address = bl->address;
12515 pspace_num = bl->pspace->num;
12516
12517 /* This is only meaningful if the target is
12518 evaluating conditions and if the user has
12519 opted for condition evaluation on the target's
12520 side. */
12521 if (gdb_evaluates_breakpoint_condition_p ()
12522 || !target_supports_evaluation_of_breakpoint_conditions ())
12523 return;
12524
12525 /* Flag all breakpoint locations with this address and
12526 the same program space as the location
12527 as "its condition has changed". We need to
12528 update the conditions on the target's side. */
12529 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS_AT_ADDR (loc2p, locp, address)
12530 {
12531 loc = *loc2p;
12532
12533 if (!is_breakpoint (loc->owner)
12534 || pspace_num != loc->pspace->num)
12535 continue;
12536
12537 /* Flag the location appropriately. We use a different state to
12538 let everyone know that we already updated the set of locations
12539 with addr bl->address and program space bl->pspace. This is so
12540 we don't have to keep calling these functions just to mark locations
12541 that have already been marked. */
12542 loc->condition_changed = condition_updated;
12543
12544 /* Free the agent expression bytecode as well. We will compute
12545 it later on. */
12546 if (loc->cond_bytecode)
12547 {
12548 free_agent_expr (loc->cond_bytecode);
12549 loc->cond_bytecode = NULL;
12550 }
12551 }
12552}
12553/* Called whether new breakpoints are created, or existing breakpoints
12554 deleted, to update the global location list and recompute which
12555 locations are duplicate of which.
12556
12557 The INSERT_MODE flag determines whether locations may not, may, or
12558 shall be inserted now. See 'enum ugll_insert_mode' for more
12559 info. */
12560
12561static void
12562update_global_location_list (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12563{
12564 struct breakpoint *b;
12565 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
12566 struct cleanup *cleanups;
12567 /* Last breakpoint location address that was marked for update. */
12568 CORE_ADDR last_addr = 0;
12569 /* Last breakpoint location program space that was marked for update. */
12570 int last_pspace_num = -1;
12571
12572 /* Used in the duplicates detection below. When iterating over all
12573 bp_locations, points to the first bp_location of a given address.
12574 Breakpoints and watchpoints of different types are never
12575 duplicates of each other. Keep one pointer for each type of
12576 breakpoint/watchpoint, so we only need to loop over all locations
12577 once. */
12578 struct bp_location *bp_loc_first; /* breakpoint */
12579 struct bp_location *wp_loc_first; /* hardware watchpoint */
12580 struct bp_location *awp_loc_first; /* access watchpoint */
12581 struct bp_location *rwp_loc_first; /* read watchpoint */
12582
12583 /* Saved former bp_location array which we compare against the newly
12584 built bp_location from the current state of ALL_BREAKPOINTS. */
12585 struct bp_location **old_location, **old_locp;
12586 unsigned old_location_count;
12587
12588 old_location = bp_location;
12589 old_location_count = bp_location_count;
12590 bp_location = NULL;
12591 bp_location_count = 0;
12592 cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, old_location);
12593
12594 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12595 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12596 bp_location_count++;
12597
12598 bp_location = xmalloc (sizeof (*bp_location) * bp_location_count);
12599 locp = bp_location;
12600 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
12601 for (loc = b->loc; loc; loc = loc->next)
12602 *locp++ = loc;
12603 qsort (bp_location, bp_location_count, sizeof (*bp_location),
12604 bp_location_compare);
12605
12606 bp_location_target_extensions_update ();
12607
12608 /* Identify bp_location instances that are no longer present in the
12609 new list, and therefore should be freed. Note that it's not
12610 necessary that those locations should be removed from inferior --
12611 if there's another location at the same address (previously
12612 marked as duplicate), we don't need to remove/insert the
12613 location.
12614
12615 LOCP is kept in sync with OLD_LOCP, each pointing to the current
12616 and former bp_location array state respectively. */
12617
12618 locp = bp_location;
12619 for (old_locp = old_location; old_locp < old_location + old_location_count;
12620 old_locp++)
12621 {
12622 struct bp_location *old_loc = *old_locp;
12623 struct bp_location **loc2p;
12624
12625 /* Tells if 'old_loc' is found among the new locations. If
12626 not, we have to free it. */
12627 int found_object = 0;
12628 /* Tells if the location should remain inserted in the target. */
12629 int keep_in_target = 0;
12630 int removed = 0;
12631
12632 /* Skip LOCP entries which will definitely never be needed.
12633 Stop either at or being the one matching OLD_LOC. */
12634 while (locp < bp_location + bp_location_count
12635 && (*locp)->address < old_loc->address)
12636 locp++;
12637
12638 for (loc2p = locp;
12639 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12640 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12641 loc2p++)
12642 {
12643 /* Check if this is a new/duplicated location or a duplicated
12644 location that had its condition modified. If so, we want to send
12645 its condition to the target if evaluation of conditions is taking
12646 place there. */
12647 if ((*loc2p)->condition_changed == condition_modified
12648 && (last_addr != old_loc->address
12649 || last_pspace_num != old_loc->pspace->num))
12650 {
12651 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (*loc2p);
12652 last_pspace_num = old_loc->pspace->num;
12653 }
12654
12655 if (*loc2p == old_loc)
12656 found_object = 1;
12657 }
12658
12659 /* We have already handled this address, update it so that we don't
12660 have to go through updates again. */
12661 last_addr = old_loc->address;
12662
12663 /* Target-side condition evaluation: Handle deleted locations. */
12664 if (!found_object)
12665 force_breakpoint_reinsertion (old_loc);
12666
12667 /* If this location is no longer present, and inserted, look if
12668 there's maybe a new location at the same address. If so,
12669 mark that one inserted, and don't remove this one. This is
12670 needed so that we don't have a time window where a breakpoint
12671 at certain location is not inserted. */
12672
12673 if (old_loc->inserted)
12674 {
12675 /* If the location is inserted now, we might have to remove
12676 it. */
12677
12678 if (found_object && should_be_inserted (old_loc))
12679 {
12680 /* The location is still present in the location list,
12681 and still should be inserted. Don't do anything. */
12682 keep_in_target = 1;
12683 }
12684 else
12685 {
12686 /* This location still exists, but it won't be kept in the
12687 target since it may have been disabled. We proceed to
12688 remove its target-side condition. */
12689
12690 /* The location is either no longer present, or got
12691 disabled. See if there's another location at the
12692 same address, in which case we don't need to remove
12693 this one from the target. */
12694
12695 /* OLD_LOC comes from existing struct breakpoint. */
12696 if (breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner))
12697 {
12698 for (loc2p = locp;
12699 (loc2p < bp_location + bp_location_count
12700 && (*loc2p)->address == old_loc->address);
12701 loc2p++)
12702 {
12703 struct bp_location *loc2 = *loc2p;
12704
12705 if (breakpoint_locations_match (loc2, old_loc))
12706 {
12707 /* Read watchpoint locations are switched to
12708 access watchpoints, if the former are not
12709 supported, but the latter are. */
12710 if (is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12711 {
12712 gdb_assert (is_hardware_watchpoint (loc2->owner));
12713 loc2->watchpoint_type = old_loc->watchpoint_type;
12714 }
12715
12716 /* loc2 is a duplicated location. We need to check
12717 if it should be inserted in case it will be
12718 unduplicated. */
12719 if (loc2 != old_loc
12720 && unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc2))
12721 {
12722 swap_insertion (old_loc, loc2);
12723 keep_in_target = 1;
12724 break;
12725 }
12726 }
12727 }
12728 }
12729 }
12730
12731 if (!keep_in_target)
12732 {
12733 if (remove_breakpoint (old_loc, mark_uninserted))
12734 {
12735 /* This is just about all we can do. We could keep
12736 this location on the global list, and try to
12737 remove it next time, but there's no particular
12738 reason why we will succeed next time.
12739
12740 Note that at this point, old_loc->owner is still
12741 valid, as delete_breakpoint frees the breakpoint
12742 only after calling us. */
12743 printf_filtered (_("warning: Error removing "
12744 "breakpoint %d\n"),
12745 old_loc->owner->number);
12746 }
12747 removed = 1;
12748 }
12749 }
12750
12751 if (!found_object)
12752 {
12753 if (removed && non_stop
12754 && breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (old_loc->owner)
12755 && !is_hardware_watchpoint (old_loc->owner))
12756 {
12757 /* This location was removed from the target. In
12758 non-stop mode, a race condition is possible where
12759 we've removed a breakpoint, but stop events for that
12760 breakpoint are already queued and will arrive later.
12761 We apply an heuristic to be able to distinguish such
12762 SIGTRAPs from other random SIGTRAPs: we keep this
12763 breakpoint location for a bit, and will retire it
12764 after we see some number of events. The theory here
12765 is that reporting of events should, "on the average",
12766 be fair, so after a while we'll see events from all
12767 threads that have anything of interest, and no longer
12768 need to keep this breakpoint location around. We
12769 don't hold locations forever so to reduce chances of
12770 mistaking a non-breakpoint SIGTRAP for a breakpoint
12771 SIGTRAP.
12772
12773 The heuristic failing can be disastrous on
12774 decr_pc_after_break targets.
12775
12776 On decr_pc_after_break targets, like e.g., x86-linux,
12777 if we fail to recognize a late breakpoint SIGTRAP,
12778 because events_till_retirement has reached 0 too
12779 soon, we'll fail to do the PC adjustment, and report
12780 a random SIGTRAP to the user. When the user resumes
12781 the inferior, it will most likely immediately crash
12782 with SIGILL/SIGBUS/SIGSEGV, or worse, get silently
12783 corrupted, because of being resumed e.g., in the
12784 middle of a multi-byte instruction, or skipped a
12785 one-byte instruction. This was actually seen happen
12786 on native x86-linux, and should be less rare on
12787 targets that do not support new thread events, like
12788 remote, due to the heuristic depending on
12789 thread_count.
12790
12791 Mistaking a random SIGTRAP for a breakpoint trap
12792 causes similar symptoms (PC adjustment applied when
12793 it shouldn't), but then again, playing with SIGTRAPs
12794 behind the debugger's back is asking for trouble.
12795
12796 Since hardware watchpoint traps are always
12797 distinguishable from other traps, so we don't need to
12798 apply keep hardware watchpoint moribund locations
12799 around. We simply always ignore hardware watchpoint
12800 traps we can no longer explain. */
12801
12802 old_loc->events_till_retirement = 3 * (thread_count () + 1);
12803 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12804
12805 VEC_safe_push (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, old_loc);
12806 }
12807 else
12808 {
12809 old_loc->owner = NULL;
12810 decref_bp_location (&old_loc);
12811 }
12812 }
12813 }
12814
12815 /* Rescan breakpoints at the same address and section, marking the
12816 first one as "first" and any others as "duplicates". This is so
12817 that the bpt instruction is only inserted once. If we have a
12818 permanent breakpoint at the same place as BPT, make that one the
12819 official one, and the rest as duplicates. Permanent breakpoints
12820 are sorted first for the same address.
12821
12822 Do the same for hardware watchpoints, but also considering the
12823 watchpoint's type (regular/access/read) and length. */
12824
12825 bp_loc_first = NULL;
12826 wp_loc_first = NULL;
12827 awp_loc_first = NULL;
12828 rwp_loc_first = NULL;
12829 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
12830 {
12831 /* ALL_BP_LOCATIONS bp_location has LOC->OWNER always
12832 non-NULL. */
12833 struct bp_location **loc_first_p;
12834 b = loc->owner;
12835
12836 if (!unduplicated_should_be_inserted (loc)
12837 || !breakpoint_address_is_meaningful (b)
12838 /* Don't detect duplicate for tracepoint locations because they are
12839 never duplicated. See the comments in field `duplicate' of
12840 `struct bp_location'. */
12841 || is_tracepoint (b))
12842 {
12843 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12844 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12845 continue;
12846 }
12847
12848 /* Permanent breakpoint should always be inserted. */
12849 if (loc->permanent && ! loc->inserted)
12850 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12851 _("allegedly permanent breakpoint is not "
12852 "actually inserted"));
12853
12854 if (b->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
12855 loc_first_p = &wp_loc_first;
12856 else if (b->type == bp_read_watchpoint)
12857 loc_first_p = &rwp_loc_first;
12858 else if (b->type == bp_access_watchpoint)
12859 loc_first_p = &awp_loc_first;
12860 else
12861 loc_first_p = &bp_loc_first;
12862
12863 if (*loc_first_p == NULL
12864 || (overlay_debugging && loc->section != (*loc_first_p)->section)
12865 || !breakpoint_locations_match (loc, *loc_first_p))
12866 {
12867 *loc_first_p = loc;
12868 loc->duplicate = 0;
12869
12870 if (is_breakpoint (loc->owner) && loc->condition_changed)
12871 {
12872 loc->needs_update = 1;
12873 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12874 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12875 }
12876 continue;
12877 }
12878
12879
12880 /* This and the above ensure the invariant that the first location
12881 is not duplicated, and is the inserted one.
12882 All following are marked as duplicated, and are not inserted. */
12883 if (loc->inserted)
12884 swap_insertion (loc, *loc_first_p);
12885 loc->duplicate = 1;
12886
12887 /* Clear the condition modification flag. */
12888 loc->condition_changed = condition_unchanged;
12889
12890 if (loc->inserted && !loc->permanent
12891 && (*loc_first_p)->permanent)
12892 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
12893 _("another breakpoint was inserted on top of "
12894 "a permanent breakpoint"));
12895 }
12896
12897 if (insert_mode == UGLL_INSERT || breakpoints_should_be_inserted_now ())
12898 {
12899 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12900 insert_breakpoint_locations ();
12901 else
12902 {
12903 /* Even though the caller told us to not insert new
12904 locations, we may still need to update conditions on the
12905 target's side of breakpoints that were already inserted
12906 if the target is evaluating breakpoint conditions. We
12907 only update conditions for locations that are marked
12908 "needs_update". */
12909 update_inserted_breakpoint_locations ();
12910 }
12911 }
12912
12913 if (insert_mode != UGLL_DONT_INSERT)
12914 download_tracepoint_locations ();
12915
12916 do_cleanups (cleanups);
12917}
12918
12919void
12920breakpoint_retire_moribund (void)
12921{
12922 struct bp_location *loc;
12923 int ix;
12924
12925 for (ix = 0; VEC_iterate (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix, loc); ++ix)
12926 if (--(loc->events_till_retirement) == 0)
12927 {
12928 decref_bp_location (&loc);
12929 VEC_unordered_remove (bp_location_p, moribund_locations, ix);
12930 --ix;
12931 }
12932}
12933
12934static void
12935update_global_location_list_nothrow (enum ugll_insert_mode insert_mode)
12936{
12937 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
12938
12939 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
12940 update_global_location_list (insert_mode);
12941}
12942
12943/* Clear BKP from a BPS. */
12944
12945static void
12946bpstat_remove_bp_location (bpstat bps, struct breakpoint *bpt)
12947{
12948 bpstat bs;
12949
12950 for (bs = bps; bs; bs = bs->next)
12951 if (bs->breakpoint_at == bpt)
12952 {
12953 bs->breakpoint_at = NULL;
12954 bs->old_val = NULL;
12955 /* bs->commands will be freed later. */
12956 }
12957}
12958
12959/* Callback for iterate_over_threads. */
12960static int
12961bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback (struct thread_info *th, void *data)
12962{
12963 struct breakpoint *bpt = data;
12964
12965 bpstat_remove_bp_location (th->control.stop_bpstat, bpt);
12966 return 0;
12967}
12968
12969/* Helper for breakpoint and tracepoint breakpoint_ops->mention
12970 callbacks. */
12971
12972static void
12973say_where (struct breakpoint *b)
12974{
12975 struct value_print_options opts;
12976
12977 get_user_print_options (&opts);
12978
12979 /* i18n: cagney/2005-02-11: Below needs to be merged into a
12980 single string. */
12981 if (b->loc == NULL)
12982 {
12983 printf_filtered (_(" (%s) pending."), b->addr_string);
12984 }
12985 else
12986 {
12987 if (opts.addressprint || b->loc->symtab == NULL)
12988 {
12989 printf_filtered (" at ");
12990 fputs_filtered (paddress (b->loc->gdbarch, b->loc->address),
12991 gdb_stdout);
12992 }
12993 if (b->loc->symtab != NULL)
12994 {
12995 /* If there is a single location, we can print the location
12996 more nicely. */
12997 if (b->loc->next == NULL)
12998 printf_filtered (": file %s, line %d.",
12999 symtab_to_filename_for_display (b->loc->symtab),
13000 b->loc->line_number);
13001 else
13002 /* This is not ideal, but each location may have a
13003 different file name, and this at least reflects the
13004 real situation somewhat. */
13005 printf_filtered (": %s.", b->addr_string);
13006 }
13007
13008 if (b->loc->next)
13009 {
13010 struct bp_location *loc = b->loc;
13011 int n = 0;
13012 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
13013 ++n;
13014 printf_filtered (" (%d locations)", n);
13015 }
13016 }
13017}
13018
13019/* Default bp_location_ops methods. */
13020
13021static void
13022bp_location_dtor (struct bp_location *self)
13023{
13024 xfree (self->cond);
13025 if (self->cond_bytecode)
13026 free_agent_expr (self->cond_bytecode);
13027 xfree (self->function_name);
13028
13029 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, self->target_info.conditions);
13030 VEC_free (agent_expr_p, self->target_info.tcommands);
13031}
13032
13033static const struct bp_location_ops bp_location_ops =
13034{
13035 bp_location_dtor
13036};
13037
13038/* Default breakpoint_ops methods all breakpoint_ops ultimately
13039 inherit from. */
13040
13041static void
13042base_breakpoint_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
13043{
13044 decref_counted_command_line (&self->commands);
13045 xfree (self->cond_string);
13046 xfree (self->extra_string);
13047 xfree (self->addr_string);
13048 xfree (self->filter);
13049 xfree (self->addr_string_range_end);
13050}
13051
13052static struct bp_location *
13053base_breakpoint_allocate_location (struct breakpoint *self)
13054{
13055 struct bp_location *loc;
13056
13057 loc = XNEW (struct bp_location);
13058 init_bp_location (loc, &bp_location_ops, self);
13059 return loc;
13060}
13061
13062static void
13063base_breakpoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13064{
13065 /* Nothing to re-set. */
13066}
13067
13068#define internal_error_pure_virtual_called() \
13069 gdb_assert_not_reached ("pure virtual function called")
13070
13071static int
13072base_breakpoint_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13073{
13074 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13075}
13076
13077static int
13078base_breakpoint_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13079{
13080 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13081}
13082
13083static int
13084base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13085 struct address_space *aspace,
13086 CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13087 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13088{
13089 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13090}
13091
13092static void
13093base_breakpoint_check_status (bpstat bs)
13094{
13095 /* Always stop. */
13096}
13097
13098/* A "works_in_software_mode" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
13099 errors. */
13100
13101static int
13102base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode (const struct breakpoint *b)
13103{
13104 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13105}
13106
13107/* A "resources_needed" breakpoint_ops method that just internal
13108 errors. */
13109
13110static int
13111base_breakpoint_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
13112{
13113 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13114}
13115
13116static enum print_stop_action
13117base_breakpoint_print_it (bpstat bs)
13118{
13119 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13120}
13121
13122static void
13123base_breakpoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
13124 struct ui_out *uiout)
13125{
13126 /* nothing */
13127}
13128
13129static void
13130base_breakpoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13131{
13132 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13133}
13134
13135static void
13136base_breakpoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
13137{
13138 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13139}
13140
13141static void
13142base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13143 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13144 enum bptype type_wanted,
13145 char *addr_start,
13146 char **copy_arg)
13147{
13148 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13149}
13150
13151static void
13152base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13153 struct linespec_result *c,
13154 char *cond_string,
13155 char *extra_string,
13156 enum bptype type_wanted,
13157 enum bpdisp disposition,
13158 int thread,
13159 int task, int ignore_count,
13160 const struct breakpoint_ops *o,
13161 int from_tty, int enabled,
13162 int internal, unsigned flags)
13163{
13164 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13165}
13166
13167static void
13168base_breakpoint_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13169 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13170{
13171 internal_error_pure_virtual_called ();
13172}
13173
13174/* The default 'explains_signal' method. */
13175
13176static int
13177base_breakpoint_explains_signal (struct breakpoint *b, enum gdb_signal sig)
13178{
13179 return 1;
13180}
13181
13182/* The default "after_condition_true" method. */
13183
13184static void
13185base_breakpoint_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13186{
13187 /* Nothing to do. */
13188}
13189
13190struct breakpoint_ops base_breakpoint_ops =
13191{
13192 base_breakpoint_dtor,
13193 base_breakpoint_allocate_location,
13194 base_breakpoint_re_set,
13195 base_breakpoint_insert_location,
13196 base_breakpoint_remove_location,
13197 base_breakpoint_breakpoint_hit,
13198 base_breakpoint_check_status,
13199 base_breakpoint_resources_needed,
13200 base_breakpoint_works_in_software_mode,
13201 base_breakpoint_print_it,
13202 NULL,
13203 base_breakpoint_print_one_detail,
13204 base_breakpoint_print_mention,
13205 base_breakpoint_print_recreate,
13206 base_breakpoint_create_sals_from_address,
13207 base_breakpoint_create_breakpoints_sal,
13208 base_breakpoint_decode_linespec,
13209 base_breakpoint_explains_signal,
13210 base_breakpoint_after_condition_true,
13211};
13212
13213/* Default breakpoint_ops methods. */
13214
13215static void
13216bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13217{
13218 /* FIXME: is this still reachable? */
13219 if (b->addr_string == NULL)
13220 {
13221 /* Anything without a string can't be re-set. */
13222 delete_breakpoint (b);
13223 return;
13224 }
13225
13226 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13227}
13228
13229static int
13230bkpt_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13231{
13232 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
13233 return target_insert_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13234 else
13235 return target_insert_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13236}
13237
13238static int
13239bkpt_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13240{
13241 if (bl->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_breakpoint)
13242 return target_remove_hw_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13243 else
13244 return target_remove_breakpoint (bl->gdbarch, &bl->target_info);
13245}
13246
13247static int
13248bkpt_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13249 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13250 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13251{
13252 if (ws->kind != TARGET_WAITKIND_STOPPED
13253 || ws->value.sig != GDB_SIGNAL_TRAP)
13254 return 0;
13255
13256 if (!breakpoint_address_match (bl->pspace->aspace, bl->address,
13257 aspace, bp_addr))
13258 return 0;
13259
13260 if (overlay_debugging /* unmapped overlay section */
13261 && section_is_overlay (bl->section)
13262 && !section_is_mapped (bl->section))
13263 return 0;
13264
13265 return 1;
13266}
13267
13268static int
13269dprintf_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13270 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13271 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13272{
13273 if (dprintf_style == dprintf_style_agent
13274 && target_can_run_breakpoint_commands ())
13275 {
13276 /* An agent-style dprintf never causes a stop. If we see a trap
13277 for this address it must be for a breakpoint that happens to
13278 be set at the same address. */
13279 return 0;
13280 }
13281
13282 return bkpt_breakpoint_hit (bl, aspace, bp_addr, ws);
13283}
13284
13285static int
13286bkpt_resources_needed (const struct bp_location *bl)
13287{
13288 gdb_assert (bl->owner->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint);
13289
13290 return 1;
13291}
13292
13293static enum print_stop_action
13294bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13295{
13296 struct breakpoint *b;
13297 const struct bp_location *bl;
13298 int bp_temp;
13299 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13300
13301 gdb_assert (bs->bp_location_at != NULL);
13302
13303 bl = bs->bp_location_at;
13304 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13305
13306 bp_temp = b->disposition == disp_del;
13307 if (bl->address != bl->requested_address)
13308 breakpoint_adjustment_warning (bl->requested_address,
13309 bl->address,
13310 b->number, 1);
13311 annotate_breakpoint (b->number);
13312 if (bp_temp)
13313 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nTemporary breakpoint ");
13314 else
13315 ui_out_text (uiout, "\nBreakpoint ");
13316 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
13317 {
13318 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "reason",
13319 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_BREAKPOINT_HIT));
13320 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "disp", bpdisp_text (b->disposition));
13321 }
13322 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "bkptno", b->number);
13323 ui_out_text (uiout, ", ");
13324
13325 return PRINT_SRC_AND_LOC;
13326}
13327
13328static void
13329bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13330{
13331 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13332 return;
13333
13334 switch (b->type)
13335 {
13336 case bp_breakpoint:
13337 case bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver:
13338 if (b->disposition == disp_del)
13339 printf_filtered (_("Temporary breakpoint"));
13340 else
13341 printf_filtered (_("Breakpoint"));
13342 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13343 if (b->type == bp_gnu_ifunc_resolver)
13344 printf_filtered (_(" at gnu-indirect-function resolver"));
13345 break;
13346 case bp_hardware_breakpoint:
13347 printf_filtered (_("Hardware assisted breakpoint %d"), b->number);
13348 break;
13349 case bp_dprintf:
13350 printf_filtered (_("Dprintf %d"), b->number);
13351 break;
13352 }
13353
13354 say_where (b);
13355}
13356
13357static void
13358bkpt_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13359{
13360 if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13361 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "tbreak");
13362 else if (tp->type == bp_breakpoint)
13363 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "break");
13364 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint
13365 && tp->disposition == disp_del)
13366 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "thbreak");
13367 else if (tp->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
13368 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "hbreak");
13369 else
13370 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13371 _("unhandled breakpoint type %d"), (int) tp->type);
13372
13373 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", tp->addr_string);
13374 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13375}
13376
13377static void
13378bkpt_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13379 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13380 enum bptype type_wanted,
13381 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13382{
13383 create_sals_from_address_default (arg, canonical, type_wanted,
13384 addr_start, copy_arg);
13385}
13386
13387static void
13388bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13389 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13390 char *cond_string,
13391 char *extra_string,
13392 enum bptype type_wanted,
13393 enum bpdisp disposition,
13394 int thread,
13395 int task, int ignore_count,
13396 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13397 int from_tty, int enabled,
13398 int internal, unsigned flags)
13399{
13400 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13401 cond_string, extra_string,
13402 type_wanted,
13403 disposition, thread, task,
13404 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13405 enabled, internal, flags);
13406}
13407
13408static void
13409bkpt_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13410 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13411{
13412 decode_linespec_default (b, s, sals);
13413}
13414
13415/* Virtual table for internal breakpoints. */
13416
13417static void
13418internal_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13419{
13420 switch (b->type)
13421 {
13422 /* Delete overlay event and longjmp master breakpoints; they
13423 will be reset later by breakpoint_re_set. */
13424 case bp_overlay_event:
13425 case bp_longjmp_master:
13426 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13427 case bp_exception_master:
13428 delete_breakpoint (b);
13429 break;
13430
13431 /* This breakpoint is special, it's set up when the inferior
13432 starts and we really don't want to touch it. */
13433 case bp_shlib_event:
13434
13435 /* Like bp_shlib_event, this breakpoint type is special. Once
13436 it is set up, we do not want to touch it. */
13437 case bp_thread_event:
13438 break;
13439 }
13440}
13441
13442static void
13443internal_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13444{
13445 if (bs->breakpoint_at->type == bp_shlib_event)
13446 {
13447 /* If requested, stop when the dynamic linker notifies GDB of
13448 events. This allows the user to get control and place
13449 breakpoints in initializer routines for dynamically loaded
13450 objects (among other things). */
13451 bs->stop = stop_on_solib_events;
13452 bs->print = stop_on_solib_events;
13453 }
13454 else
13455 bs->stop = 0;
13456}
13457
13458static enum print_stop_action
13459internal_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13460{
13461 struct breakpoint *b;
13462
13463 b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13464
13465 switch (b->type)
13466 {
13467 case bp_shlib_event:
13468 /* Did we stop because the user set the stop_on_solib_events
13469 variable? (If so, we report this as a generic, "Stopped due
13470 to shlib event" message.) */
13471 print_solib_event (0);
13472 break;
13473
13474 case bp_thread_event:
13475 /* Not sure how we will get here.
13476 GDB should not stop for these breakpoints. */
13477 printf_filtered (_("Thread Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13478 break;
13479
13480 case bp_overlay_event:
13481 /* By analogy with the thread event, GDB should not stop for these. */
13482 printf_filtered (_("Overlay Event Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13483 break;
13484
13485 case bp_longjmp_master:
13486 /* These should never be enabled. */
13487 printf_filtered (_("Longjmp Master Breakpoint: gdb should not stop!\n"));
13488 break;
13489
13490 case bp_std_terminate_master:
13491 /* These should never be enabled. */
13492 printf_filtered (_("std::terminate Master Breakpoint: "
13493 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13494 break;
13495
13496 case bp_exception_master:
13497 /* These should never be enabled. */
13498 printf_filtered (_("Exception Master Breakpoint: "
13499 "gdb should not stop!\n"));
13500 break;
13501 }
13502
13503 return PRINT_NOTHING;
13504}
13505
13506static void
13507internal_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13508{
13509 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13510}
13511
13512/* Virtual table for momentary breakpoints */
13513
13514static void
13515momentary_bkpt_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13516{
13517 /* Keep temporary breakpoints, which can be encountered when we step
13518 over a dlopen call and solib_add is resetting the breakpoints.
13519 Otherwise these should have been blown away via the cleanup chain
13520 or by breakpoint_init_inferior when we rerun the executable. */
13521}
13522
13523static void
13524momentary_bkpt_check_status (bpstat bs)
13525{
13526 /* Nothing. The point of these breakpoints is causing a stop. */
13527}
13528
13529static enum print_stop_action
13530momentary_bkpt_print_it (bpstat bs)
13531{
13532 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
13533
13534 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
13535 {
13536 struct breakpoint *b = bs->breakpoint_at;
13537
13538 switch (b->type)
13539 {
13540 case bp_finish:
13541 ui_out_field_string
13542 (uiout, "reason",
13543 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_FUNCTION_FINISHED));
13544 break;
13545
13546 case bp_until:
13547 ui_out_field_string
13548 (uiout, "reason",
13549 async_reason_lookup (EXEC_ASYNC_LOCATION_REACHED));
13550 break;
13551 }
13552 }
13553
13554 return PRINT_UNKNOWN;
13555}
13556
13557static void
13558momentary_bkpt_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13559{
13560 /* Nothing to mention. These breakpoints are internal. */
13561}
13562
13563/* Ensure INITIATING_FRAME is cleared when no such breakpoint exists.
13564
13565 It gets cleared already on the removal of the first one of such placed
13566 breakpoints. This is OK as they get all removed altogether. */
13567
13568static void
13569longjmp_bkpt_dtor (struct breakpoint *self)
13570{
13571 struct thread_info *tp = find_thread_id (self->thread);
13572
13573 if (tp)
13574 tp->initiating_frame = null_frame_id;
13575
13576 momentary_breakpoint_ops.dtor (self);
13577}
13578
13579/* Specific methods for probe breakpoints. */
13580
13581static int
13582bkpt_probe_insert_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13583{
13584 int v = bkpt_insert_location (bl);
13585
13586 if (v == 0)
13587 {
13588 /* The insertion was successful, now let's set the probe's semaphore
13589 if needed. */
13590 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore != NULL)
13591 bl->probe.probe->pops->set_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13592 bl->probe.objfile,
13593 bl->gdbarch);
13594 }
13595
13596 return v;
13597}
13598
13599static int
13600bkpt_probe_remove_location (struct bp_location *bl)
13601{
13602 /* Let's clear the semaphore before removing the location. */
13603 if (bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore != NULL)
13604 bl->probe.probe->pops->clear_semaphore (bl->probe.probe,
13605 bl->probe.objfile,
13606 bl->gdbarch);
13607
13608 return bkpt_remove_location (bl);
13609}
13610
13611static void
13612bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13613 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13614 enum bptype type_wanted,
13615 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13616{
13617 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13618
13619 lsal.sals = parse_probes (arg, canonical);
13620
13621 *copy_arg = xstrdup (canonical->addr_string);
13622 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (*copy_arg);
13623
13624 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13625}
13626
13627static void
13628bkpt_probe_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13629 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13630{
13631 *sals = parse_probes (s, NULL);
13632 if (!sals->sals)
13633 error (_("probe not found"));
13634}
13635
13636/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in tracepoints. */
13637
13638static void
13639tracepoint_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13640{
13641 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13642}
13643
13644static int
13645tracepoint_breakpoint_hit (const struct bp_location *bl,
13646 struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR bp_addr,
13647 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
13648{
13649 /* By definition, the inferior does not report stops at
13650 tracepoints. */
13651 return 0;
13652}
13653
13654static void
13655tracepoint_print_one_detail (const struct breakpoint *self,
13656 struct ui_out *uiout)
13657{
13658 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13659 if (tp->static_trace_marker_id)
13660 {
13661 gdb_assert (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint);
13662
13663 ui_out_text (uiout, "\tmarker id is ");
13664 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "static-tracepoint-marker-string-id",
13665 tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13666 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
13667 }
13668}
13669
13670static void
13671tracepoint_print_mention (struct breakpoint *b)
13672{
13673 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (current_uiout))
13674 return;
13675
13676 switch (b->type)
13677 {
13678 case bp_tracepoint:
13679 printf_filtered (_("Tracepoint"));
13680 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13681 break;
13682 case bp_fast_tracepoint:
13683 printf_filtered (_("Fast tracepoint"));
13684 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13685 break;
13686 case bp_static_tracepoint:
13687 printf_filtered (_("Static tracepoint"));
13688 printf_filtered (_(" %d"), b->number);
13689 break;
13690 default:
13691 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13692 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) b->type);
13693 }
13694
13695 say_where (b);
13696}
13697
13698static void
13699tracepoint_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *self, struct ui_file *fp)
13700{
13701 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) self;
13702
13703 if (self->type == bp_fast_tracepoint)
13704 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "ftrace");
13705 if (self->type == bp_static_tracepoint)
13706 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "strace");
13707 else if (self->type == bp_tracepoint)
13708 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "trace");
13709 else
13710 internal_error (__FILE__, __LINE__,
13711 _("unhandled tracepoint type %d"), (int) self->type);
13712
13713 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " %s", self->addr_string);
13714 print_recreate_thread (self, fp);
13715
13716 if (tp->pass_count)
13717 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " passcount %d\n", tp->pass_count);
13718}
13719
13720static void
13721tracepoint_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13722 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13723 enum bptype type_wanted,
13724 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13725{
13726 create_sals_from_address_default (arg, canonical, type_wanted,
13727 addr_start, copy_arg);
13728}
13729
13730static void
13731tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13732 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13733 char *cond_string,
13734 char *extra_string,
13735 enum bptype type_wanted,
13736 enum bpdisp disposition,
13737 int thread,
13738 int task, int ignore_count,
13739 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13740 int from_tty, int enabled,
13741 int internal, unsigned flags)
13742{
13743 create_breakpoints_sal_default (gdbarch, canonical,
13744 cond_string, extra_string,
13745 type_wanted,
13746 disposition, thread, task,
13747 ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
13748 enabled, internal, flags);
13749}
13750
13751static void
13752tracepoint_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13753 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13754{
13755 decode_linespec_default (b, s, sals);
13756}
13757
13758struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
13759
13760/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be use on tracepoints placed in a
13761 static probe. */
13762
13763static void
13764tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13765 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13766 enum bptype type_wanted,
13767 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13768{
13769 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13770 bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_address (arg, canonical, type_wanted,
13771 addr_start, copy_arg);
13772}
13773
13774static void
13775tracepoint_probe_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13776 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13777{
13778 /* We use the same method for breakpoint on probes. */
13779 bkpt_probe_decode_linespec (b, s, sals);
13780}
13781
13782static struct breakpoint_ops tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
13783
13784/* Dprintf breakpoint_ops methods. */
13785
13786static void
13787dprintf_re_set (struct breakpoint *b)
13788{
13789 breakpoint_re_set_default (b);
13790
13791 /* This breakpoint could have been pending, and be resolved now, and
13792 if so, we should now have the extra string. If we don't, the
13793 dprintf was malformed when created, but we couldn't tell because
13794 we can't extract the extra string until the location is
13795 resolved. */
13796 if (b->loc != NULL && b->extra_string == NULL)
13797 error (_("Format string required"));
13798
13799 /* 1 - connect to target 1, that can run breakpoint commands.
13800 2 - create a dprintf, which resolves fine.
13801 3 - disconnect from target 1
13802 4 - connect to target 2, that can NOT run breakpoint commands.
13803
13804 After steps #3/#4, you'll want the dprintf command list to
13805 be updated, because target 1 and 2 may well return different
13806 answers for target_can_run_breakpoint_commands().
13807 Given absence of finer grained resetting, we get to do
13808 it all the time. */
13809 if (b->extra_string != NULL)
13810 update_dprintf_command_list (b);
13811}
13812
13813/* Implement the "print_recreate" breakpoint_ops method for dprintf. */
13814
13815static void
13816dprintf_print_recreate (struct breakpoint *tp, struct ui_file *fp)
13817{
13818 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "dprintf %s%s", tp->addr_string,
13819 tp->extra_string);
13820 print_recreate_thread (tp, fp);
13821}
13822
13823/* Implement the "after_condition_true" breakpoint_ops method for
13824 dprintf.
13825
13826 dprintf's are implemented with regular commands in their command
13827 list, but we run the commands here instead of before presenting the
13828 stop to the user, as dprintf's don't actually cause a stop. This
13829 also makes it so that the commands of multiple dprintfs at the same
13830 address are all handled. */
13831
13832static void
13833dprintf_after_condition_true (struct bpstats *bs)
13834{
13835 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13836 struct bpstats tmp_bs = { NULL };
13837 struct bpstats *tmp_bs_p = &tmp_bs;
13838
13839 /* dprintf's never cause a stop. This wasn't set in the
13840 check_status hook instead because that would make the dprintf's
13841 condition not be evaluated. */
13842 bs->stop = 0;
13843
13844 /* Run the command list here. Take ownership of it instead of
13845 copying. We never want these commands to run later in
13846 bpstat_do_actions, if a breakpoint that causes a stop happens to
13847 be set at same address as this dprintf, or even if running the
13848 commands here throws. */
13849 tmp_bs.commands = bs->commands;
13850 bs->commands = NULL;
13851 old_chain = make_cleanup_decref_counted_command_line (&tmp_bs.commands);
13852
13853 bpstat_do_actions_1 (&tmp_bs_p);
13854
13855 /* 'tmp_bs.commands' will usually be NULL by now, but
13856 bpstat_do_actions_1 may return early without processing the whole
13857 list. */
13858 do_cleanups (old_chain);
13859}
13860
13861/* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used on static tracepoints with
13862 markers (`-m'). */
13863
13864static void
13865strace_marker_create_sals_from_address (char **arg,
13866 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13867 enum bptype type_wanted,
13868 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
13869{
13870 struct linespec_sals lsal;
13871
13872 lsal.sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (arg);
13873
13874 *copy_arg = savestring (addr_start, *arg - addr_start);
13875
13876 canonical->addr_string = xstrdup (*copy_arg);
13877 lsal.canonical = xstrdup (*copy_arg);
13878 VEC_safe_push (linespec_sals, canonical->sals, &lsal);
13879}
13880
13881static void
13882strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
13883 struct linespec_result *canonical,
13884 char *cond_string,
13885 char *extra_string,
13886 enum bptype type_wanted,
13887 enum bpdisp disposition,
13888 int thread,
13889 int task, int ignore_count,
13890 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
13891 int from_tty, int enabled,
13892 int internal, unsigned flags)
13893{
13894 int i;
13895 struct linespec_sals *lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals,
13896 canonical->sals, 0);
13897
13898 /* If the user is creating a static tracepoint by marker id
13899 (strace -m MARKER_ID), then store the sals index, so that
13900 breakpoint_re_set can try to match up which of the newly
13901 found markers corresponds to this one, and, don't try to
13902 expand multiple locations for each sal, given than SALS
13903 already should contain all sals for MARKER_ID. */
13904
13905 for (i = 0; i < lsal->sals.nelts; ++i)
13906 {
13907 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded;
13908 struct tracepoint *tp;
13909 struct cleanup *old_chain;
13910 char *addr_string;
13911
13912 expanded.nelts = 1;
13913 expanded.sals = &lsal->sals.sals[i];
13914
13915 addr_string = xstrdup (canonical->addr_string);
13916 old_chain = make_cleanup (xfree, addr_string);
13917
13918 tp = XCNEW (struct tracepoint);
13919 init_breakpoint_sal (&tp->base, gdbarch, expanded,
13920 addr_string, NULL,
13921 cond_string, extra_string,
13922 type_wanted, disposition,
13923 thread, task, ignore_count, ops,
13924 from_tty, enabled, internal, flags,
13925 canonical->special_display);
13926 /* Given that its possible to have multiple markers with
13927 the same string id, if the user is creating a static
13928 tracepoint by marker id ("strace -m MARKER_ID"), then
13929 store the sals index, so that breakpoint_re_set can
13930 try to match up which of the newly found markers
13931 corresponds to this one */
13932 tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx = i;
13933
13934 install_breakpoint (internal, &tp->base, 0);
13935
13936 discard_cleanups (old_chain);
13937 }
13938}
13939
13940static void
13941strace_marker_decode_linespec (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
13942 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
13943{
13944 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
13945
13946 *sals = decode_static_tracepoint_spec (s);
13947 if (sals->nelts > tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx)
13948 {
13949 sals->sals[0] = sals->sals[tp->static_trace_marker_id_idx];
13950 sals->nelts = 1;
13951 }
13952 else
13953 error (_("marker %s not found"), tp->static_trace_marker_id);
13954}
13955
13956static struct breakpoint_ops strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13957
13958static int
13959strace_marker_p (struct breakpoint *b)
13960{
13961 return b->ops == &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
13962}
13963
13964/* Delete a breakpoint and clean up all traces of it in the data
13965 structures. */
13966
13967void
13968delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
13969{
13970 struct breakpoint *b;
13971
13972 gdb_assert (bpt != NULL);
13973
13974 /* Has this bp already been deleted? This can happen because
13975 multiple lists can hold pointers to bp's. bpstat lists are
13976 especial culprits.
13977
13978 One example of this happening is a watchpoint's scope bp. When
13979 the scope bp triggers, we notice that the watchpoint is out of
13980 scope, and delete it. We also delete its scope bp. But the
13981 scope bp is marked "auto-deleting", and is already on a bpstat.
13982 That bpstat is then checked for auto-deleting bp's, which are
13983 deleted.
13984
13985 A real solution to this problem might involve reference counts in
13986 bp's, and/or giving them pointers back to their referencing
13987 bpstat's, and teaching delete_breakpoint to only free a bp's
13988 storage when no more references were extent. A cheaper bandaid
13989 was chosen. */
13990 if (bpt->type == bp_none)
13991 return;
13992
13993 /* At least avoid this stale reference until the reference counting
13994 of breakpoints gets resolved. */
13995 if (bpt->related_breakpoint != bpt)
13996 {
13997 struct breakpoint *related;
13998 struct watchpoint *w;
13999
14000 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14001 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt->related_breakpoint;
14002 else if (bpt->related_breakpoint->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14003 w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
14004 else
14005 w = NULL;
14006 if (w != NULL)
14007 watchpoint_del_at_next_stop (w);
14008
14009 /* Unlink bpt from the bpt->related_breakpoint ring. */
14010 for (related = bpt; related->related_breakpoint != bpt;
14011 related = related->related_breakpoint);
14012 related->related_breakpoint = bpt->related_breakpoint;
14013 bpt->related_breakpoint = bpt;
14014 }
14015
14016 /* watch_command_1 creates a watchpoint but only sets its number if
14017 update_watchpoint succeeds in creating its bp_locations. If there's
14018 a problem in that process, we'll be asked to delete the half-created
14019 watchpoint. In that case, don't announce the deletion. */
14020 if (bpt->number)
14021 observer_notify_breakpoint_deleted (bpt);
14022
14023 if (breakpoint_chain == bpt)
14024 breakpoint_chain = bpt->next;
14025
14026 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14027 if (b->next == bpt)
14028 {
14029 b->next = bpt->next;
14030 break;
14031 }
14032
14033 /* Be sure no bpstat's are pointing at the breakpoint after it's
14034 been freed. */
14035 /* FIXME, how can we find all bpstat's? We just check stop_bpstat
14036 in all threads for now. Note that we cannot just remove bpstats
14037 pointing at bpt from the stop_bpstat list entirely, as breakpoint
14038 commands are associated with the bpstat; if we remove it here,
14039 then the later call to bpstat_do_actions (&stop_bpstat); in
14040 event-top.c won't do anything, and temporary breakpoints with
14041 commands won't work. */
14042
14043 iterate_over_threads (bpstat_remove_breakpoint_callback, bpt);
14044
14045 /* Now that breakpoint is removed from breakpoint list, update the
14046 global location list. This will remove locations that used to
14047 belong to this breakpoint. Do this before freeing the breakpoint
14048 itself, since remove_breakpoint looks at location's owner. It
14049 might be better design to have location completely
14050 self-contained, but it's not the case now. */
14051 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14052
14053 bpt->ops->dtor (bpt);
14054 /* On the chance that someone will soon try again to delete this
14055 same bp, we mark it as deleted before freeing its storage. */
14056 bpt->type = bp_none;
14057 xfree (bpt);
14058}
14059
14060static void
14061do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup (void *b)
14062{
14063 delete_breakpoint (b);
14064}
14065
14066struct cleanup *
14067make_cleanup_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b)
14068{
14069 return make_cleanup (do_delete_breakpoint_cleanup, b);
14070}
14071
14072/* Iterator function to call a user-provided callback function once
14073 for each of B and its related breakpoints. */
14074
14075static void
14076iterate_over_related_breakpoints (struct breakpoint *b,
14077 void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
14078 void *),
14079 void *data)
14080{
14081 struct breakpoint *related;
14082
14083 related = b;
14084 do
14085 {
14086 struct breakpoint *next;
14087
14088 /* FUNCTION may delete RELATED. */
14089 next = related->related_breakpoint;
14090
14091 if (next == related)
14092 {
14093 /* RELATED is the last ring entry. */
14094 function (related, data);
14095
14096 /* FUNCTION may have deleted it, so we'd never reach back to
14097 B. There's nothing left to do anyway, so just break
14098 out. */
14099 break;
14100 }
14101 else
14102 function (related, data);
14103
14104 related = next;
14105 }
14106 while (related != b);
14107}
14108
14109static void
14110do_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14111{
14112 delete_breakpoint (b);
14113}
14114
14115/* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14116 delete_breakpoint. */
14117
14118static void
14119do_map_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14120{
14121 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
14122}
14123
14124void
14125delete_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
14126{
14127 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14128
14129 dont_repeat ();
14130
14131 if (arg == 0)
14132 {
14133 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
14134
14135 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument. Do not delete
14136 internal breakpoints, these have to be deleted with an
14137 explicit breakpoint number argument. */
14138 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14139 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
14140 {
14141 breaks_to_delete = 1;
14142 break;
14143 }
14144
14145 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
14146 if (!from_tty
14147 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all breakpoints? "))))
14148 {
14149 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14150 if (user_breakpoint_p (b))
14151 delete_breakpoint (b);
14152 }
14153 }
14154 else
14155 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
14156}
14157
14158static int
14159all_locations_are_pending (struct bp_location *loc)
14160{
14161 for (; loc; loc = loc->next)
14162 if (!loc->shlib_disabled
14163 && !loc->pspace->executing_startup)
14164 return 0;
14165 return 1;
14166}
14167
14168/* Subroutine of update_breakpoint_locations to simplify it.
14169 Return non-zero if multiple fns in list LOC have the same name.
14170 Null names are ignored. */
14171
14172static int
14173ambiguous_names_p (struct bp_location *loc)
14174{
14175 struct bp_location *l;
14176 htab_t htab = htab_create_alloc (13, htab_hash_string,
14177 (int (*) (const void *,
14178 const void *)) streq,
14179 NULL, xcalloc, xfree);
14180
14181 for (l = loc; l != NULL; l = l->next)
14182 {
14183 const char **slot;
14184 const char *name = l->function_name;
14185
14186 /* Allow for some names to be NULL, ignore them. */
14187 if (name == NULL)
14188 continue;
14189
14190 slot = (const char **) htab_find_slot (htab, (const void *) name,
14191 INSERT);
14192 /* NOTE: We can assume slot != NULL here because xcalloc never
14193 returns NULL. */
14194 if (*slot != NULL)
14195 {
14196 htab_delete (htab);
14197 return 1;
14198 }
14199 *slot = name;
14200 }
14201
14202 htab_delete (htab);
14203 return 0;
14204}
14205
14206/* When symbols change, it probably means the sources changed as well,
14207 and it might mean the static tracepoint markers are no longer at
14208 the same address or line numbers they used to be at last we
14209 checked. Losing your static tracepoints whenever you rebuild is
14210 undesirable. This function tries to resync/rematch gdb static
14211 tracepoints with the markers on the target, for static tracepoints
14212 that have not been set by marker id. Static tracepoint that have
14213 been set by marker id are reset by marker id in breakpoint_re_set.
14214 The heuristic is:
14215
14216 1) For a tracepoint set at a specific address, look for a marker at
14217 the old PC. If one is found there, assume to be the same marker.
14218 If the name / string id of the marker found is different from the
14219 previous known name, assume that means the user renamed the marker
14220 in the sources, and output a warning.
14221
14222 2) For a tracepoint set at a given line number, look for a marker
14223 at the new address of the old line number. If one is found there,
14224 assume to be the same marker. If the name / string id of the
14225 marker found is different from the previous known name, assume that
14226 means the user renamed the marker in the sources, and output a
14227 warning.
14228
14229 3) If a marker is no longer found at the same address or line, it
14230 may mean the marker no longer exists. But it may also just mean
14231 the code changed a bit. Maybe the user added a few lines of code
14232 that made the marker move up or down (in line number terms). Ask
14233 the target for info about the marker with the string id as we knew
14234 it. If found, update line number and address in the matching
14235 static tracepoint. This will get confused if there's more than one
14236 marker with the same ID (possible in UST, although unadvised
14237 precisely because it confuses tools). */
14238
14239static struct symtab_and_line
14240update_static_tracepoint (struct breakpoint *b, struct symtab_and_line sal)
14241{
14242 struct tracepoint *tp = (struct tracepoint *) b;
14243 struct static_tracepoint_marker marker;
14244 CORE_ADDR pc;
14245
14246 pc = sal.pc;
14247 if (sal.line)
14248 find_line_pc (sal.symtab, sal.line, &pc);
14249
14250 if (target_static_tracepoint_marker_at (pc, &marker))
14251 {
14252 if (strcmp (tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id) != 0)
14253 warning (_("static tracepoint %d changed probed marker from %s to %s"),
14254 b->number,
14255 tp->static_trace_marker_id, marker.str_id);
14256
14257 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14258 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (marker.str_id);
14259 release_static_tracepoint_marker (&marker);
14260
14261 return sal;
14262 }
14263
14264 /* Old marker wasn't found on target at lineno. Try looking it up
14265 by string ID. */
14266 if (!sal.explicit_pc
14267 && sal.line != 0
14268 && sal.symtab != NULL
14269 && tp->static_trace_marker_id != NULL)
14270 {
14271 VEC(static_tracepoint_marker_p) *markers;
14272
14273 markers
14274 = target_static_tracepoint_markers_by_strid (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14275
14276 if (!VEC_empty(static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers))
14277 {
14278 struct symtab_and_line sal2;
14279 struct symbol *sym;
14280 struct static_tracepoint_marker *tpmarker;
14281 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
14282
14283 tpmarker = VEC_index (static_tracepoint_marker_p, markers, 0);
14284
14285 xfree (tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14286 tp->static_trace_marker_id = xstrdup (tpmarker->str_id);
14287
14288 warning (_("marker for static tracepoint %d (%s) not "
14289 "found at previous line number"),
14290 b->number, tp->static_trace_marker_id);
14291
14292 init_sal (&sal2);
14293
14294 sal2.pc = tpmarker->address;
14295
14296 sal2 = find_pc_line (tpmarker->address, 0);
14297 sym = find_pc_sect_function (tpmarker->address, NULL);
14298 ui_out_text (uiout, "Now in ");
14299 if (sym)
14300 {
14301 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "func",
14302 SYMBOL_PRINT_NAME (sym));
14303 ui_out_text (uiout, " at ");
14304 }
14305 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "file",
14306 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab));
14307 ui_out_text (uiout, ":");
14308
14309 if (ui_out_is_mi_like_p (uiout))
14310 {
14311 const char *fullname = symtab_to_fullname (sal2.symtab);
14312
14313 ui_out_field_string (uiout, "fullname", fullname);
14314 }
14315
14316 ui_out_field_int (uiout, "line", sal2.line);
14317 ui_out_text (uiout, "\n");
14318
14319 b->loc->line_number = sal2.line;
14320 b->loc->symtab = sym != NULL ? sal2.symtab : NULL;
14321
14322 xfree (b->addr_string);
14323 b->addr_string = xstrprintf ("%s:%d",
14324 symtab_to_filename_for_display (sal2.symtab),
14325 b->loc->line_number);
14326
14327 /* Might be nice to check if function changed, and warn if
14328 so. */
14329
14330 release_static_tracepoint_marker (tpmarker);
14331 }
14332 }
14333 return sal;
14334}
14335
14336/* Returns 1 iff locations A and B are sufficiently same that
14337 we don't need to report breakpoint as changed. */
14338
14339static int
14340locations_are_equal (struct bp_location *a, struct bp_location *b)
14341{
14342 while (a && b)
14343 {
14344 if (a->address != b->address)
14345 return 0;
14346
14347 if (a->shlib_disabled != b->shlib_disabled)
14348 return 0;
14349
14350 if (a->enabled != b->enabled)
14351 return 0;
14352
14353 a = a->next;
14354 b = b->next;
14355 }
14356
14357 if ((a == NULL) != (b == NULL))
14358 return 0;
14359
14360 return 1;
14361}
14362
14363/* Create new breakpoint locations for B (a hardware or software breakpoint)
14364 based on SALS and SALS_END. If SALS_END.NELTS is not zero, then B is
14365 a ranged breakpoint. */
14366
14367void
14368update_breakpoint_locations (struct breakpoint *b,
14369 struct symtabs_and_lines sals,
14370 struct symtabs_and_lines sals_end)
14371{
14372 int i;
14373 struct bp_location *existing_locations = b->loc;
14374
14375 if (sals_end.nelts != 0 && (sals.nelts != 1 || sals_end.nelts != 1))
14376 {
14377 /* Ranged breakpoints have only one start location and one end
14378 location. */
14379 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14380 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14381 printf_unfiltered (_("Could not reset ranged breakpoint %d: "
14382 "multiple locations found\n"),
14383 b->number);
14384 return;
14385 }
14386
14387 /* If there's no new locations, and all existing locations are
14388 pending, don't do anything. This optimizes the common case where
14389 all locations are in the same shared library, that was unloaded.
14390 We'd like to retain the location, so that when the library is
14391 loaded again, we don't loose the enabled/disabled status of the
14392 individual locations. */
14393 if (all_locations_are_pending (existing_locations) && sals.nelts == 0)
14394 return;
14395
14396 b->loc = NULL;
14397
14398 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14399 {
14400 struct bp_location *new_loc;
14401
14402 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (sals.sals[i].pspace);
14403
14404 new_loc = add_location_to_breakpoint (b, &(sals.sals[i]));
14405
14406 /* Reparse conditions, they might contain references to the
14407 old symtab. */
14408 if (b->cond_string != NULL)
14409 {
14410 const char *s;
14411 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
14412
14413 s = b->cond_string;
14414 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14415 {
14416 new_loc->cond = parse_exp_1 (&s, sals.sals[i].pc,
14417 block_for_pc (sals.sals[i].pc),
14418 0);
14419 }
14420 if (e.reason < 0)
14421 {
14422 warning (_("failed to reevaluate condition "
14423 "for breakpoint %d: %s"),
14424 b->number, e.message);
14425 new_loc->enabled = 0;
14426 }
14427 }
14428
14429 if (sals_end.nelts)
14430 {
14431 CORE_ADDR end = find_breakpoint_range_end (sals_end.sals[0]);
14432
14433 new_loc->length = end - sals.sals[0].pc + 1;
14434 }
14435 }
14436
14437 /* If possible, carry over 'disable' status from existing
14438 breakpoints. */
14439 {
14440 struct bp_location *e = existing_locations;
14441 /* If there are multiple breakpoints with the same function name,
14442 e.g. for inline functions, comparing function names won't work.
14443 Instead compare pc addresses; this is just a heuristic as things
14444 may have moved, but in practice it gives the correct answer
14445 often enough until a better solution is found. */
14446 int have_ambiguous_names = ambiguous_names_p (b->loc);
14447
14448 for (; e; e = e->next)
14449 {
14450 if (!e->enabled && e->function_name)
14451 {
14452 struct bp_location *l = b->loc;
14453 if (have_ambiguous_names)
14454 {
14455 for (; l; l = l->next)
14456 if (breakpoint_locations_match (e, l))
14457 {
14458 l->enabled = 0;
14459 break;
14460 }
14461 }
14462 else
14463 {
14464 for (; l; l = l->next)
14465 if (l->function_name
14466 && strcmp (e->function_name, l->function_name) == 0)
14467 {
14468 l->enabled = 0;
14469 break;
14470 }
14471 }
14472 }
14473 }
14474 }
14475
14476 if (!locations_are_equal (existing_locations, b->loc))
14477 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14478
14479 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
14480}
14481
14482/* Find the SaL locations corresponding to the given ADDR_STRING.
14483 On return, FOUND will be 1 if any SaL was found, zero otherwise. */
14484
14485static struct symtabs_and_lines
14486addr_string_to_sals (struct breakpoint *b, char *addr_string, int *found)
14487{
14488 char *s;
14489 struct symtabs_and_lines sals = {0};
14490 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
14491
14492 gdb_assert (b->ops != NULL);
14493 s = addr_string;
14494
14495 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ERROR)
14496 {
14497 b->ops->decode_linespec (b, &s, &sals);
14498 }
14499 if (e.reason < 0)
14500 {
14501 int not_found_and_ok = 0;
14502 /* For pending breakpoints, it's expected that parsing will
14503 fail until the right shared library is loaded. User has
14504 already told to create pending breakpoints and don't need
14505 extra messages. If breakpoint is in bp_shlib_disabled
14506 state, then user already saw the message about that
14507 breakpoint being disabled, and don't want to see more
14508 errors. */
14509 if (e.error == NOT_FOUND_ERROR
14510 && (b->condition_not_parsed
14511 || (b->loc && b->loc->shlib_disabled)
14512 || (b->loc && b->loc->pspace->executing_startup)
14513 || b->enable_state == bp_disabled))
14514 not_found_and_ok = 1;
14515
14516 if (!not_found_and_ok)
14517 {
14518 /* We surely don't want to warn about the same breakpoint
14519 10 times. One solution, implemented here, is disable
14520 the breakpoint on error. Another solution would be to
14521 have separate 'warning emitted' flag. Since this
14522 happens only when a binary has changed, I don't know
14523 which approach is better. */
14524 b->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14525 throw_exception (e);
14526 }
14527 }
14528
14529 if (e.reason == 0 || e.error != NOT_FOUND_ERROR)
14530 {
14531 int i;
14532
14533 for (i = 0; i < sals.nelts; ++i)
14534 resolve_sal_pc (&sals.sals[i]);
14535 if (b->condition_not_parsed && s && s[0])
14536 {
14537 char *cond_string, *extra_string;
14538 int thread, task;
14539
14540 find_condition_and_thread (s, sals.sals[0].pc,
14541 &cond_string, &thread, &task,
14542 &extra_string);
14543 if (cond_string)
14544 b->cond_string = cond_string;
14545 b->thread = thread;
14546 b->task = task;
14547 if (extra_string)
14548 b->extra_string = extra_string;
14549 b->condition_not_parsed = 0;
14550 }
14551
14552 if (b->type == bp_static_tracepoint && !strace_marker_p (b))
14553 sals.sals[0] = update_static_tracepoint (b, sals.sals[0]);
14554
14555 *found = 1;
14556 }
14557 else
14558 *found = 0;
14559
14560 return sals;
14561}
14562
14563/* The default re_set method, for typical hardware or software
14564 breakpoints. Reevaluate the breakpoint and recreate its
14565 locations. */
14566
14567static void
14568breakpoint_re_set_default (struct breakpoint *b)
14569{
14570 int found;
14571 struct symtabs_and_lines sals, sals_end;
14572 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded = {0};
14573 struct symtabs_and_lines expanded_end = {0};
14574
14575 sals = addr_string_to_sals (b, b->addr_string, &found);
14576 if (found)
14577 {
14578 make_cleanup (xfree, sals.sals);
14579 expanded = sals;
14580 }
14581
14582 if (b->addr_string_range_end)
14583 {
14584 sals_end = addr_string_to_sals (b, b->addr_string_range_end, &found);
14585 if (found)
14586 {
14587 make_cleanup (xfree, sals_end.sals);
14588 expanded_end = sals_end;
14589 }
14590 }
14591
14592 update_breakpoint_locations (b, expanded, expanded_end);
14593}
14594
14595/* Default method for creating SALs from an address string. It basically
14596 calls parse_breakpoint_sals. Return 1 for success, zero for failure. */
14597
14598static void
14599create_sals_from_address_default (char **arg,
14600 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14601 enum bptype type_wanted,
14602 char *addr_start, char **copy_arg)
14603{
14604 parse_breakpoint_sals (arg, canonical);
14605}
14606
14607/* Call create_breakpoints_sal for the given arguments. This is the default
14608 function for the `create_breakpoints_sal' method of
14609 breakpoint_ops. */
14610
14611static void
14612create_breakpoints_sal_default (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
14613 struct linespec_result *canonical,
14614 char *cond_string,
14615 char *extra_string,
14616 enum bptype type_wanted,
14617 enum bpdisp disposition,
14618 int thread,
14619 int task, int ignore_count,
14620 const struct breakpoint_ops *ops,
14621 int from_tty, int enabled,
14622 int internal, unsigned flags)
14623{
14624 create_breakpoints_sal (gdbarch, canonical, cond_string,
14625 extra_string,
14626 type_wanted, disposition,
14627 thread, task, ignore_count, ops, from_tty,
14628 enabled, internal, flags);
14629}
14630
14631/* Decode the line represented by S by calling decode_line_full. This is the
14632 default function for the `decode_linespec' method of breakpoint_ops. */
14633
14634static void
14635decode_linespec_default (struct breakpoint *b, char **s,
14636 struct symtabs_and_lines *sals)
14637{
14638 struct linespec_result canonical;
14639
14640 init_linespec_result (&canonical);
14641 decode_line_full (s, DECODE_LINE_FUNFIRSTLINE,
14642 (struct symtab *) NULL, 0,
14643 &canonical, multiple_symbols_all,
14644 b->filter);
14645
14646 /* We should get 0 or 1 resulting SALs. */
14647 gdb_assert (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) < 2);
14648
14649 if (VEC_length (linespec_sals, canonical.sals) > 0)
14650 {
14651 struct linespec_sals *lsal;
14652
14653 lsal = VEC_index (linespec_sals, canonical.sals, 0);
14654 *sals = lsal->sals;
14655 /* Arrange it so the destructor does not free the
14656 contents. */
14657 lsal->sals.sals = NULL;
14658 }
14659
14660 destroy_linespec_result (&canonical);
14661}
14662
14663/* Prepare the global context for a re-set of breakpoint B. */
14664
14665static struct cleanup *
14666prepare_re_set_context (struct breakpoint *b)
14667{
14668 struct cleanup *cleanups;
14669
14670 input_radix = b->input_radix;
14671 cleanups = save_current_space_and_thread ();
14672 if (b->pspace != NULL)
14673 switch_to_program_space_and_thread (b->pspace);
14674 set_language (b->language);
14675
14676 return cleanups;
14677}
14678
14679/* Reset a breakpoint given it's struct breakpoint * BINT.
14680 The value we return ends up being the return value from catch_errors.
14681 Unused in this case. */
14682
14683static int
14684breakpoint_re_set_one (void *bint)
14685{
14686 /* Get past catch_errs. */
14687 struct breakpoint *b = (struct breakpoint *) bint;
14688 struct cleanup *cleanups;
14689
14690 cleanups = prepare_re_set_context (b);
14691 b->ops->re_set (b);
14692 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14693 return 0;
14694}
14695
14696/* Re-set all breakpoints after symbols have been re-loaded. */
14697void
14698breakpoint_re_set (void)
14699{
14700 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
14701 enum language save_language;
14702 int save_input_radix;
14703 struct cleanup *old_chain;
14704
14705 save_language = current_language->la_language;
14706 save_input_radix = input_radix;
14707 old_chain = save_current_program_space ();
14708
14709 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
14710 {
14711 /* Format possible error msg. */
14712 char *message = xstrprintf ("Error in re-setting breakpoint %d: ",
14713 b->number);
14714 struct cleanup *cleanups = make_cleanup (xfree, message);
14715 catch_errors (breakpoint_re_set_one, b, message, RETURN_MASK_ALL);
14716 do_cleanups (cleanups);
14717 }
14718 set_language (save_language);
14719 input_radix = save_input_radix;
14720
14721 jit_breakpoint_re_set ();
14722
14723 do_cleanups (old_chain);
14724
14725 create_overlay_event_breakpoint ();
14726 create_longjmp_master_breakpoint ();
14727 create_std_terminate_master_breakpoint ();
14728 create_exception_master_breakpoint ();
14729}
14730\f
14731/* Reset the thread number of this breakpoint:
14732
14733 - If the breakpoint is for all threads, leave it as-is.
14734 - Else, reset it to the current thread for inferior_ptid. */
14735void
14736breakpoint_re_set_thread (struct breakpoint *b)
14737{
14738 if (b->thread != -1)
14739 {
14740 if (in_thread_list (inferior_ptid))
14741 b->thread = pid_to_thread_id (inferior_ptid);
14742
14743 /* We're being called after following a fork. The new fork is
14744 selected as current, and unless this was a vfork will have a
14745 different program space from the original thread. Reset that
14746 as well. */
14747 b->loc->pspace = current_program_space;
14748 }
14749}
14750
14751/* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14752 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14753 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14754
14755void
14756set_ignore_count (int bptnum, int count, int from_tty)
14757{
14758 struct breakpoint *b;
14759
14760 if (count < 0)
14761 count = 0;
14762
14763 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14764 if (b->number == bptnum)
14765 {
14766 if (is_tracepoint (b))
14767 {
14768 if (from_tty && count != 0)
14769 printf_filtered (_("Ignore count ignored for tracepoint %d."),
14770 bptnum);
14771 return;
14772 }
14773
14774 b->ignore_count = count;
14775 if (from_tty)
14776 {
14777 if (count == 0)
14778 printf_filtered (_("Will stop next time "
14779 "breakpoint %d is reached."),
14780 bptnum);
14781 else if (count == 1)
14782 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next crossing of breakpoint %d."),
14783 bptnum);
14784 else
14785 printf_filtered (_("Will ignore next %d "
14786 "crossings of breakpoint %d."),
14787 count, bptnum);
14788 }
14789 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (b);
14790 return;
14791 }
14792
14793 error (_("No breakpoint number %d."), bptnum);
14794}
14795
14796/* Command to set ignore-count of breakpoint N to COUNT. */
14797
14798static void
14799ignore_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14800{
14801 char *p = args;
14802 int num;
14803
14804 if (p == 0)
14805 error_no_arg (_("a breakpoint number"));
14806
14807 num = get_number (&p);
14808 if (num == 0)
14809 error (_("bad breakpoint number: '%s'"), args);
14810 if (*p == 0)
14811 error (_("Second argument (specified ignore-count) is missing."));
14812
14813 set_ignore_count (num,
14814 longest_to_int (value_as_long (parse_and_eval (p))),
14815 from_tty);
14816 if (from_tty)
14817 printf_filtered ("\n");
14818}
14819\f
14820/* Call FUNCTION on each of the breakpoints
14821 whose numbers are given in ARGS. */
14822
14823static void
14824map_breakpoint_numbers (char *args, void (*function) (struct breakpoint *,
14825 void *),
14826 void *data)
14827{
14828 int num;
14829 struct breakpoint *b, *tmp;
14830 int match;
14831 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
14832
14833 if (args == 0)
14834 error_no_arg (_("one or more breakpoint numbers"));
14835
14836 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
14837
14838 while (!state.finished)
14839 {
14840 const char *p = state.string;
14841
14842 match = 0;
14843
14844 num = get_number_or_range (&state);
14845 if (num == 0)
14846 {
14847 warning (_("bad breakpoint number at or near '%s'"), p);
14848 }
14849 else
14850 {
14851 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, tmp)
14852 if (b->number == num)
14853 {
14854 match = 1;
14855 function (b, data);
14856 break;
14857 }
14858 if (match == 0)
14859 printf_unfiltered (_("No breakpoint number %d.\n"), num);
14860 }
14861 }
14862}
14863
14864static struct bp_location *
14865find_location_by_number (char *number)
14866{
14867 char *dot = strchr (number, '.');
14868 char *p1;
14869 int bp_num;
14870 int loc_num;
14871 struct breakpoint *b;
14872 struct bp_location *loc;
14873
14874 *dot = '\0';
14875
14876 p1 = number;
14877 bp_num = get_number (&p1);
14878 if (bp_num == 0)
14879 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14880
14881 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
14882 if (b->number == bp_num)
14883 {
14884 break;
14885 }
14886
14887 if (!b || b->number != bp_num)
14888 error (_("Bad breakpoint number '%s'"), number);
14889
14890 p1 = dot+1;
14891 loc_num = get_number (&p1);
14892 if (loc_num == 0)
14893 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), number);
14894
14895 --loc_num;
14896 loc = b->loc;
14897 for (;loc_num && loc; --loc_num, loc = loc->next)
14898 ;
14899 if (!loc)
14900 error (_("Bad breakpoint location number '%s'"), dot+1);
14901
14902 return loc;
14903}
14904
14905
14906/* Set ignore-count of breakpoint number BPTNUM to COUNT.
14907 If from_tty is nonzero, it prints a message to that effect,
14908 which ends with a period (no newline). */
14909
14910void
14911disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
14912{
14913 /* Never disable a watchpoint scope breakpoint; we want to
14914 hit them when we leave scope so we can delete both the
14915 watchpoint and its scope breakpoint at that time. */
14916 if (bpt->type == bp_watchpoint_scope)
14917 return;
14918
14919 bpt->enable_state = bp_disabled;
14920
14921 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
14922 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14923
14924 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14925 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
14926 {
14927 struct bp_location *location;
14928
14929 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
14930 target_disable_tracepoint (location);
14931 }
14932
14933 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14934
14935 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
14936}
14937
14938/* A callback for iterate_over_related_breakpoints. */
14939
14940static void
14941do_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14942{
14943 disable_breakpoint (b);
14944}
14945
14946/* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
14947 disable_breakpoint. */
14948
14949static void
14950do_map_disable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
14951{
14952 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14953}
14954
14955static void
14956disable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
14957{
14958 if (args == 0)
14959 {
14960 struct breakpoint *bpt;
14961
14962 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
14963 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
14964 disable_breakpoint (bpt);
14965 }
14966 else
14967 {
14968 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
14969
14970 while (num)
14971 {
14972 if (strchr (num, '.'))
14973 {
14974 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
14975
14976 if (loc)
14977 {
14978 if (loc->enabled)
14979 {
14980 loc->enabled = 0;
14981 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
14982 }
14983 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
14984 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
14985 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
14986 target_disable_tracepoint (loc);
14987 }
14988 update_global_location_list (UGLL_DONT_INSERT);
14989 }
14990 else
14991 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_disable_breakpoint, NULL);
14992 num = extract_arg (&args);
14993 }
14994 }
14995}
14996
14997static void
14998enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, enum bpdisp disposition,
14999 int count)
15000{
15001 int target_resources_ok;
15002
15003 if (bpt->type == bp_hardware_breakpoint)
15004 {
15005 int i;
15006 i = hw_breakpoint_used_count ();
15007 target_resources_ok =
15008 target_can_use_hardware_watchpoint (bp_hardware_breakpoint,
15009 i + 1, 0);
15010 if (target_resources_ok == 0)
15011 error (_("No hardware breakpoint support in the target."));
15012 else if (target_resources_ok < 0)
15013 error (_("Hardware breakpoints used exceeds limit."));
15014 }
15015
15016 if (is_watchpoint (bpt))
15017 {
15018 /* Initialize it just to avoid a GCC false warning. */
15019 enum enable_state orig_enable_state = 0;
15020 volatile struct gdb_exception e;
15021
15022 TRY_CATCH (e, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15023 {
15024 struct watchpoint *w = (struct watchpoint *) bpt;
15025
15026 orig_enable_state = bpt->enable_state;
15027 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
15028 update_watchpoint (w, 1 /* reparse */);
15029 }
15030 if (e.reason < 0)
15031 {
15032 bpt->enable_state = orig_enable_state;
15033 exception_fprintf (gdb_stderr, e, _("Cannot enable watchpoint %d: "),
15034 bpt->number);
15035 return;
15036 }
15037 }
15038
15039 bpt->enable_state = bp_enabled;
15040
15041 /* Mark breakpoint locations modified. */
15042 mark_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
15043
15044 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
15045 && current_trace_status ()->running && is_tracepoint (bpt))
15046 {
15047 struct bp_location *location;
15048
15049 for (location = bpt->loc; location; location = location->next)
15050 target_enable_tracepoint (location);
15051 }
15052
15053 bpt->disposition = disposition;
15054 bpt->enable_count = count;
15055 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
15056
15057 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (bpt);
15058}
15059
15060
15061void
15062enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt)
15063{
15064 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, bpt->disposition, 0);
15065}
15066
15067static void
15068do_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
15069{
15070 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
15071}
15072
15073/* A callback for map_breakpoint_numbers that calls
15074 enable_breakpoint. */
15075
15076static void
15077do_map_enable_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *b, void *ignore)
15078{
15079 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (b, do_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
15080}
15081
15082/* The enable command enables the specified breakpoints (or all defined
15083 breakpoints) so they once again become (or continue to be) effective
15084 in stopping the inferior. */
15085
15086static void
15087enable_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15088{
15089 if (args == 0)
15090 {
15091 struct breakpoint *bpt;
15092
15093 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
15094 if (user_breakpoint_p (bpt))
15095 enable_breakpoint (bpt);
15096 }
15097 else
15098 {
15099 char *num = extract_arg (&args);
15100
15101 while (num)
15102 {
15103 if (strchr (num, '.'))
15104 {
15105 struct bp_location *loc = find_location_by_number (num);
15106
15107 if (loc)
15108 {
15109 if (!loc->enabled)
15110 {
15111 loc->enabled = 1;
15112 mark_breakpoint_location_modified (loc);
15113 }
15114 if (target_supports_enable_disable_tracepoint ()
15115 && current_trace_status ()->running && loc->owner
15116 && is_tracepoint (loc->owner))
15117 target_enable_tracepoint (loc);
15118 }
15119 update_global_location_list (UGLL_MAY_INSERT);
15120 }
15121 else
15122 map_breakpoint_numbers (num, do_map_enable_breakpoint, NULL);
15123 num = extract_arg (&args);
15124 }
15125 }
15126}
15127
15128/* This struct packages up disposition data for application to multiple
15129 breakpoints. */
15130
15131struct disp_data
15132{
15133 enum bpdisp disp;
15134 int count;
15135};
15136
15137static void
15138do_enable_breakpoint_disp (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *arg)
15139{
15140 struct disp_data disp_data = *(struct disp_data *) arg;
15141
15142 enable_breakpoint_disp (bpt, disp_data.disp, disp_data.count);
15143}
15144
15145static void
15146do_map_enable_once_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
15147{
15148 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, 1 };
15149
15150 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15151}
15152
15153static void
15154enable_once_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15155{
15156 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_once_breakpoint, NULL);
15157}
15158
15159static void
15160do_map_enable_count_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *countptr)
15161{
15162 struct disp_data disp = { disp_disable, *(int *) countptr };
15163
15164 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15165}
15166
15167static void
15168enable_count_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15169{
15170 int count = get_number (&args);
15171
15172 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_count_breakpoint, &count);
15173}
15174
15175static void
15176do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint (struct breakpoint *bpt, void *ignore)
15177{
15178 struct disp_data disp = { disp_del, 1 };
15179
15180 iterate_over_related_breakpoints (bpt, do_enable_breakpoint_disp, &disp);
15181}
15182
15183static void
15184enable_delete_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15185{
15186 map_breakpoint_numbers (args, do_map_enable_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15187}
15188\f
15189static void
15190set_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
15191{
15192}
15193
15194static void
15195show_breakpoint_cmd (char *args, int from_tty)
15196{
15197}
15198
15199/* Invalidate last known value of any hardware watchpoint if
15200 the memory which that value represents has been written to by
15201 GDB itself. */
15202
15203static void
15204invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change (struct inferior *inferior,
15205 CORE_ADDR addr, ssize_t len,
15206 const bfd_byte *data)
15207{
15208 struct breakpoint *bp;
15209
15210 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
15211 if (bp->enable_state == bp_enabled
15212 && bp->type == bp_hardware_watchpoint)
15213 {
15214 struct watchpoint *wp = (struct watchpoint *) bp;
15215
15216 if (wp->val_valid && wp->val)
15217 {
15218 struct bp_location *loc;
15219
15220 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
15221 if (loc->loc_type == bp_loc_hardware_watchpoint
15222 && loc->address + loc->length > addr
15223 && addr + len > loc->address)
15224 {
15225 value_free (wp->val);
15226 wp->val = NULL;
15227 wp->val_valid = 0;
15228 }
15229 }
15230 }
15231}
15232
15233/* Create and insert a breakpoint for software single step. */
15234
15235void
15236insert_single_step_breakpoint (struct gdbarch *gdbarch,
15237 struct address_space *aspace,
15238 CORE_ADDR next_pc)
15239{
15240 struct thread_info *tp = inferior_thread ();
15241 struct symtab_and_line sal;
15242 CORE_ADDR pc = next_pc;
15243
15244 if (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints == NULL)
15245 {
15246 tp->control.single_step_breakpoints
15247 = new_single_step_breakpoint (tp->num, gdbarch);
15248 }
15249
15250 sal = find_pc_line (pc, 0);
15251 sal.pc = pc;
15252 sal.section = find_pc_overlay (pc);
15253 sal.explicit_pc = 1;
15254 add_location_to_breakpoint (tp->control.single_step_breakpoints, &sal);
15255
15256 update_global_location_list (UGLL_INSERT);
15257}
15258
15259/* See breakpoint.h. */
15260
15261int
15262breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (struct breakpoint *bp,
15263 struct address_space *aspace,
15264 CORE_ADDR pc)
15265{
15266 struct bp_location *loc;
15267
15268 for (loc = bp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next)
15269 if (loc->inserted
15270 && breakpoint_location_address_match (loc, aspace, pc))
15271 return 1;
15272
15273 return 0;
15274}
15275
15276/* Check whether a software single-step breakpoint is inserted at
15277 PC. */
15278
15279int
15280single_step_breakpoint_inserted_here_p (struct address_space *aspace,
15281 CORE_ADDR pc)
15282{
15283 struct breakpoint *bpt;
15284
15285 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bpt)
15286 {
15287 if (bpt->type == bp_single_step
15288 && breakpoint_has_location_inserted_here (bpt, aspace, pc))
15289 return 1;
15290 }
15291 return 0;
15292}
15293
15294/* Returns 0 if 'bp' is NOT a syscall catchpoint,
15295 non-zero otherwise. */
15296static int
15297is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (struct breakpoint *bp)
15298{
15299 if (syscall_catchpoint_p (bp)
15300 && bp->enable_state != bp_disabled
15301 && bp->enable_state != bp_call_disabled)
15302 return 1;
15303 else
15304 return 0;
15305}
15306
15307int
15308catch_syscall_enabled (void)
15309{
15310 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
15311 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (current_inferior ());
15312
15313 return inf_data->total_syscalls_count != 0;
15314}
15315
15316int
15317catching_syscall_number (int syscall_number)
15318{
15319 struct breakpoint *bp;
15320
15321 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (bp)
15322 if (is_syscall_catchpoint_enabled (bp))
15323 {
15324 struct syscall_catchpoint *c = (struct syscall_catchpoint *) bp;
15325
15326 if (c->syscalls_to_be_caught)
15327 {
15328 int i, iter;
15329 for (i = 0;
15330 VEC_iterate (int, c->syscalls_to_be_caught, i, iter);
15331 i++)
15332 if (syscall_number == iter)
15333 return 1;
15334 }
15335 else
15336 return 1;
15337 }
15338
15339 return 0;
15340}
15341
15342/* Complete syscall names. Used by "catch syscall". */
15343static VEC (char_ptr) *
15344catch_syscall_completer (struct cmd_list_element *cmd,
15345 const char *text, const char *word)
15346{
15347 const char **list = get_syscall_names ();
15348 VEC (char_ptr) *retlist
15349 = (list == NULL) ? NULL : complete_on_enum (list, word, word);
15350
15351 xfree (list);
15352 return retlist;
15353}
15354
15355/* Tracepoint-specific operations. */
15356
15357/* Set tracepoint count to NUM. */
15358static void
15359set_tracepoint_count (int num)
15360{
15361 tracepoint_count = num;
15362 set_internalvar_integer (lookup_internalvar ("tpnum"), num);
15363}
15364
15365static void
15366trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15367{
15368 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15369 const char *arg_cp = arg;
15370
15371 if (arg && probe_linespec_to_ops (&arg_cp))
15372 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
15373 else
15374 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15375
15376 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15377 arg,
15378 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
15379 0 /* tempflag */,
15380 bp_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15381 0 /* Ignore count */,
15382 pending_break_support,
15383 ops,
15384 from_tty,
15385 1 /* enabled */,
15386 0 /* internal */, 0);
15387}
15388
15389static void
15390ftrace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15391{
15392 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15393 arg,
15394 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
15395 0 /* tempflag */,
15396 bp_fast_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15397 0 /* Ignore count */,
15398 pending_break_support,
15399 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15400 from_tty,
15401 1 /* enabled */,
15402 0 /* internal */, 0);
15403}
15404
15405/* strace command implementation. Creates a static tracepoint. */
15406
15407static void
15408strace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15409{
15410 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
15411
15412 /* Decide if we are dealing with a static tracepoint marker (`-m'),
15413 or with a normal static tracepoint. */
15414 if (arg && strncmp (arg, "-m", 2) == 0 && isspace (arg[2]))
15415 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
15416 else
15417 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
15418
15419 create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15420 arg,
15421 NULL, 0, NULL, 1 /* parse arg */,
15422 0 /* tempflag */,
15423 bp_static_tracepoint /* type_wanted */,
15424 0 /* Ignore count */,
15425 pending_break_support,
15426 ops,
15427 from_tty,
15428 1 /* enabled */,
15429 0 /* internal */, 0);
15430}
15431
15432/* Set up a fake reader function that gets command lines from a linked
15433 list that was acquired during tracepoint uploading. */
15434
15435static struct uploaded_tp *this_utp;
15436static int next_cmd;
15437
15438static char *
15439read_uploaded_action (void)
15440{
15441 char *rslt;
15442
15443 VEC_iterate (char_ptr, this_utp->cmd_strings, next_cmd, rslt);
15444
15445 next_cmd++;
15446
15447 return rslt;
15448}
15449
15450/* Given information about a tracepoint as recorded on a target (which
15451 can be either a live system or a trace file), attempt to create an
15452 equivalent GDB tracepoint. This is not a reliable process, since
15453 the target does not necessarily have all the information used when
15454 the tracepoint was originally defined. */
15455
15456struct tracepoint *
15457create_tracepoint_from_upload (struct uploaded_tp *utp)
15458{
15459 char *addr_str, small_buf[100];
15460 struct tracepoint *tp;
15461
15462 if (utp->at_string)
15463 addr_str = utp->at_string;
15464 else
15465 {
15466 /* In the absence of a source location, fall back to raw
15467 address. Since there is no way to confirm that the address
15468 means the same thing as when the trace was started, warn the
15469 user. */
15470 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d has no "
15471 "source location, using raw address"),
15472 utp->number);
15473 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "*%s", hex_string (utp->addr));
15474 addr_str = small_buf;
15475 }
15476
15477 /* There's not much we can do with a sequence of bytecodes. */
15478 if (utp->cond && !utp->cond_string)
15479 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d condition "
15480 "has no source form, ignoring it"),
15481 utp->number);
15482
15483 if (!create_breakpoint (get_current_arch (),
15484 addr_str,
15485 utp->cond_string, -1, NULL,
15486 0 /* parse cond/thread */,
15487 0 /* tempflag */,
15488 utp->type /* type_wanted */,
15489 0 /* Ignore count */,
15490 pending_break_support,
15491 &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops,
15492 0 /* from_tty */,
15493 utp->enabled /* enabled */,
15494 0 /* internal */,
15495 CREATE_BREAKPOINT_FLAGS_INSERTED))
15496 return NULL;
15497
15498 /* Get the tracepoint we just created. */
15499 tp = get_tracepoint (tracepoint_count);
15500 gdb_assert (tp != NULL);
15501
15502 if (utp->pass > 0)
15503 {
15504 xsnprintf (small_buf, sizeof (small_buf), "%d %d", utp->pass,
15505 tp->base.number);
15506
15507 trace_pass_command (small_buf, 0);
15508 }
15509
15510 /* If we have uploaded versions of the original commands, set up a
15511 special-purpose "reader" function and call the usual command line
15512 reader, then pass the result to the breakpoint command-setting
15513 function. */
15514 if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->cmd_strings))
15515 {
15516 struct command_line *cmd_list;
15517
15518 this_utp = utp;
15519 next_cmd = 0;
15520
15521 cmd_list = read_command_lines_1 (read_uploaded_action, 1, NULL, NULL);
15522
15523 breakpoint_set_commands (&tp->base, cmd_list);
15524 }
15525 else if (!VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->actions)
15526 || !VEC_empty (char_ptr, utp->step_actions))
15527 warning (_("Uploaded tracepoint %d actions "
15528 "have no source form, ignoring them"),
15529 utp->number);
15530
15531 /* Copy any status information that might be available. */
15532 tp->base.hit_count = utp->hit_count;
15533 tp->traceframe_usage = utp->traceframe_usage;
15534
15535 return tp;
15536}
15537
15538/* Print information on tracepoint number TPNUM_EXP, or all if
15539 omitted. */
15540
15541static void
15542tracepoints_info (char *args, int from_tty)
15543{
15544 struct ui_out *uiout = current_uiout;
15545 int num_printed;
15546
15547 num_printed = breakpoint_1 (args, 0, is_tracepoint);
15548
15549 if (num_printed == 0)
15550 {
15551 if (args == NULL || *args == '\0')
15552 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoints.\n");
15553 else
15554 ui_out_message (uiout, 0, "No tracepoint matching '%s'.\n", args);
15555 }
15556
15557 default_collect_info ();
15558}
15559
15560/* The 'enable trace' command enables tracepoints.
15561 Not supported by all targets. */
15562static void
15563enable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15564{
15565 enable_command (args, from_tty);
15566}
15567
15568/* The 'disable trace' command disables tracepoints.
15569 Not supported by all targets. */
15570static void
15571disable_trace_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15572{
15573 disable_command (args, from_tty);
15574}
15575
15576/* Remove a tracepoint (or all if no argument). */
15577static void
15578delete_trace_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15579{
15580 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15581
15582 dont_repeat ();
15583
15584 if (arg == 0)
15585 {
15586 int breaks_to_delete = 0;
15587
15588 /* Delete all breakpoints if no argument.
15589 Do not delete internal or call-dummy breakpoints, these
15590 have to be deleted with an explicit breakpoint number
15591 argument. */
15592 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15593 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15594 {
15595 breaks_to_delete = 1;
15596 break;
15597 }
15598
15599 /* Ask user only if there are some breakpoints to delete. */
15600 if (!from_tty
15601 || (breaks_to_delete && query (_("Delete all tracepoints? "))))
15602 {
15603 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15604 if (is_tracepoint (b) && user_breakpoint_p (b))
15605 delete_breakpoint (b);
15606 }
15607 }
15608 else
15609 map_breakpoint_numbers (arg, do_map_delete_breakpoint, NULL);
15610}
15611
15612/* Helper function for trace_pass_command. */
15613
15614static void
15615trace_pass_set_count (struct tracepoint *tp, int count, int from_tty)
15616{
15617 tp->pass_count = count;
15618 observer_notify_breakpoint_modified (&tp->base);
15619 if (from_tty)
15620 printf_filtered (_("Setting tracepoint %d's passcount to %d\n"),
15621 tp->base.number, count);
15622}
15623
15624/* Set passcount for tracepoint.
15625
15626 First command argument is passcount, second is tracepoint number.
15627 If tracepoint number omitted, apply to most recently defined.
15628 Also accepts special argument "all". */
15629
15630static void
15631trace_pass_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15632{
15633 struct tracepoint *t1;
15634 unsigned int count;
15635
15636 if (args == 0 || *args == 0)
15637 error (_("passcount command requires an "
15638 "argument (count + optional TP num)"));
15639
15640 count = strtoul (args, &args, 10); /* Count comes first, then TP num. */
15641
15642 args = skip_spaces (args);
15643 if (*args && strncasecmp (args, "all", 3) == 0)
15644 {
15645 struct breakpoint *b;
15646
15647 args += 3; /* Skip special argument "all". */
15648 if (*args)
15649 error (_("Junk at end of arguments."));
15650
15651 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15652 {
15653 t1 = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15654 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15655 }
15656 }
15657 else if (*args == '\0')
15658 {
15659 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, NULL);
15660 if (t1)
15661 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15662 }
15663 else
15664 {
15665 struct get_number_or_range_state state;
15666
15667 init_number_or_range (&state, args);
15668 while (!state.finished)
15669 {
15670 t1 = get_tracepoint_by_number (&args, &state);
15671 if (t1)
15672 trace_pass_set_count (t1, count, from_tty);
15673 }
15674 }
15675}
15676
15677struct tracepoint *
15678get_tracepoint (int num)
15679{
15680 struct breakpoint *t;
15681
15682 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15683 if (t->number == num)
15684 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15685
15686 return NULL;
15687}
15688
15689/* Find the tracepoint with the given target-side number (which may be
15690 different from the tracepoint number after disconnecting and
15691 reconnecting). */
15692
15693struct tracepoint *
15694get_tracepoint_by_number_on_target (int num)
15695{
15696 struct breakpoint *b;
15697
15698 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (b)
15699 {
15700 struct tracepoint *t = (struct tracepoint *) b;
15701
15702 if (t->number_on_target == num)
15703 return t;
15704 }
15705
15706 return NULL;
15707}
15708
15709/* Utility: parse a tracepoint number and look it up in the list.
15710 If STATE is not NULL, use, get_number_or_range_state and ignore ARG.
15711 If the argument is missing, the most recent tracepoint
15712 (tracepoint_count) is returned. */
15713
15714struct tracepoint *
15715get_tracepoint_by_number (char **arg,
15716 struct get_number_or_range_state *state)
15717{
15718 struct breakpoint *t;
15719 int tpnum;
15720 char *instring = arg == NULL ? NULL : *arg;
15721
15722 if (state)
15723 {
15724 gdb_assert (!state->finished);
15725 tpnum = get_number_or_range (state);
15726 }
15727 else if (arg == NULL || *arg == NULL || ! **arg)
15728 tpnum = tracepoint_count;
15729 else
15730 tpnum = get_number (arg);
15731
15732 if (tpnum <= 0)
15733 {
15734 if (instring && *instring)
15735 printf_filtered (_("bad tracepoint number at or near '%s'\n"),
15736 instring);
15737 else
15738 printf_filtered (_("No previous tracepoint\n"));
15739 return NULL;
15740 }
15741
15742 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (t)
15743 if (t->number == tpnum)
15744 {
15745 return (struct tracepoint *) t;
15746 }
15747
15748 printf_unfiltered ("No tracepoint number %d.\n", tpnum);
15749 return NULL;
15750}
15751
15752void
15753print_recreate_thread (struct breakpoint *b, struct ui_file *fp)
15754{
15755 if (b->thread != -1)
15756 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " thread %d", b->thread);
15757
15758 if (b->task != 0)
15759 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " task %d", b->task);
15760
15761 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "\n");
15762}
15763
15764/* Save information on user settable breakpoints (watchpoints, etc) to
15765 a new script file named FILENAME. If FILTER is non-NULL, call it
15766 on each breakpoint and only include the ones for which it returns
15767 non-zero. */
15768
15769static void
15770save_breakpoints (char *filename, int from_tty,
15771 int (*filter) (const struct breakpoint *))
15772{
15773 struct breakpoint *tp;
15774 int any = 0;
15775 struct cleanup *cleanup;
15776 struct ui_file *fp;
15777 int extra_trace_bits = 0;
15778
15779 if (filename == 0 || *filename == 0)
15780 error (_("Argument required (file name in which to save)"));
15781
15782 /* See if we have anything to save. */
15783 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15784 {
15785 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15786 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15787 continue;
15788
15789 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15790 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15791 continue;
15792
15793 any = 1;
15794
15795 if (is_tracepoint (tp))
15796 {
15797 extra_trace_bits = 1;
15798
15799 /* We can stop searching. */
15800 break;
15801 }
15802 }
15803
15804 if (!any)
15805 {
15806 warning (_("Nothing to save."));
15807 return;
15808 }
15809
15810 filename = tilde_expand (filename);
15811 cleanup = make_cleanup (xfree, filename);
15812 fp = gdb_fopen (filename, "w");
15813 if (!fp)
15814 error (_("Unable to open file '%s' for saving (%s)"),
15815 filename, safe_strerror (errno));
15816 make_cleanup_ui_file_delete (fp);
15817
15818 if (extra_trace_bits)
15819 save_trace_state_variables (fp);
15820
15821 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (tp)
15822 {
15823 /* Skip internal and momentary breakpoints. */
15824 if (!user_breakpoint_p (tp))
15825 continue;
15826
15827 /* If we have a filter, only save the breakpoints it accepts. */
15828 if (filter && !filter (tp))
15829 continue;
15830
15831 tp->ops->print_recreate (tp, fp);
15832
15833 /* Note, we can't rely on tp->number for anything, as we can't
15834 assume the recreated breakpoint numbers will match. Use $bpnum
15835 instead. */
15836
15837 if (tp->cond_string)
15838 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " condition $bpnum %s\n", tp->cond_string);
15839
15840 if (tp->ignore_count)
15841 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " ignore $bpnum %d\n", tp->ignore_count);
15842
15843 if (tp->type != bp_dprintf && tp->commands)
15844 {
15845 volatile struct gdb_exception ex;
15846
15847 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " commands\n");
15848
15849 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, fp);
15850 TRY_CATCH (ex, RETURN_MASK_ALL)
15851 {
15852 print_command_lines (current_uiout, tp->commands->commands, 2);
15853 }
15854 ui_out_redirect (current_uiout, NULL);
15855
15856 if (ex.reason < 0)
15857 throw_exception (ex);
15858
15859 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, " end\n");
15860 }
15861
15862 if (tp->enable_state == bp_disabled)
15863 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum\n");
15864
15865 /* If this is a multi-location breakpoint, check if the locations
15866 should be individually disabled. Watchpoint locations are
15867 special, and not user visible. */
15868 if (!is_watchpoint (tp) && tp->loc && tp->loc->next)
15869 {
15870 struct bp_location *loc;
15871 int n = 1;
15872
15873 for (loc = tp->loc; loc != NULL; loc = loc->next, n++)
15874 if (!loc->enabled)
15875 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "disable $bpnum.%d\n", n);
15876 }
15877 }
15878
15879 if (extra_trace_bits && *default_collect)
15880 fprintf_unfiltered (fp, "set default-collect %s\n", default_collect);
15881
15882 if (from_tty)
15883 printf_filtered (_("Saved to file '%s'.\n"), filename);
15884 do_cleanups (cleanup);
15885}
15886
15887/* The `save breakpoints' command. */
15888
15889static void
15890save_breakpoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15891{
15892 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, NULL);
15893}
15894
15895/* The `save tracepoints' command. */
15896
15897static void
15898save_tracepoints_command (char *args, int from_tty)
15899{
15900 save_breakpoints (args, from_tty, is_tracepoint);
15901}
15902
15903/* Create a vector of all tracepoints. */
15904
15905VEC(breakpoint_p) *
15906all_tracepoints (void)
15907{
15908 VEC(breakpoint_p) *tp_vec = 0;
15909 struct breakpoint *tp;
15910
15911 ALL_TRACEPOINTS (tp)
15912 {
15913 VEC_safe_push (breakpoint_p, tp_vec, tp);
15914 }
15915
15916 return tp_vec;
15917}
15918
15919\f
15920/* This help string is used for the break, hbreak, tbreak and thbreak
15921 commands. It is defined as a macro to prevent duplication.
15922 COMMAND should be a string constant containing the name of the
15923 command. */
15924#define BREAK_ARGS_HELP(command) \
15925command" [PROBE_MODIFIER] [LOCATION] [thread THREADNUM] [if CONDITION]\n\
15926PROBE_MODIFIER shall be present if the command is to be placed in a\n\
15927probe point. Accepted values are `-probe' (for a generic, automatically\n\
15928guessed probe type) or `-probe-stap' (for a SystemTap probe).\n\
15929LOCATION may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
15930If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
15931If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function.\n\
15932If an address is specified, break at that exact address.\n\
15933With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of the selected\n\
15934stack frame. This is useful for breaking on return to a stack frame.\n\
15935\n\
15936THREADNUM is the number from \"info threads\".\n\
15937CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
15938\n\
15939Multiple breakpoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
15940conditions are different.\n\
15941\n\
15942Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints."
15943
15944/* List of subcommands for "catch". */
15945static struct cmd_list_element *catch_cmdlist;
15946
15947/* List of subcommands for "tcatch". */
15948static struct cmd_list_element *tcatch_cmdlist;
15949
15950void
15951add_catch_command (char *name, char *docstring,
15952 cmd_sfunc_ftype *sfunc,
15953 completer_ftype *completer,
15954 void *user_data_catch,
15955 void *user_data_tcatch)
15956{
15957 struct cmd_list_element *command;
15958
15959 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15960 &catch_cmdlist);
15961 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15962 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_catch);
15963 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15964
15965 command = add_cmd (name, class_breakpoint, NULL, docstring,
15966 &tcatch_cmdlist);
15967 set_cmd_sfunc (command, sfunc);
15968 set_cmd_context (command, user_data_tcatch);
15969 set_cmd_completer (command, completer);
15970}
15971
15972static void
15973clear_syscall_counts (struct inferior *inf)
15974{
15975 struct catch_syscall_inferior_data *inf_data
15976 = get_catch_syscall_inferior_data (inf);
15977
15978 inf_data->total_syscalls_count = 0;
15979 inf_data->any_syscall_count = 0;
15980 VEC_free (int, inf_data->syscalls_counts);
15981}
15982
15983static void
15984save_command (char *arg, int from_tty)
15985{
15986 printf_unfiltered (_("\"save\" must be followed by "
15987 "the name of a save subcommand.\n"));
15988 help_list (save_cmdlist, "save ", all_commands, gdb_stdout);
15989}
15990
15991struct breakpoint *
15992iterate_over_breakpoints (int (*callback) (struct breakpoint *, void *),
15993 void *data)
15994{
15995 struct breakpoint *b, *b_tmp;
15996
15997 ALL_BREAKPOINTS_SAFE (b, b_tmp)
15998 {
15999 if ((*callback) (b, data))
16000 return b;
16001 }
16002
16003 return NULL;
16004}
16005
16006/* Zero if any of the breakpoint's locations could be a location where
16007 functions have been inlined, nonzero otherwise. */
16008
16009static int
16010is_non_inline_function (struct breakpoint *b)
16011{
16012 /* The shared library event breakpoint is set on the address of a
16013 non-inline function. */
16014 if (b->type == bp_shlib_event)
16015 return 1;
16016
16017 return 0;
16018}
16019
16020/* Nonzero if the specified PC cannot be a location where functions
16021 have been inlined. */
16022
16023int
16024pc_at_non_inline_function (struct address_space *aspace, CORE_ADDR pc,
16025 const struct target_waitstatus *ws)
16026{
16027 struct breakpoint *b;
16028 struct bp_location *bl;
16029
16030 ALL_BREAKPOINTS (b)
16031 {
16032 if (!is_non_inline_function (b))
16033 continue;
16034
16035 for (bl = b->loc; bl != NULL; bl = bl->next)
16036 {
16037 if (!bl->shlib_disabled
16038 && bpstat_check_location (bl, aspace, pc, ws))
16039 return 1;
16040 }
16041 }
16042
16043 return 0;
16044}
16045
16046/* Remove any references to OBJFILE which is going to be freed. */
16047
16048void
16049breakpoint_free_objfile (struct objfile *objfile)
16050{
16051 struct bp_location **locp, *loc;
16052
16053 ALL_BP_LOCATIONS (loc, locp)
16054 if (loc->symtab != NULL && SYMTAB_OBJFILE (loc->symtab) == objfile)
16055 loc->symtab = NULL;
16056}
16057
16058void
16059initialize_breakpoint_ops (void)
16060{
16061 static int initialized = 0;
16062
16063 struct breakpoint_ops *ops;
16064
16065 if (initialized)
16066 return;
16067 initialized = 1;
16068
16069 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be inherit by all kinds of
16070 breakpoints (real breakpoints, i.e., user "break" breakpoints,
16071 internal and momentary breakpoints, etc.). */
16072 ops = &bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16073 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16074 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
16075 ops->insert_location = bkpt_insert_location;
16076 ops->remove_location = bkpt_remove_location;
16077 ops->breakpoint_hit = bkpt_breakpoint_hit;
16078 ops->create_sals_from_address = bkpt_create_sals_from_address;
16079 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = bkpt_create_breakpoints_sal;
16080 ops->decode_linespec = bkpt_decode_linespec;
16081
16082 /* The breakpoint_ops structure to be used in regular breakpoints. */
16083 ops = &bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16084 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16085 ops->re_set = bkpt_re_set;
16086 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
16087 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
16088 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
16089 ops->print_recreate = bkpt_print_recreate;
16090
16091 /* Ranged breakpoints. */
16092 ops = &ranged_breakpoint_ops;
16093 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16094 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_ranged_breakpoint;
16095 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_ranged_breakpoint;
16096 ops->print_it = print_it_ranged_breakpoint;
16097 ops->print_one = print_one_ranged_breakpoint;
16098 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_ranged_breakpoint;
16099 ops->print_mention = print_mention_ranged_breakpoint;
16100 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_ranged_breakpoint;
16101
16102 /* Internal breakpoints. */
16103 ops = &internal_breakpoint_ops;
16104 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16105 ops->re_set = internal_bkpt_re_set;
16106 ops->check_status = internal_bkpt_check_status;
16107 ops->print_it = internal_bkpt_print_it;
16108 ops->print_mention = internal_bkpt_print_mention;
16109
16110 /* Momentary breakpoints. */
16111 ops = &momentary_breakpoint_ops;
16112 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16113 ops->re_set = momentary_bkpt_re_set;
16114 ops->check_status = momentary_bkpt_check_status;
16115 ops->print_it = momentary_bkpt_print_it;
16116 ops->print_mention = momentary_bkpt_print_mention;
16117
16118 /* Momentary breakpoints for bp_longjmp and bp_exception. */
16119 ops = &longjmp_breakpoint_ops;
16120 *ops = momentary_breakpoint_ops;
16121 ops->dtor = longjmp_bkpt_dtor;
16122
16123 /* Probe breakpoints. */
16124 ops = &bkpt_probe_breakpoint_ops;
16125 *ops = bkpt_breakpoint_ops;
16126 ops->insert_location = bkpt_probe_insert_location;
16127 ops->remove_location = bkpt_probe_remove_location;
16128 ops->create_sals_from_address = bkpt_probe_create_sals_from_address;
16129 ops->decode_linespec = bkpt_probe_decode_linespec;
16130
16131 /* Watchpoints. */
16132 ops = &watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16133 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16134 ops->dtor = dtor_watchpoint;
16135 ops->re_set = re_set_watchpoint;
16136 ops->insert_location = insert_watchpoint;
16137 ops->remove_location = remove_watchpoint;
16138 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_watchpoint;
16139 ops->check_status = check_status_watchpoint;
16140 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_watchpoint;
16141 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_watchpoint;
16142 ops->print_it = print_it_watchpoint;
16143 ops->print_mention = print_mention_watchpoint;
16144 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_watchpoint;
16145 ops->explains_signal = explains_signal_watchpoint;
16146
16147 /* Masked watchpoints. */
16148 ops = &masked_watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16149 *ops = watchpoint_breakpoint_ops;
16150 ops->insert_location = insert_masked_watchpoint;
16151 ops->remove_location = remove_masked_watchpoint;
16152 ops->resources_needed = resources_needed_masked_watchpoint;
16153 ops->works_in_software_mode = works_in_software_mode_masked_watchpoint;
16154 ops->print_it = print_it_masked_watchpoint;
16155 ops->print_one_detail = print_one_detail_masked_watchpoint;
16156 ops->print_mention = print_mention_masked_watchpoint;
16157 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_masked_watchpoint;
16158
16159 /* Tracepoints. */
16160 ops = &tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16161 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16162 ops->re_set = tracepoint_re_set;
16163 ops->breakpoint_hit = tracepoint_breakpoint_hit;
16164 ops->print_one_detail = tracepoint_print_one_detail;
16165 ops->print_mention = tracepoint_print_mention;
16166 ops->print_recreate = tracepoint_print_recreate;
16167 ops->create_sals_from_address = tracepoint_create_sals_from_address;
16168 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = tracepoint_create_breakpoints_sal;
16169 ops->decode_linespec = tracepoint_decode_linespec;
16170
16171 /* Probe tracepoints. */
16172 ops = &tracepoint_probe_breakpoint_ops;
16173 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16174 ops->create_sals_from_address = tracepoint_probe_create_sals_from_address;
16175 ops->decode_linespec = tracepoint_probe_decode_linespec;
16176
16177 /* Static tracepoints with marker (`-m'). */
16178 ops = &strace_marker_breakpoint_ops;
16179 *ops = tracepoint_breakpoint_ops;
16180 ops->create_sals_from_address = strace_marker_create_sals_from_address;
16181 ops->create_breakpoints_sal = strace_marker_create_breakpoints_sal;
16182 ops->decode_linespec = strace_marker_decode_linespec;
16183
16184 /* Fork catchpoints. */
16185 ops = &catch_fork_breakpoint_ops;
16186 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16187 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_fork;
16188 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_fork;
16189 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_fork;
16190 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_fork;
16191 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_fork;
16192 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_fork;
16193 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_fork;
16194
16195 /* Vfork catchpoints. */
16196 ops = &catch_vfork_breakpoint_ops;
16197 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16198 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_vfork;
16199 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_vfork;
16200 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_vfork;
16201 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_vfork;
16202 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_vfork;
16203 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_vfork;
16204 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_vfork;
16205
16206 /* Exec catchpoints. */
16207 ops = &catch_exec_breakpoint_ops;
16208 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16209 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_exec;
16210 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_exec;
16211 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_exec;
16212 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_exec;
16213 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_exec;
16214 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_exec;
16215 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_exec;
16216 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_exec;
16217
16218 /* Syscall catchpoints. */
16219 ops = &catch_syscall_breakpoint_ops;
16220 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16221 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_syscall;
16222 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_syscall;
16223 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_syscall;
16224 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_syscall;
16225 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_syscall;
16226 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_syscall;
16227 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_syscall;
16228 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_syscall;
16229
16230 /* Solib-related catchpoints. */
16231 ops = &catch_solib_breakpoint_ops;
16232 *ops = base_breakpoint_ops;
16233 ops->dtor = dtor_catch_solib;
16234 ops->insert_location = insert_catch_solib;
16235 ops->remove_location = remove_catch_solib;
16236 ops->breakpoint_hit = breakpoint_hit_catch_solib;
16237 ops->check_status = check_status_catch_solib;
16238 ops->print_it = print_it_catch_solib;
16239 ops->print_one = print_one_catch_solib;
16240 ops->print_mention = print_mention_catch_solib;
16241 ops->print_recreate = print_recreate_catch_solib;
16242
16243 ops = &dprintf_breakpoint_ops;
16244 *ops = bkpt_base_breakpoint_ops;
16245 ops->re_set = dprintf_re_set;
16246 ops->resources_needed = bkpt_resources_needed;
16247 ops->print_it = bkpt_print_it;
16248 ops->print_mention = bkpt_print_mention;
16249 ops->print_recreate = dprintf_print_recreate;
16250 ops->after_condition_true = dprintf_after_condition_true;
16251 ops->breakpoint_hit = dprintf_breakpoint_hit;
16252}
16253
16254/* Chain containing all defined "enable breakpoint" subcommands. */
16255
16256static struct cmd_list_element *enablebreaklist = NULL;
16257
16258void
16259_initialize_breakpoint (void)
16260{
16261 struct cmd_list_element *c;
16262
16263 initialize_breakpoint_ops ();
16264
16265 observer_attach_solib_unloaded (disable_breakpoints_in_unloaded_shlib);
16266 observer_attach_free_objfile (disable_breakpoints_in_freed_objfile);
16267 observer_attach_inferior_exit (clear_syscall_counts);
16268 observer_attach_memory_changed (invalidate_bp_value_on_memory_change);
16269
16270 breakpoint_objfile_key
16271 = register_objfile_data_with_cleanup (NULL, free_breakpoint_probes);
16272
16273 catch_syscall_inferior_data
16274 = register_inferior_data_with_cleanup (NULL,
16275 catch_syscall_inferior_data_cleanup);
16276
16277 breakpoint_chain = 0;
16278 /* Don't bother to call set_breakpoint_count. $bpnum isn't useful
16279 before a breakpoint is set. */
16280 breakpoint_count = 0;
16281
16282 tracepoint_count = 0;
16283
16284 add_com ("ignore", class_breakpoint, ignore_command, _("\
16285Set ignore-count of breakpoint number N to COUNT.\n\
16286Usage is `ignore N COUNT'."));
16287 if (xdb_commands)
16288 add_com_alias ("bc", "ignore", class_breakpoint, 1);
16289
16290 add_com ("commands", class_breakpoint, commands_command, _("\
16291Set commands to be executed when a breakpoint is hit.\n\
16292Give breakpoint number as argument after \"commands\".\n\
16293With no argument, the targeted breakpoint is the last one set.\n\
16294The commands themselves follow starting on the next line.\n\
16295Type a line containing \"end\" to indicate the end of them.\n\
16296Give \"silent\" as the first line to make the breakpoint silent;\n\
16297then no output is printed when it is hit, except what the commands print."));
16298
16299 c = add_com ("condition", class_breakpoint, condition_command, _("\
16300Specify breakpoint number N to break only if COND is true.\n\
16301Usage is `condition N COND', where N is an integer and COND is an\n\
16302expression to be evaluated whenever breakpoint N is reached."));
16303 set_cmd_completer (c, condition_completer);
16304
16305 c = add_com ("tbreak", class_breakpoint, tbreak_command, _("\
16306Set a temporary breakpoint.\n\
16307Like \"break\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
16308so it will be deleted when hit. Equivalent to \"break\" followed\n\
16309by using \"enable delete\" on the breakpoint number.\n\
16310\n"
16311BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("tbreak")));
16312 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16313
16314 c = add_com ("hbreak", class_breakpoint, hbreak_command, _("\
16315Set a hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
16316Like \"break\" except the breakpoint requires hardware support,\n\
16317some target hardware may not have this support.\n\
16318\n"
16319BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("hbreak")));
16320 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16321
16322 c = add_com ("thbreak", class_breakpoint, thbreak_command, _("\
16323Set a temporary hardware assisted breakpoint.\n\
16324Like \"hbreak\" except the breakpoint is only temporary,\n\
16325so it will be deleted when hit.\n\
16326\n"
16327BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("thbreak")));
16328 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16329
16330 add_prefix_cmd ("enable", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16331Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16332Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16333With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
16334This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16335With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."),
16336 &enablelist, "enable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16337 if (xdb_commands)
16338 add_com ("ab", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16339Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16340Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16341With no subcommand, breakpoints are enabled until you command otherwise.\n\
16342This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16343With a subcommand you can enable temporarily."));
16344
16345 add_com_alias ("en", "enable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16346
16347 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, enable_command, _("\
16348Enable some breakpoints.\n\
16349Give breakpoint numbers (separated by spaces) as arguments.\n\
16350This is used to cancel the effect of the \"disable\" command.\n\
16351May be abbreviated to simply \"enable\".\n"),
16352 &enablebreaklist, "enable breakpoints ", 1, &enablelist);
16353
16354 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16355Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16356If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16357 &enablebreaklist);
16358
16359 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16360Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16361If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16362 &enablebreaklist);
16363
16364 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16365Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16366If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16367the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16368 &enablebreaklist);
16369
16370 add_cmd ("delete", no_class, enable_delete_command, _("\
16371Enable breakpoints and delete when hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16372If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it is deleted."),
16373 &enablelist);
16374
16375 add_cmd ("once", no_class, enable_once_command, _("\
16376Enable breakpoints for one hit. Give breakpoint numbers.\n\
16377If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion, it becomes disabled."),
16378 &enablelist);
16379
16380 add_cmd ("count", no_class, enable_count_command, _("\
16381Enable breakpoints for COUNT hits. Give count and then breakpoint numbers.\n\
16382If a breakpoint is hit while enabled in this fashion,\n\
16383the count is decremented; when it reaches zero, the breakpoint is disabled."),
16384 &enablelist);
16385
16386 add_prefix_cmd ("disable", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
16387Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16388Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16389To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16390A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."),
16391 &disablelist, "disable ", 1, &cmdlist);
16392 add_com_alias ("dis", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16393 add_com_alias ("disa", "disable", class_breakpoint, 1);
16394 if (xdb_commands)
16395 add_com ("sb", class_breakpoint, disable_command, _("\
16396Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16397Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16398To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16399A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled."));
16400
16401 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, disable_command, _("\
16402Disable some breakpoints.\n\
16403Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16404To disable all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16405A disabled breakpoint is not forgotten, but has no effect until re-enabled.\n\
16406This command may be abbreviated \"disable\"."),
16407 &disablelist);
16408
16409 add_prefix_cmd ("delete", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
16410Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16411Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16412To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16413\n\
16414Also a prefix command for deletion of other GDB objects.\n\
16415The \"unset\" command is also an alias for \"delete\"."),
16416 &deletelist, "delete ", 1, &cmdlist);
16417 add_com_alias ("d", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16418 add_com_alias ("del", "delete", class_breakpoint, 1);
16419 if (xdb_commands)
16420 add_com ("db", class_breakpoint, delete_command, _("\
16421Delete some breakpoints.\n\
16422Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16423To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n"));
16424
16425 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_alias, delete_command, _("\
16426Delete some breakpoints or auto-display expressions.\n\
16427Arguments are breakpoint numbers with spaces in between.\n\
16428To delete all breakpoints, give no argument.\n\
16429This command may be abbreviated \"delete\"."),
16430 &deletelist);
16431
16432 add_com ("clear", class_breakpoint, clear_command, _("\
16433Clear breakpoint at specified line or function.\n\
16434Argument may be line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
16435If line number is specified, all breakpoints in that line are cleared.\n\
16436If function is specified, breakpoints at beginning of function are cleared.\n\
16437If an address is specified, breakpoints at that address are cleared.\n\
16438\n\
16439With no argument, clears all breakpoints in the line that the selected frame\n\
16440is executing in.\n\
16441\n\
16442See also the \"delete\" command which clears breakpoints by number."));
16443 add_com_alias ("cl", "clear", class_breakpoint, 1);
16444
16445 c = add_com ("break", class_breakpoint, break_command, _("\
16446Set breakpoint at specified line or function.\n"
16447BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("break")));
16448 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16449
16450 add_com_alias ("b", "break", class_run, 1);
16451 add_com_alias ("br", "break", class_run, 1);
16452 add_com_alias ("bre", "break", class_run, 1);
16453 add_com_alias ("brea", "break", class_run, 1);
16454
16455 if (xdb_commands)
16456 add_com_alias ("ba", "break", class_breakpoint, 1);
16457
16458 if (dbx_commands)
16459 {
16460 add_abbrev_prefix_cmd ("stop", class_breakpoint, stop_command, _("\
16461Break in function/address or break at a line in the current file."),
16462 &stoplist, "stop ", 1, &cmdlist);
16463 add_cmd ("in", class_breakpoint, stopin_command,
16464 _("Break in function or address."), &stoplist);
16465 add_cmd ("at", class_breakpoint, stopat_command,
16466 _("Break at a line in the current file."), &stoplist);
16467 add_com ("status", class_info, breakpoints_info, _("\
16468Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16469The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16470\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16471\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16472The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16473the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16474breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16475address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16476\n\
16477Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16478are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16479is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16480Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16481breakpoint set."));
16482 }
16483
16484 add_info ("breakpoints", breakpoints_info, _("\
16485Status of specified breakpoints (all user-settable breakpoints if no argument).\n\
16486The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16487\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16488\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16489The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16490the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16491breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16492address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16493\n\
16494Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16495are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16496is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16497Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16498breakpoint set."));
16499
16500 add_info_alias ("b", "breakpoints", 1);
16501
16502 if (xdb_commands)
16503 add_com ("lb", class_breakpoint, breakpoints_info, _("\
16504Status of user-settable breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16505The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16506\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16507\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16508The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16509the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16510breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16511address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16512\n\
16513Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16514are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16515is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16516Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16517breakpoint set."));
16518
16519 add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_maintenance, maintenance_info_breakpoints, _("\
16520Status of all breakpoints, or breakpoint number NUMBER.\n\
16521The \"Type\" column indicates one of:\n\
16522\tbreakpoint - normal breakpoint\n\
16523\twatchpoint - watchpoint\n\
16524\tlongjmp - internal breakpoint used to step through longjmp()\n\
16525\tlongjmp resume - internal breakpoint at the target of longjmp()\n\
16526\tuntil - internal breakpoint used by the \"until\" command\n\
16527\tfinish - internal breakpoint used by the \"finish\" command\n\
16528The \"Disp\" column contains one of \"keep\", \"del\", or \"dis\" to indicate\n\
16529the disposition of the breakpoint after it gets hit. \"dis\" means that the\n\
16530breakpoint will be disabled. The \"Address\" and \"What\" columns indicate the\n\
16531address and file/line number respectively.\n\
16532\n\
16533Convenience variable \"$_\" and default examine address for \"x\"\n\
16534are set to the address of the last breakpoint listed unless the command\n\
16535is prefixed with \"server \".\n\n\
16536Convenience variable \"$bpnum\" contains the number of the last\n\
16537breakpoint set."),
16538 &maintenanceinfolist);
16539
16540 add_prefix_cmd ("catch", class_breakpoint, catch_command, _("\
16541Set catchpoints to catch events."),
16542 &catch_cmdlist, "catch ",
16543 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16544
16545 add_prefix_cmd ("tcatch", class_breakpoint, tcatch_command, _("\
16546Set temporary catchpoints to catch events."),
16547 &tcatch_cmdlist, "tcatch ",
16548 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16549
16550 add_catch_command ("fork", _("Catch calls to fork."),
16551 catch_fork_command_1,
16552 NULL,
16553 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_permanent,
16554 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_fork_temporary);
16555 add_catch_command ("vfork", _("Catch calls to vfork."),
16556 catch_fork_command_1,
16557 NULL,
16558 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_permanent,
16559 (void *) (uintptr_t) catch_vfork_temporary);
16560 add_catch_command ("exec", _("Catch calls to exec."),
16561 catch_exec_command_1,
16562 NULL,
16563 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16564 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16565 add_catch_command ("load", _("Catch loads of shared libraries.\n\
16566Usage: catch load [REGEX]\n\
16567If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16568 catch_load_command_1,
16569 NULL,
16570 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16571 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16572 add_catch_command ("unload", _("Catch unloads of shared libraries.\n\
16573Usage: catch unload [REGEX]\n\
16574If REGEX is given, only stop for libraries matching the regular expression."),
16575 catch_unload_command_1,
16576 NULL,
16577 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16578 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16579 add_catch_command ("syscall", _("\
16580Catch system calls by their names and/or numbers.\n\
16581Arguments say which system calls to catch. If no arguments\n\
16582are given, every system call will be caught.\n\
16583Arguments, if given, should be one or more system call names\n\
16584(if your system supports that), or system call numbers."),
16585 catch_syscall_command_1,
16586 catch_syscall_completer,
16587 CATCH_PERMANENT,
16588 CATCH_TEMPORARY);
16589
16590 c = add_com ("watch", class_breakpoint, watch_command, _("\
16591Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16592Usage: watch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16593A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16594an expression changes.\n\
16595If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16596the memory to which it refers."));
16597 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16598
16599 c = add_com ("rwatch", class_breakpoint, rwatch_command, _("\
16600Set a read watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16601Usage: rwatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16602A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16603an expression is read.\n\
16604If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16605the memory to which it refers."));
16606 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16607
16608 c = add_com ("awatch", class_breakpoint, awatch_command, _("\
16609Set a watchpoint for an expression.\n\
16610Usage: awatch [-l|-location] EXPRESSION\n\
16611A watchpoint stops execution of your program whenever the value of\n\
16612an expression is either read or written.\n\
16613If -l or -location is given, this evaluates EXPRESSION and watches\n\
16614the memory to which it refers."));
16615 set_cmd_completer (c, expression_completer);
16616
16617 add_info ("watchpoints", watchpoints_info, _("\
16618Status of specified watchpoints (all watchpoints if no argument)."));
16619
16620 /* XXX: cagney/2005-02-23: This should be a boolean, and should
16621 respond to changes - contrary to the description. */
16622 add_setshow_zinteger_cmd ("can-use-hw-watchpoints", class_support,
16623 &can_use_hw_watchpoints, _("\
16624Set debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16625Show debugger's willingness to use watchpoint hardware."), _("\
16626If zero, gdb will not use hardware for new watchpoints, even if\n\
16627such is available. (However, any hardware watchpoints that were\n\
16628created before setting this to nonzero, will continue to use watchpoint\n\
16629hardware.)"),
16630 NULL,
16631 show_can_use_hw_watchpoints,
16632 &setlist, &showlist);
16633
16634 can_use_hw_watchpoints = 1;
16635
16636 /* Tracepoint manipulation commands. */
16637
16638 c = add_com ("trace", class_breakpoint, trace_command, _("\
16639Set a tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
16640\n"
16641BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("trace") "\n\
16642Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16643 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16644
16645 add_com_alias ("tp", "trace", class_alias, 0);
16646 add_com_alias ("tr", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16647 add_com_alias ("tra", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16648 add_com_alias ("trac", "trace", class_alias, 1);
16649
16650 c = add_com ("ftrace", class_breakpoint, ftrace_command, _("\
16651Set a fast tracepoint at specified line or function.\n\
16652\n"
16653BREAK_ARGS_HELP ("ftrace") "\n\
16654Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16655 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16656
16657 c = add_com ("strace", class_breakpoint, strace_command, _("\
16658Set a static tracepoint at specified line, function or marker.\n\
16659\n\
16660strace [LOCATION] [if CONDITION]\n\
16661LOCATION may be a line number, function name, \"*\" and an address,\n\
16662or -m MARKER_ID.\n\
16663If a line number is specified, probe the marker at start of code\n\
16664for that line. If a function is specified, probe the marker at start\n\
16665of code for that function. If an address is specified, probe the marker\n\
16666at that exact address. If a marker id is specified, probe the marker\n\
16667with that name. With no LOCATION, uses current execution address of\n\
16668the selected stack frame.\n\
16669Static tracepoints accept an extra collect action -- ``collect $_sdata''.\n\
16670This collects arbitrary user data passed in the probe point call to the\n\
16671tracing library. You can inspect it when analyzing the trace buffer,\n\
16672by printing the $_sdata variable like any other convenience variable.\n\
16673\n\
16674CONDITION is a boolean expression.\n\
16675\n\
16676Multiple tracepoints at one place are permitted, and useful if their\n\
16677conditions are different.\n\
16678\n\
16679Do \"help breakpoints\" for info on other commands dealing with breakpoints.\n\
16680Do \"help tracepoints\" for info on other tracepoint commands."));
16681 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16682
16683 add_info ("tracepoints", tracepoints_info, _("\
16684Status of specified tracepoints (all tracepoints if no argument).\n\
16685Convenience variable \"$tpnum\" contains the number of the\n\
16686last tracepoint set."));
16687
16688 add_info_alias ("tp", "tracepoints", 1);
16689
16690 add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, delete_trace_command, _("\
16691Delete specified tracepoints.\n\
16692Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16693No argument means delete all tracepoints."),
16694 &deletelist);
16695 add_alias_cmd ("tr", "tracepoints", class_trace, 1, &deletelist);
16696
16697 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, disable_trace_command, _("\
16698Disable specified tracepoints.\n\
16699Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16700No argument means disable all tracepoints."),
16701 &disablelist);
16702 deprecate_cmd (c, "disable");
16703
16704 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, enable_trace_command, _("\
16705Enable specified tracepoints.\n\
16706Arguments are tracepoint numbers, separated by spaces.\n\
16707No argument means enable all tracepoints."),
16708 &enablelist);
16709 deprecate_cmd (c, "enable");
16710
16711 add_com ("passcount", class_trace, trace_pass_command, _("\
16712Set the passcount for a tracepoint.\n\
16713The trace will end when the tracepoint has been passed 'count' times.\n\
16714Usage: passcount COUNT TPNUM, where TPNUM may also be \"all\";\n\
16715if TPNUM is omitted, passcount refers to the last tracepoint defined."));
16716
16717 add_prefix_cmd ("save", class_breakpoint, save_command,
16718 _("Save breakpoint definitions as a script."),
16719 &save_cmdlist, "save ",
16720 0/*allow-unknown*/, &cmdlist);
16721
16722 c = add_cmd ("breakpoints", class_breakpoint, save_breakpoints_command, _("\
16723Save current breakpoint definitions as a script.\n\
16724This includes all types of breakpoints (breakpoints, watchpoints,\n\
16725catchpoints, tracepoints). Use the 'source' command in another debug\n\
16726session to restore them."),
16727 &save_cmdlist);
16728 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16729
16730 c = add_cmd ("tracepoints", class_trace, save_tracepoints_command, _("\
16731Save current tracepoint definitions as a script.\n\
16732Use the 'source' command in another debug session to restore them."),
16733 &save_cmdlist);
16734 set_cmd_completer (c, filename_completer);
16735
16736 c = add_com_alias ("save-tracepoints", "save tracepoints", class_trace, 0);
16737 deprecate_cmd (c, "save tracepoints");
16738
16739 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, set_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16740Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16741Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16742pending breakpoint behavior"),
16743 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist, "set breakpoint ",
16744 0/*allow-unknown*/, &setlist);
16745 add_prefix_cmd ("breakpoint", class_maintenance, show_breakpoint_cmd, _("\
16746Breakpoint specific settings\n\
16747Configure various breakpoint-specific variables such as\n\
16748pending breakpoint behavior"),
16749 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist, "show breakpoint ",
16750 0/*allow-unknown*/, &showlist);
16751
16752 add_setshow_auto_boolean_cmd ("pending", no_class,
16753 &pending_break_support, _("\
16754Set debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16755Show debugger's behavior regarding pending breakpoints."), _("\
16756If on, an unrecognized breakpoint location will cause gdb to create a\n\
16757pending breakpoint. If off, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in\n\
16758an error. If auto, an unrecognized breakpoint location results in a\n\
16759user-query to see if a pending breakpoint should be created."),
16760 NULL,
16761 show_pending_break_support,
16762 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16763 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16764
16765 pending_break_support = AUTO_BOOLEAN_AUTO;
16766
16767 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("auto-hw", no_class,
16768 &automatic_hardware_breakpoints, _("\
16769Set automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16770Show automatic usage of hardware breakpoints."), _("\
16771If set, the debugger will automatically use hardware breakpoints for\n\
16772breakpoints set with \"break\" but falling in read-only memory. If not set,\n\
16773a warning will be emitted for such breakpoints."),
16774 NULL,
16775 show_automatic_hardware_breakpoints,
16776 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16777 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16778
16779 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("always-inserted", class_support,
16780 &always_inserted_mode, _("\
16781Set mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16782Show mode for inserting breakpoints."), _("\
16783When this mode is on, breakpoints are inserted immediately as soon as\n\
16784they're created, kept inserted even when execution stops, and removed\n\
16785only when the user deletes them. When this mode is off (the default),\n\
16786breakpoints are inserted only when execution continues, and removed\n\
16787when execution stops."),
16788 NULL,
16789 &show_always_inserted_mode,
16790 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16791 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16792
16793 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("condition-evaluation", class_breakpoint,
16794 condition_evaluation_enums,
16795 &condition_evaluation_mode_1, _("\
16796Set mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16797Show mode of breakpoint condition evaluation."), _("\
16798When this is set to \"host\", breakpoint conditions will be\n\
16799evaluated on the host's side by GDB. When it is set to \"target\",\n\
16800breakpoint conditions will be downloaded to the target (if the target\n\
16801supports such feature) and conditions will be evaluated on the target's side.\n\
16802If this is set to \"auto\" (default), this will be automatically set to\n\
16803\"target\" if it supports condition evaluation, otherwise it will\n\
16804be set to \"gdb\""),
16805 &set_condition_evaluation_mode,
16806 &show_condition_evaluation_mode,
16807 &breakpoint_set_cmdlist,
16808 &breakpoint_show_cmdlist);
16809
16810 add_com ("break-range", class_breakpoint, break_range_command, _("\
16811Set a breakpoint for an address range.\n\
16812break-range START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION\n\
16813where START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION can be one of the following:\n\
16814 LINENUM, for that line in the current file,\n\
16815 FILE:LINENUM, for that line in that file,\n\
16816 +OFFSET, for that number of lines after the current line\n\
16817 or the start of the range\n\
16818 FUNCTION, for the first line in that function,\n\
16819 FILE:FUNCTION, to distinguish among like-named static functions.\n\
16820 *ADDRESS, for the instruction at that address.\n\
16821\n\
16822The breakpoint will stop execution of the inferior whenever it executes\n\
16823an instruction at any address within the [START-LOCATION, END-LOCATION]\n\
16824range (including START-LOCATION and END-LOCATION)."));
16825
16826 c = add_com ("dprintf", class_breakpoint, dprintf_command, _("\
16827Set a dynamic printf at specified line or function.\n\
16828dprintf location,format string,arg1,arg2,...\n\
16829location may be a line number, function name, or \"*\" and an address.\n\
16830If a line number is specified, break at start of code for that line.\n\
16831If a function is specified, break at start of code for that function."));
16832 set_cmd_completer (c, location_completer);
16833
16834 add_setshow_enum_cmd ("dprintf-style", class_support,
16835 dprintf_style_enums, &dprintf_style, _("\
16836Set the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16837Show the style of usage for dynamic printf."), _("\
16838This setting chooses how GDB will do a dynamic printf.\n\
16839If the value is \"gdb\", then the printing is done by GDB to its own\n\
16840console, as with the \"printf\" command.\n\
16841If the value is \"call\", the print is done by calling a function in your\n\
16842program; by default printf(), but you can choose a different function or\n\
16843output stream by setting dprintf-function and dprintf-channel."),
16844 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16845 &setlist, &showlist);
16846
16847 dprintf_function = xstrdup ("printf");
16848 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-function", class_support,
16849 &dprintf_function, _("\
16850Set the function to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16851Show the function to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16852 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16853 &setlist, &showlist);
16854
16855 dprintf_channel = xstrdup ("");
16856 add_setshow_string_cmd ("dprintf-channel", class_support,
16857 &dprintf_channel, _("\
16858Set the channel to use for dynamic printf"), _("\
16859Show the channel to use for dynamic printf"), NULL,
16860 update_dprintf_commands, NULL,
16861 &setlist, &showlist);
16862
16863 add_setshow_boolean_cmd ("disconnected-dprintf", no_class,
16864 &disconnected_dprintf, _("\
16865Set whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16866Show whether dprintf continues after GDB disconnects."), _("\
16867Use this to let dprintf commands continue to hit and produce output\n\
16868even if GDB disconnects or detaches from the target."),
16869 NULL,
16870 NULL,
16871 &setlist, &showlist);
16872
16873 add_com ("agent-printf", class_vars, agent_printf_command, _("\
16874agent-printf \"printf format string\", arg1, arg2, arg3, ..., argn\n\
16875(target agent only) This is useful for formatted output in user-defined commands."));
16876
16877 automatic_hardware_breakpoints = 1;
16878
16879 observer_attach_about_to_proceed (breakpoint_about_to_proceed);
16880 observer_attach_thread_exit (remove_threaded_breakpoints);
16881}
This page took 0.074806 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.